{ "version":"2.0", "metadata":{ "apiVersion":"2006-03-01", "checksumFormat":"md5", "endpointPrefix":"s3", "globalEndpoint":"s3.amazonaws.com", "protocol":"rest-xml", "protocols":["rest-xml"], "serviceAbbreviation":"Amazon S3", "serviceFullName":"Amazon Simple Storage Service", "serviceId":"S3", "signatureVersion":"s3", "uid":"s3-2006-03-01", "auth":["aws.auth#sigv4"] }, "operations":{ "AbortMultipartUpload":{ "name":"AbortMultipartUpload", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"AbortMultipartUploadRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"AbortMultipartUploadOutput"}, "errors":[ {"shape":"NoSuchUpload"} ], "documentation":"

This operation aborts a multipart upload. After a multipart upload is aborted, no additional parts can be uploaded using that upload ID. The storage consumed by any previously uploaded parts will be freed. However, if any part uploads are currently in progress, those part uploads might or might not succeed. As a result, it might be necessary to abort a given multipart upload multiple times in order to completely free all storage consumed by all parts.

To verify that all parts have been removed and prevent getting charged for the part storage, you should call the ListParts API operation and ensure that the parts list is empty.

Permissions
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to AbortMultipartUpload:

" }, "CompleteMultipartUpload":{ "name":"CompleteMultipartUpload", "http":{ "method":"POST", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}" }, "input":{"shape":"CompleteMultipartUploadRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"CompleteMultipartUploadOutput"}, "documentation":"

Completes a multipart upload by assembling previously uploaded parts.

You first initiate the multipart upload and then upload all parts using the UploadPart operation or the UploadPartCopy operation. After successfully uploading all relevant parts of an upload, you call this CompleteMultipartUpload operation to complete the upload. Upon receiving this request, Amazon S3 concatenates all the parts in ascending order by part number to create a new object. In the CompleteMultipartUpload request, you must provide the parts list and ensure that the parts list is complete. The CompleteMultipartUpload API operation concatenates the parts that you provide in the list. For each part in the list, you must provide the PartNumber value and the ETag value that are returned after that part was uploaded.

The processing of a CompleteMultipartUpload request could take several minutes to finalize. After Amazon S3 begins processing the request, it sends an HTTP response header that specifies a 200 OK response. While processing is in progress, Amazon S3 periodically sends white space characters to keep the connection from timing out. A request could fail after the initial 200 OK response has been sent. This means that a 200 OK response can contain either a success or an error. The error response might be embedded in the 200 OK response. If you call this API operation directly, make sure to design your application to parse the contents of the response and handle it appropriately. If you use Amazon Web Services SDKs, SDKs handle this condition. The SDKs detect the embedded error and apply error handling per your configuration settings (including automatically retrying the request as appropriate). If the condition persists, the SDKs throw an exception (or, for the SDKs that don't use exceptions, they return an error).

Note that if CompleteMultipartUpload fails, applications should be prepared to retry any failed requests (including 500 error responses). For more information, see Amazon S3 Error Best Practices.

You can't use Content-Type: application/x-www-form-urlencoded for the CompleteMultipartUpload requests. Also, if you don't provide a Content-Type header, CompleteMultipartUpload can still return a 200 OK response.

For more information about multipart uploads, see Uploading Objects Using Multipart Upload in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, you must make requests for this API operation to the Zonal endpoint. These endpoints support virtual-hosted-style requests in the format https://amzn-s3-demo-bucket.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com/key-name . Path-style requests are not supported. For more information about endpoints in Availability Zones, see Regional and Zonal endpoints for directory buckets in Availability Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about endpoints in Local Zones, see Concepts for directory buckets in Local Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions
Special errors
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to CompleteMultipartUpload:

" }, "CopyObject":{ "name":"CopyObject", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}" }, "input":{"shape":"CopyObjectRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"CopyObjectOutput"}, "errors":[ {"shape":"ObjectNotInActiveTierError"} ], "documentation":"

End of support notice: Beginning October 1, 2025, Amazon S3 will discontinue support for creating new Email Grantee Access Control Lists (ACL). Email Grantee ACLs created prior to this date will continue to work and remain accessible through the Amazon Web Services Management Console, Command Line Interface (CLI), SDKs, and REST API. However, you will no longer be able to create new Email Grantee ACLs.

This change affects the following Amazon Web Services Regions: US East (N. Virginia) Region, US West (N. California) Region, US West (Oregon) Region, Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region, Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region, Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region, Europe (Ireland) Region, and South America (São Paulo) Region.

Creates a copy of an object that is already stored in Amazon S3.

You can store individual objects of up to 5 TB in Amazon S3. You create a copy of your object up to 5 GB in size in a single atomic action using this API. However, to copy an object greater than 5 GB, you must use the multipart upload Upload Part - Copy (UploadPartCopy) API. For more information, see Copy Object Using the REST Multipart Upload API.

You can copy individual objects between general purpose buckets, between directory buckets, and between general purpose buckets and directory buckets.

Both the Region that you want to copy the object from and the Region that you want to copy the object to must be enabled for your account. For more information about how to enable a Region for your account, see Enable or disable a Region for standalone accounts in the Amazon Web Services Account Management Guide.

Amazon S3 transfer acceleration does not support cross-Region copies. If you request a cross-Region copy using a transfer acceleration endpoint, you get a 400 Bad Request error. For more information, see Transfer Acceleration.

Authentication and authorization

All CopyObject requests must be authenticated and signed by using IAM credentials (access key ID and secret access key for the IAM identities). All headers with the x-amz- prefix, including x-amz-copy-source, must be signed. For more information, see REST Authentication.

Directory buckets - You must use the IAM credentials to authenticate and authorize your access to the CopyObject API operation, instead of using the temporary security credentials through the CreateSession API operation.

Amazon Web Services CLI or SDKs handles authentication and authorization on your behalf.

Permissions

You must have read access to the source object and write access to the destination bucket.

Response and special errors

When the request is an HTTP 1.1 request, the response is chunk encoded. When the request is not an HTTP 1.1 request, the response would not contain the Content-Length. You always need to read the entire response body to check if the copy succeeds.

Charge

The copy request charge is based on the storage class and Region that you specify for the destination object. The request can also result in a data retrieval charge for the source if the source storage class bills for data retrieval. If the copy source is in a different region, the data transfer is billed to the copy source account. For pricing information, see Amazon S3 pricing.

HTTP Host header syntax

The following operations are related to CopyObject:

", "staticContextParams":{ "DisableS3ExpressSessionAuth":{"value":true} } }, "CreateBucket":{ "name":"CreateBucket", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}" }, "input":{"shape":"CreateBucketRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"CreateBucketOutput"}, "errors":[ {"shape":"BucketAlreadyExists"}, {"shape":"BucketAlreadyOwnedByYou"} ], "documentation":"

End of support notice: Beginning October 1, 2025, Amazon S3 will discontinue support for creating new Email Grantee Access Control Lists (ACL). Email Grantee ACLs created prior to this date will continue to work and remain accessible through the Amazon Web Services Management Console, Command Line Interface (CLI), SDKs, and REST API. However, you will no longer be able to create new Email Grantee ACLs.

This change affects the following Amazon Web Services Regions: US East (N. Virginia) Region, US West (N. California) Region, US West (Oregon) Region, Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region, Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region, Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region, Europe (Ireland) Region, and South America (São Paulo) Region.

End of support notice: Beginning October 1, 2025, Amazon S3 will stop returning DisplayName. Update your applications to use canonical IDs (unique identifier for Amazon Web Services accounts), Amazon Web Services account ID (12 digit identifier) or IAM ARNs (full resource naming) as a direct replacement of DisplayName.

This change affects the following Amazon Web Services Regions: US East (N. Virginia) Region, US West (N. California) Region, US West (Oregon) Region, Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region, Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region, Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region, Europe (Ireland) Region, and South America (São Paulo) Region.

This action creates an Amazon S3 bucket. To create an Amazon S3 on Outposts bucket, see CreateBucket .

Creates a new S3 bucket. To create a bucket, you must set up Amazon S3 and have a valid Amazon Web Services Access Key ID to authenticate requests. Anonymous requests are never allowed to create buckets. By creating the bucket, you become the bucket owner.

There are two types of buckets: general purpose buckets and directory buckets. For more information about these bucket types, see Creating, configuring, and working with Amazon S3 buckets in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to CreateBucket:

", "staticContextParams":{ "DisableAccessPoints":{"value":true}, "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration":{ "name":"CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"POST", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?metadataConfiguration" }, "input":{"shape":"CreateBucketMetadataConfigurationRequest"}, "documentation":"

Creates an S3 Metadata V2 metadata configuration for a general purpose bucket. For more information, see Accelerating data discovery with S3 Metadata in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions

To use this operation, you must have the following permissions. For more information, see Setting up permissions for configuring metadata tables in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you want to encrypt your metadata tables with server-side encryption with Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS), you need additional permissions in your KMS key policy. For more information, see Setting up permissions for configuring metadata tables in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you also want to integrate your table bucket with Amazon Web Services analytics services so that you can query your metadata table, you need additional permissions. For more information, see Integrating Amazon S3 Tables with Amazon Web Services analytics services in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

To query your metadata tables, you need additional permissions. For more information, see Permissions for querying metadata tables in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The following operations are related to CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "CreateBucketMetadataTableConfiguration":{ "name":"CreateBucketMetadataTableConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"POST", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?metadataTable" }, "input":{"shape":"CreateBucketMetadataTableConfigurationRequest"}, "documentation":"

We recommend that you create your S3 Metadata configurations by using the V2 CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration API operation. We no longer recommend using the V1 CreateBucketMetadataTableConfiguration API operation.

If you created your S3 Metadata configuration before July 15, 2025, we recommend that you delete and re-create your configuration by using CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration so that you can expire journal table records and create a live inventory table.

Creates a V1 S3 Metadata configuration for a general purpose bucket. For more information, see Accelerating data discovery with S3 Metadata in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions

To use this operation, you must have the following permissions. For more information, see Setting up permissions for configuring metadata tables in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you want to encrypt your metadata tables with server-side encryption with Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS), you need additional permissions. For more information, see Setting up permissions for configuring metadata tables in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you also want to integrate your table bucket with Amazon Web Services analytics services so that you can query your metadata table, you need additional permissions. For more information, see Integrating Amazon S3 Tables with Amazon Web Services analytics services in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The following operations are related to CreateBucketMetadataTableConfiguration:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "CreateMultipartUpload":{ "name":"CreateMultipartUpload", "http":{ "method":"POST", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}?uploads" }, "input":{"shape":"CreateMultipartUploadRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"CreateMultipartUploadOutput"}, "documentation":"

End of support notice: Beginning October 1, 2025, Amazon S3 will discontinue support for creating new Email Grantee Access Control Lists (ACL). Email Grantee ACLs created prior to this date will continue to work and remain accessible through the Amazon Web Services Management Console, Command Line Interface (CLI), SDKs, and REST API. However, you will no longer be able to create new Email Grantee ACLs.

This change affects the following Amazon Web Services Regions: US East (N. Virginia) Region, US West (N. California) Region, US West (Oregon) Region, Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region, Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region, Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region, Europe (Ireland) Region, and South America (São Paulo) Region.

This action initiates a multipart upload and returns an upload ID. This upload ID is used to associate all of the parts in the specific multipart upload. You specify this upload ID in each of your subsequent upload part requests (see UploadPart). You also include this upload ID in the final request to either complete or abort the multipart upload request. For more information about multipart uploads, see Multipart Upload Overview in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

After you initiate a multipart upload and upload one or more parts, to stop being charged for storing the uploaded parts, you must either complete or abort the multipart upload. Amazon S3 frees up the space used to store the parts and stops charging you for storing them only after you either complete or abort a multipart upload.

If you have configured a lifecycle rule to abort incomplete multipart uploads, the created multipart upload must be completed within the number of days specified in the bucket lifecycle configuration. Otherwise, the incomplete multipart upload becomes eligible for an abort action and Amazon S3 aborts the multipart upload. For more information, see Aborting Incomplete Multipart Uploads Using a Bucket Lifecycle Configuration.

Request signing

For request signing, multipart upload is just a series of regular requests. You initiate a multipart upload, send one or more requests to upload parts, and then complete the multipart upload process. You sign each request individually. There is nothing special about signing multipart upload requests. For more information about signing, see Authenticating Requests (Amazon Web Services Signature Version 4) in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions
Encryption
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to CreateMultipartUpload:

" }, "CreateSession":{ "name":"CreateSession", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?session" }, "input":{"shape":"CreateSessionRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"CreateSessionOutput"}, "errors":[ {"shape":"NoSuchBucket"} ], "documentation":"

Creates a session that establishes temporary security credentials to support fast authentication and authorization for the Zonal endpoint API operations on directory buckets. For more information about Zonal endpoint API operations that include the Availability Zone in the request endpoint, see S3 Express One Zone APIs in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

To make Zonal endpoint API requests on a directory bucket, use the CreateSession API operation. Specifically, you grant s3express:CreateSession permission to a bucket in a bucket policy or an IAM identity-based policy. Then, you use IAM credentials to make the CreateSession API request on the bucket, which returns temporary security credentials that include the access key ID, secret access key, session token, and expiration. These credentials have associated permissions to access the Zonal endpoint API operations. After the session is created, you don’t need to use other policies to grant permissions to each Zonal endpoint API individually. Instead, in your Zonal endpoint API requests, you sign your requests by applying the temporary security credentials of the session to the request headers and following the SigV4 protocol for authentication. You also apply the session token to the x-amz-s3session-token request header for authorization. Temporary security credentials are scoped to the bucket and expire after 5 minutes. After the expiration time, any calls that you make with those credentials will fail. You must use IAM credentials again to make a CreateSession API request that generates a new set of temporary credentials for use. Temporary credentials cannot be extended or refreshed beyond the original specified interval.

If you use Amazon Web Services SDKs, SDKs handle the session token refreshes automatically to avoid service interruptions when a session expires. We recommend that you use the Amazon Web Services SDKs to initiate and manage requests to the CreateSession API. For more information, see Performance guidelines and design patterns in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions

To obtain temporary security credentials, you must create a bucket policy or an IAM identity-based policy that grants s3express:CreateSession permission to the bucket. In a policy, you can have the s3express:SessionMode condition key to control who can create a ReadWrite or ReadOnly session. For more information about ReadWrite or ReadOnly sessions, see x-amz-create-session-mode . For example policies, see Example bucket policies for S3 Express One Zone and Amazon Web Services Identity and Access Management (IAM) identity-based policies for S3 Express One Zone in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

To grant cross-account access to Zonal endpoint API operations, the bucket policy should also grant both accounts the s3express:CreateSession permission.

If you want to encrypt objects with SSE-KMS, you must also have the kms:GenerateDataKey and the kms:Decrypt permissions in IAM identity-based policies and KMS key policies for the target KMS key.

Encryption

For directory buckets, there are only two supported options for server-side encryption: server-side encryption with Amazon S3 managed keys (SSE-S3) (AES256) and server-side encryption with KMS keys (SSE-KMS) (aws:kms). We recommend that the bucket's default encryption uses the desired encryption configuration and you don't override the bucket default encryption in your CreateSession requests or PUT object requests. Then, new objects are automatically encrypted with the desired encryption settings. For more information, see Protecting data with server-side encryption in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about the encryption overriding behaviors in directory buckets, see Specifying server-side encryption with KMS for new object uploads.

For Zonal endpoint (object-level) API operations except CopyObject and UploadPartCopy, you authenticate and authorize requests through CreateSession for low latency. To encrypt new objects in a directory bucket with SSE-KMS, you must specify SSE-KMS as the directory bucket's default encryption configuration with a KMS key (specifically, a customer managed key). Then, when a session is created for Zonal endpoint API operations, new objects are automatically encrypted and decrypted with SSE-KMS and S3 Bucket Keys during the session.

Only 1 customer managed key is supported per directory bucket for the lifetime of the bucket. The Amazon Web Services managed key (aws/s3) isn't supported. After you specify SSE-KMS as your bucket's default encryption configuration with a customer managed key, you can't change the customer managed key for the bucket's SSE-KMS configuration.

In the Zonal endpoint API calls (except CopyObject and UploadPartCopy) using the REST API, you can't override the values of the encryption settings (x-amz-server-side-encryption, x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id, x-amz-server-side-encryption-context, and x-amz-server-side-encryption-bucket-key-enabled) from the CreateSession request. You don't need to explicitly specify these encryption settings values in Zonal endpoint API calls, and Amazon S3 will use the encryption settings values from the CreateSession request to protect new objects in the directory bucket.

When you use the CLI or the Amazon Web Services SDKs, for CreateSession, the session token refreshes automatically to avoid service interruptions when a session expires. The CLI or the Amazon Web Services SDKs use the bucket's default encryption configuration for the CreateSession request. It's not supported to override the encryption settings values in the CreateSession request. Also, in the Zonal endpoint API calls (except CopyObject and UploadPartCopy), it's not supported to override the values of the encryption settings from the CreateSession request.

HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

", "staticContextParams":{ "DisableS3ExpressSessionAuth":{"value":true} } }, "DeleteBucket":{ "name":"DeleteBucket", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteBucketRequest"}, "documentation":"

Deletes the S3 bucket. All objects (including all object versions and delete markers) in the bucket must be deleted before the bucket itself can be deleted.

Permissions
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to DeleteBucket:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfiguration":{ "name":"DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?analytics", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Deletes an analytics configuration for the bucket (specified by the analytics configuration ID).

To use this operation, you must have permissions to perform the s3:PutAnalyticsConfiguration action. The bucket owner has this permission by default. The bucket owner can grant this permission to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources.

For information about the Amazon S3 analytics feature, see Amazon S3 Analytics – Storage Class Analysis.

The following operations are related to DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfiguration:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "DeleteBucketCors":{ "name":"DeleteBucketCors", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?cors", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteBucketCorsRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Deletes the cors configuration information set for the bucket.

To use this operation, you must have permission to perform the s3:PutBucketCORS action. The bucket owner has this permission by default and can grant this permission to others.

For information about cors, see Enabling Cross-Origin Resource Sharing in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Related Resources

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "DeleteBucketEncryption":{ "name":"DeleteBucketEncryption", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?encryption", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteBucketEncryptionRequest"}, "documentation":"

This implementation of the DELETE action resets the default encryption for the bucket as server-side encryption with Amazon S3 managed keys (SSE-S3).

Permissions
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to DeleteBucketEncryption:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "DeleteBucketIntelligentTieringConfiguration":{ "name":"DeleteBucketIntelligentTieringConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?intelligent-tiering", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteBucketIntelligentTieringConfigurationRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Deletes the S3 Intelligent-Tiering configuration from the specified bucket.

The S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class is designed to optimize storage costs by automatically moving data to the most cost-effective storage access tier, without performance impact or operational overhead. S3 Intelligent-Tiering delivers automatic cost savings in three low latency and high throughput access tiers. To get the lowest storage cost on data that can be accessed in minutes to hours, you can choose to activate additional archiving capabilities.

The S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class is the ideal storage class for data with unknown, changing, or unpredictable access patterns, independent of object size or retention period. If the size of an object is less than 128 KB, it is not monitored and not eligible for auto-tiering. Smaller objects can be stored, but they are always charged at the Frequent Access tier rates in the S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class.

For more information, see Storage class for automatically optimizing frequently and infrequently accessed objects.

Operations related to DeleteBucketIntelligentTieringConfiguration include:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "DeleteBucketInventoryConfiguration":{ "name":"DeleteBucketInventoryConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?inventory", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Deletes an S3 Inventory configuration (identified by the inventory ID) from the bucket.

To use this operation, you must have permissions to perform the s3:PutInventoryConfiguration action. The bucket owner has this permission by default. The bucket owner can grant this permission to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources.

For information about the Amazon S3 inventory feature, see Amazon S3 Inventory.

Operations related to DeleteBucketInventoryConfiguration include:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "DeleteBucketLifecycle":{ "name":"DeleteBucketLifecycle", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?lifecycle", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteBucketLifecycleRequest"}, "documentation":"

Deletes the lifecycle configuration from the specified bucket. Amazon S3 removes all the lifecycle configuration rules in the lifecycle subresource associated with the bucket. Your objects never expire, and Amazon S3 no longer automatically deletes any objects on the basis of rules contained in the deleted lifecycle configuration.

Permissions
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is s3express-control.region.amazonaws.com.

For more information about the object expiration, see Elements to Describe Lifecycle Actions.

Related actions include:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "DeleteBucketMetadataConfiguration":{ "name":"DeleteBucketMetadataConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?metadataConfiguration", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteBucketMetadataConfigurationRequest"}, "documentation":"

Deletes an S3 Metadata configuration from a general purpose bucket. For more information, see Accelerating data discovery with S3 Metadata in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

You can use the V2 DeleteBucketMetadataConfiguration API operation with V1 or V2 metadata configurations. However, if you try to use the V1 DeleteBucketMetadataTableConfiguration API operation with V2 configurations, you will receive an HTTP 405 Method Not Allowed error.

Permissions

To use this operation, you must have the s3:DeleteBucketMetadataTableConfiguration permission. For more information, see Setting up permissions for configuring metadata tables in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The IAM policy action name is the same for the V1 and V2 API operations.

The following operations are related to DeleteBucketMetadataConfiguration:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "DeleteBucketMetadataTableConfiguration":{ "name":"DeleteBucketMetadataTableConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?metadataTable", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteBucketMetadataTableConfigurationRequest"}, "documentation":"

We recommend that you delete your S3 Metadata configurations by using the V2 DeleteBucketMetadataTableConfiguration API operation. We no longer recommend using the V1 DeleteBucketMetadataTableConfiguration API operation.

If you created your S3 Metadata configuration before July 15, 2025, we recommend that you delete and re-create your configuration by using CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration so that you can expire journal table records and create a live inventory table.

Deletes a V1 S3 Metadata configuration from a general purpose bucket. For more information, see Accelerating data discovery with S3 Metadata in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

You can use the V2 DeleteBucketMetadataConfiguration API operation with V1 or V2 metadata table configurations. However, if you try to use the V1 DeleteBucketMetadataTableConfiguration API operation with V2 configurations, you will receive an HTTP 405 Method Not Allowed error.

Make sure that you update your processes to use the new V2 API operations (CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration, GetBucketMetadataConfiguration, and DeleteBucketMetadataConfiguration) instead of the V1 API operations.

Permissions

To use this operation, you must have the s3:DeleteBucketMetadataTableConfiguration permission. For more information, see Setting up permissions for configuring metadata tables in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The following operations are related to DeleteBucketMetadataTableConfiguration:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "DeleteBucketMetricsConfiguration":{ "name":"DeleteBucketMetricsConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?metrics", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Deletes a metrics configuration for the Amazon CloudWatch request metrics (specified by the metrics configuration ID) from the bucket. Note that this doesn't include the daily storage metrics.

To use this operation, you must have permissions to perform the s3:PutMetricsConfiguration action. The bucket owner has this permission by default. The bucket owner can grant this permission to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources.

For information about CloudWatch request metrics for Amazon S3, see Monitoring Metrics with Amazon CloudWatch.

The following operations are related to DeleteBucketMetricsConfiguration:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "DeleteBucketOwnershipControls":{ "name":"DeleteBucketOwnershipControls", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?ownershipControls", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteBucketOwnershipControlsRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Removes OwnershipControls for an Amazon S3 bucket. To use this operation, you must have the s3:PutBucketOwnershipControls permission. For more information about Amazon S3 permissions, see Specifying Permissions in a Policy.

For information about Amazon S3 Object Ownership, see Using Object Ownership.

The following operations are related to DeleteBucketOwnershipControls:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "DeleteBucketPolicy":{ "name":"DeleteBucketPolicy", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?policy", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteBucketPolicyRequest"}, "documentation":"

Deletes the policy of a specified bucket.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, you must make requests for this API operation to the Regional endpoint. These endpoints support path-style requests in the format https://s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com/bucket-name . Virtual-hosted-style requests aren't supported. For more information about endpoints in Availability Zones, see Regional and Zonal endpoints for directory buckets in Availability Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about endpoints in Local Zones, see Concepts for directory buckets in Local Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions

If you are using an identity other than the root user of the Amazon Web Services account that owns the bucket, the calling identity must both have the DeleteBucketPolicy permissions on the specified bucket and belong to the bucket owner's account in order to use this operation.

If you don't have DeleteBucketPolicy permissions, Amazon S3 returns a 403 Access Denied error. If you have the correct permissions, but you're not using an identity that belongs to the bucket owner's account, Amazon S3 returns a 405 Method Not Allowed error.

To ensure that bucket owners don't inadvertently lock themselves out of their own buckets, the root principal in a bucket owner's Amazon Web Services account can perform the GetBucketPolicy, PutBucketPolicy, and DeleteBucketPolicy API actions, even if their bucket policy explicitly denies the root principal's access. Bucket owner root principals can only be blocked from performing these API actions by VPC endpoint policies and Amazon Web Services Organizations policies.

HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to DeleteBucketPolicy

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "DeleteBucketReplication":{ "name":"DeleteBucketReplication", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?replication", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteBucketReplicationRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Deletes the replication configuration from the bucket.

To use this operation, you must have permissions to perform the s3:PutReplicationConfiguration action. The bucket owner has these permissions by default and can grant it to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources.

It can take a while for the deletion of a replication configuration to fully propagate.

For information about replication configuration, see Replication in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The following operations are related to DeleteBucketReplication:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "DeleteBucketTagging":{ "name":"DeleteBucketTagging", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?tagging", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteBucketTaggingRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Deletes the tags from the bucket.

To use this operation, you must have permission to perform the s3:PutBucketTagging action. By default, the bucket owner has this permission and can grant this permission to others.

The following operations are related to DeleteBucketTagging:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "DeleteBucketWebsite":{ "name":"DeleteBucketWebsite", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?website", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteBucketWebsiteRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

This action removes the website configuration for a bucket. Amazon S3 returns a 200 OK response upon successfully deleting a website configuration on the specified bucket. You will get a 200 OK response if the website configuration you are trying to delete does not exist on the bucket. Amazon S3 returns a 404 response if the bucket specified in the request does not exist.

This DELETE action requires the S3:DeleteBucketWebsite permission. By default, only the bucket owner can delete the website configuration attached to a bucket. However, bucket owners can grant other users permission to delete the website configuration by writing a bucket policy granting them the S3:DeleteBucketWebsite permission.

For more information about hosting websites, see Hosting Websites on Amazon S3.

The following operations are related to DeleteBucketWebsite:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "DeleteObject":{ "name":"DeleteObject", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteObjectRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"DeleteObjectOutput"}, "documentation":"

Removes an object from a bucket. The behavior depends on the bucket's versioning state:

To remove a specific version, you must use the versionId query parameter. Using this query parameter permanently deletes the version. If the object deleted is a delete marker, Amazon S3 sets the response header x-amz-delete-marker to true.

If the object you want to delete is in a bucket where the bucket versioning configuration is MFA Delete enabled, you must include the x-amz-mfa request header in the DELETE versionId request. Requests that include x-amz-mfa must use HTTPS. For more information about MFA Delete, see Using MFA Delete in the Amazon S3 User Guide. To see sample requests that use versioning, see Sample Request.

Directory buckets - MFA delete is not supported by directory buckets.

You can delete objects by explicitly calling DELETE Object or calling (PutBucketLifecycle) to enable Amazon S3 to remove them for you. If you want to block users or accounts from removing or deleting objects from your bucket, you must deny them the s3:DeleteObject, s3:DeleteObjectVersion, and s3:PutLifeCycleConfiguration actions.

Directory buckets - S3 Lifecycle is not supported by directory buckets.

Permissions
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following action is related to DeleteObject:

" }, "DeleteObjectTagging":{ "name":"DeleteObjectTagging", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}?tagging", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteObjectTaggingRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"DeleteObjectTaggingOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Removes the entire tag set from the specified object. For more information about managing object tags, see Object Tagging.

To use this operation, you must have permission to perform the s3:DeleteObjectTagging action.

To delete tags of a specific object version, add the versionId query parameter in the request. You will need permission for the s3:DeleteObjectVersionTagging action.

The following operations are related to DeleteObjectTagging:

" }, "DeleteObjects":{ "name":"DeleteObjects", "http":{ "method":"POST", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?delete" }, "input":{"shape":"DeleteObjectsRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"DeleteObjectsOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation enables you to delete multiple objects from a bucket using a single HTTP request. If you know the object keys that you want to delete, then this operation provides a suitable alternative to sending individual delete requests, reducing per-request overhead.

The request can contain a list of up to 1,000 keys that you want to delete. In the XML, you provide the object key names, and optionally, version IDs if you want to delete a specific version of the object from a versioning-enabled bucket. For each key, Amazon S3 performs a delete operation and returns the result of that delete, success or failure, in the response. If the object specified in the request isn't found, Amazon S3 confirms the deletion by returning the result as deleted.

The operation supports two modes for the response: verbose and quiet. By default, the operation uses verbose mode in which the response includes the result of deletion of each key in your request. In quiet mode the response includes only keys where the delete operation encountered an error. For a successful deletion in a quiet mode, the operation does not return any information about the delete in the response body.

When performing this action on an MFA Delete enabled bucket, that attempts to delete any versioned objects, you must include an MFA token. If you do not provide one, the entire request will fail, even if there are non-versioned objects you are trying to delete. If you provide an invalid token, whether there are versioned keys in the request or not, the entire Multi-Object Delete request will fail. For information about MFA Delete, see MFA Delete in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory buckets - MFA delete is not supported by directory buckets.

Permissions
Content-MD5 request header
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to DeleteObjects:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true } }, "DeletePublicAccessBlock":{ "name":"DeletePublicAccessBlock", "http":{ "method":"DELETE", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?publicAccessBlock", "responseCode":204 }, "input":{"shape":"DeletePublicAccessBlockRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Removes the PublicAccessBlock configuration for an Amazon S3 bucket. To use this operation, you must have the s3:PutBucketPublicAccessBlock permission. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources.

The following operations are related to DeletePublicAccessBlock:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketAccelerateConfiguration":{ "name":"GetBucketAccelerateConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?accelerate" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

This implementation of the GET action uses the accelerate subresource to return the Transfer Acceleration state of a bucket, which is either Enabled or Suspended. Amazon S3 Transfer Acceleration is a bucket-level feature that enables you to perform faster data transfers to and from Amazon S3.

To use this operation, you must have permission to perform the s3:GetAccelerateConfiguration action. The bucket owner has this permission by default. The bucket owner can grant this permission to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to your Amazon S3 Resources in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

You set the Transfer Acceleration state of an existing bucket to Enabled or Suspended by using the PutBucketAccelerateConfiguration operation.

A GET accelerate request does not return a state value for a bucket that has no transfer acceleration state. A bucket has no Transfer Acceleration state if a state has never been set on the bucket.

For more information about transfer acceleration, see Transfer Acceleration in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The following operations are related to GetBucketAccelerateConfiguration:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketAcl":{ "name":"GetBucketAcl", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?acl" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketAclRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketAclOutput"}, "documentation":"

End of support notice: Beginning October 1, 2025, Amazon S3 will stop returning DisplayName. Update your applications to use canonical IDs (unique identifier for Amazon Web Services accounts), Amazon Web Services account ID (12 digit identifier) or IAM ARNs (full resource naming) as a direct replacement of DisplayName.

This change affects the following Amazon Web Services Regions: US East (N. Virginia) Region, US West (N. California) Region, US West (Oregon) Region, Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region, Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region, Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region, Europe (Ireland) Region, and South America (São Paulo) Region.

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

This implementation of the GET action uses the acl subresource to return the access control list (ACL) of a bucket. To use GET to return the ACL of the bucket, you must have the READ_ACP access to the bucket. If READ_ACP permission is granted to the anonymous user, you can return the ACL of the bucket without using an authorization header.

When you use this API operation with an access point, provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name.

When you use this API operation with an Object Lambda access point, provide the alias of the Object Lambda access point in place of the bucket name. If the Object Lambda access point alias in a request is not valid, the error code InvalidAccessPointAliasError is returned. For more information about InvalidAccessPointAliasError, see List of Error Codes.

If your bucket uses the bucket owner enforced setting for S3 Object Ownership, requests to read ACLs are still supported and return the bucket-owner-full-control ACL with the owner being the account that created the bucket. For more information, see Controlling object ownership and disabling ACLs in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The following operations are related to GetBucketAcl:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketAnalyticsConfiguration":{ "name":"GetBucketAnalyticsConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?analytics" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

This implementation of the GET action returns an analytics configuration (identified by the analytics configuration ID) from the bucket.

To use this operation, you must have permissions to perform the s3:GetAnalyticsConfiguration action. The bucket owner has this permission by default. The bucket owner can grant this permission to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

For information about Amazon S3 analytics feature, see Amazon S3 Analytics – Storage Class Analysis in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The following operations are related to GetBucketAnalyticsConfiguration:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketCors":{ "name":"GetBucketCors", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?cors" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketCorsRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketCorsOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns the Cross-Origin Resource Sharing (CORS) configuration information set for the bucket.

To use this operation, you must have permission to perform the s3:GetBucketCORS action. By default, the bucket owner has this permission and can grant it to others.

When you use this API operation with an access point, provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name.

When you use this API operation with an Object Lambda access point, provide the alias of the Object Lambda access point in place of the bucket name. If the Object Lambda access point alias in a request is not valid, the error code InvalidAccessPointAliasError is returned. For more information about InvalidAccessPointAliasError, see List of Error Codes.

For more information about CORS, see Enabling Cross-Origin Resource Sharing.

The following operations are related to GetBucketCors:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketEncryption":{ "name":"GetBucketEncryption", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?encryption" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketEncryptionRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketEncryptionOutput"}, "documentation":"

Returns the default encryption configuration for an Amazon S3 bucket. By default, all buckets have a default encryption configuration that uses server-side encryption with Amazon S3 managed keys (SSE-S3).

Permissions
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to GetBucketEncryption:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketIntelligentTieringConfiguration":{ "name":"GetBucketIntelligentTieringConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?intelligent-tiering" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketIntelligentTieringConfigurationRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketIntelligentTieringConfigurationOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Gets the S3 Intelligent-Tiering configuration from the specified bucket.

The S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class is designed to optimize storage costs by automatically moving data to the most cost-effective storage access tier, without performance impact or operational overhead. S3 Intelligent-Tiering delivers automatic cost savings in three low latency and high throughput access tiers. To get the lowest storage cost on data that can be accessed in minutes to hours, you can choose to activate additional archiving capabilities.

The S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class is the ideal storage class for data with unknown, changing, or unpredictable access patterns, independent of object size or retention period. If the size of an object is less than 128 KB, it is not monitored and not eligible for auto-tiering. Smaller objects can be stored, but they are always charged at the Frequent Access tier rates in the S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class.

For more information, see Storage class for automatically optimizing frequently and infrequently accessed objects.

Operations related to GetBucketIntelligentTieringConfiguration include:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketInventoryConfiguration":{ "name":"GetBucketInventoryConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?inventory" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns an S3 Inventory configuration (identified by the inventory configuration ID) from the bucket.

To use this operation, you must have permissions to perform the s3:GetInventoryConfiguration action. The bucket owner has this permission by default and can grant this permission to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources.

For information about the Amazon S3 inventory feature, see Amazon S3 Inventory.

The following operations are related to GetBucketInventoryConfiguration:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketLifecycle":{ "name":"GetBucketLifecycle", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?lifecycle" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketLifecycleRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketLifecycleOutput"}, "documentation":"

For an updated version of this API, see GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration. If you configured a bucket lifecycle using the filter element, you should see the updated version of this topic. This topic is provided for backward compatibility.

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns the lifecycle configuration information set on the bucket. For information about lifecycle configuration, see Object Lifecycle Management.

To use this operation, you must have permission to perform the s3:GetLifecycleConfiguration action. The bucket owner has this permission by default. The bucket owner can grant this permission to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources.

GetBucketLifecycle has the following special error:

The following operations are related to GetBucketLifecycle:

", "deprecated":true, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration":{ "name":"GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?lifecycle" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput"}, "documentation":"

Returns the lifecycle configuration information set on the bucket. For information about lifecycle configuration, see Object Lifecycle Management.

Bucket lifecycle configuration now supports specifying a lifecycle rule using an object key name prefix, one or more object tags, object size, or any combination of these. Accordingly, this section describes the latest API, which is compatible with the new functionality. The previous version of the API supported filtering based only on an object key name prefix, which is supported for general purpose buckets for backward compatibility. For the related API description, see GetBucketLifecycle.

Lifecyle configurations for directory buckets only support expiring objects and cancelling multipart uploads. Expiring of versioned objects, transitions and tag filters are not supported.

Permissions
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is s3express-control.region.amazonaws.com.

GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration has the following special error:

The following operations are related to GetBucketLifecycleConfiguration:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketLocation":{ "name":"GetBucketLocation", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?location" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketLocationRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketLocationOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns the Region the bucket resides in. You set the bucket's Region using the LocationConstraint request parameter in a CreateBucket request. For more information, see CreateBucket.

When you use this API operation with an access point, provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name.

When you use this API operation with an Object Lambda access point, provide the alias of the Object Lambda access point in place of the bucket name. If the Object Lambda access point alias in a request is not valid, the error code InvalidAccessPointAliasError is returned. For more information about InvalidAccessPointAliasError, see List of Error Codes.

We recommend that you use HeadBucket to return the Region that a bucket resides in. For backward compatibility, Amazon S3 continues to support GetBucketLocation.

The following operations are related to GetBucketLocation:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketLogging":{ "name":"GetBucketLogging", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?logging" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketLoggingRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketLoggingOutput"}, "documentation":"

End of support notice: Beginning October 1, 2025, Amazon S3 will stop returning DisplayName. Update your applications to use canonical IDs (unique identifier for Amazon Web Services accounts), Amazon Web Services account ID (12 digit identifier) or IAM ARNs (full resource naming) as a direct replacement of DisplayName.

This change affects the following Amazon Web Services Regions: US East (N. Virginia) Region, US West (N. California) Region, US West (Oregon) Region, Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region, Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region, Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region, Europe (Ireland) Region, and South America (São Paulo) Region.

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns the logging status of a bucket and the permissions users have to view and modify that status.

The following operations are related to GetBucketLogging:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketMetadataConfiguration":{ "name":"GetBucketMetadataConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?metadataConfiguration" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketMetadataConfigurationRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketMetadataConfigurationOutput"}, "documentation":"

Retrieves the S3 Metadata configuration for a general purpose bucket. For more information, see Accelerating data discovery with S3 Metadata in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

You can use the V2 GetBucketMetadataConfiguration API operation with V1 or V2 metadata configurations. However, if you try to use the V1 GetBucketMetadataTableConfiguration API operation with V2 configurations, you will receive an HTTP 405 Method Not Allowed error.

Permissions

To use this operation, you must have the s3:GetBucketMetadataTableConfiguration permission. For more information, see Setting up permissions for configuring metadata tables in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The IAM policy action name is the same for the V1 and V2 API operations.

The following operations are related to GetBucketMetadataConfiguration:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketMetadataTableConfiguration":{ "name":"GetBucketMetadataTableConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?metadataTable" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketMetadataTableConfigurationRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketMetadataTableConfigurationOutput"}, "documentation":"

We recommend that you retrieve your S3 Metadata configurations by using the V2 GetBucketMetadataTableConfiguration API operation. We no longer recommend using the V1 GetBucketMetadataTableConfiguration API operation.

If you created your S3 Metadata configuration before July 15, 2025, we recommend that you delete and re-create your configuration by using CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration so that you can expire journal table records and create a live inventory table.

Retrieves the V1 S3 Metadata configuration for a general purpose bucket. For more information, see Accelerating data discovery with S3 Metadata in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

You can use the V2 GetBucketMetadataConfiguration API operation with V1 or V2 metadata table configurations. However, if you try to use the V1 GetBucketMetadataTableConfiguration API operation with V2 configurations, you will receive an HTTP 405 Method Not Allowed error.

Make sure that you update your processes to use the new V2 API operations (CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration, GetBucketMetadataConfiguration, and DeleteBucketMetadataConfiguration) instead of the V1 API operations.

Permissions

To use this operation, you must have the s3:GetBucketMetadataTableConfiguration permission. For more information, see Setting up permissions for configuring metadata tables in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The following operations are related to GetBucketMetadataTableConfiguration:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketMetricsConfiguration":{ "name":"GetBucketMetricsConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?metrics" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Gets a metrics configuration (specified by the metrics configuration ID) from the bucket. Note that this doesn't include the daily storage metrics.

To use this operation, you must have permissions to perform the s3:GetMetricsConfiguration action. The bucket owner has this permission by default. The bucket owner can grant this permission to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources.

For information about CloudWatch request metrics for Amazon S3, see Monitoring Metrics with Amazon CloudWatch.

The following operations are related to GetBucketMetricsConfiguration:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketNotification":{ "name":"GetBucketNotification", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?notification" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"NotificationConfigurationDeprecated"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

No longer used, see GetBucketNotificationConfiguration.

", "deprecated":true, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketNotificationConfiguration":{ "name":"GetBucketNotificationConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?notification" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"NotificationConfiguration"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns the notification configuration of a bucket.

If notifications are not enabled on the bucket, the action returns an empty NotificationConfiguration element.

By default, you must be the bucket owner to read the notification configuration of a bucket. However, the bucket owner can use a bucket policy to grant permission to other users to read this configuration with the s3:GetBucketNotification permission.

When you use this API operation with an access point, provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name.

When you use this API operation with an Object Lambda access point, provide the alias of the Object Lambda access point in place of the bucket name. If the Object Lambda access point alias in a request is not valid, the error code InvalidAccessPointAliasError is returned. For more information about InvalidAccessPointAliasError, see List of Error Codes.

For more information about setting and reading the notification configuration on a bucket, see Setting Up Notification of Bucket Events. For more information about bucket policies, see Using Bucket Policies.

The following action is related to GetBucketNotification:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketOwnershipControls":{ "name":"GetBucketOwnershipControls", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?ownershipControls" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketOwnershipControlsRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketOwnershipControlsOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Retrieves OwnershipControls for an Amazon S3 bucket. To use this operation, you must have the s3:GetBucketOwnershipControls permission. For more information about Amazon S3 permissions, see Specifying permissions in a policy.

A bucket doesn't have OwnershipControls settings in the following cases:

By default, Amazon S3 sets OwnershipControls for all newly created buckets.

For information about Amazon S3 Object Ownership, see Using Object Ownership.

The following operations are related to GetBucketOwnershipControls:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketPolicy":{ "name":"GetBucketPolicy", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?policy" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketPolicyRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketPolicyOutput"}, "documentation":"

Returns the policy of a specified bucket.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, you must make requests for this API operation to the Regional endpoint. These endpoints support path-style requests in the format https://s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com/bucket-name . Virtual-hosted-style requests aren't supported. For more information about endpoints in Availability Zones, see Regional and Zonal endpoints for directory buckets in Availability Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about endpoints in Local Zones, see Concepts for directory buckets in Local Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions

If you are using an identity other than the root user of the Amazon Web Services account that owns the bucket, the calling identity must both have the GetBucketPolicy permissions on the specified bucket and belong to the bucket owner's account in order to use this operation.

If you don't have GetBucketPolicy permissions, Amazon S3 returns a 403 Access Denied error. If you have the correct permissions, but you're not using an identity that belongs to the bucket owner's account, Amazon S3 returns a 405 Method Not Allowed error.

To ensure that bucket owners don't inadvertently lock themselves out of their own buckets, the root principal in a bucket owner's Amazon Web Services account can perform the GetBucketPolicy, PutBucketPolicy, and DeleteBucketPolicy API actions, even if their bucket policy explicitly denies the root principal's access. Bucket owner root principals can only be blocked from performing these API actions by VPC endpoint policies and Amazon Web Services Organizations policies.

Example bucket policies

General purpose buckets example bucket policies - See Bucket policy examples in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory bucket example bucket policies - See Example bucket policies for S3 Express One Zone in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following action is related to GetBucketPolicy:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketPolicyStatus":{ "name":"GetBucketPolicyStatus", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?policyStatus" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketPolicyStatusRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketPolicyStatusOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Retrieves the policy status for an Amazon S3 bucket, indicating whether the bucket is public. In order to use this operation, you must have the s3:GetBucketPolicyStatus permission. For more information about Amazon S3 permissions, see Specifying Permissions in a Policy.

For more information about when Amazon S3 considers a bucket public, see The Meaning of \"Public\".

The following operations are related to GetBucketPolicyStatus:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketReplication":{ "name":"GetBucketReplication", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?replication" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketReplicationRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketReplicationOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns the replication configuration of a bucket.

It can take a while to propagate the put or delete a replication configuration to all Amazon S3 systems. Therefore, a get request soon after put or delete can return a wrong result.

For information about replication configuration, see Replication in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This action requires permissions for the s3:GetReplicationConfiguration action. For more information about permissions, see Using Bucket Policies and User Policies.

If you include the Filter element in a replication configuration, you must also include the DeleteMarkerReplication and Priority elements. The response also returns those elements.

For information about GetBucketReplication errors, see List of replication-related error codes

The following operations are related to GetBucketReplication:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketRequestPayment":{ "name":"GetBucketRequestPayment", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?requestPayment" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketRequestPaymentRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketRequestPaymentOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns the request payment configuration of a bucket. To use this version of the operation, you must be the bucket owner. For more information, see Requester Pays Buckets.

The following operations are related to GetBucketRequestPayment:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketTagging":{ "name":"GetBucketTagging", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?tagging" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketTaggingRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketTaggingOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns the tag set associated with the bucket.

To use this operation, you must have permission to perform the s3:GetBucketTagging action. By default, the bucket owner has this permission and can grant this permission to others.

GetBucketTagging has the following special error:

The following operations are related to GetBucketTagging:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketVersioning":{ "name":"GetBucketVersioning", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?versioning" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketVersioningRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketVersioningOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns the versioning state of a bucket.

To retrieve the versioning state of a bucket, you must be the bucket owner.

This implementation also returns the MFA Delete status of the versioning state. If the MFA Delete status is enabled, the bucket owner must use an authentication device to change the versioning state of the bucket.

The following operations are related to GetBucketVersioning:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetBucketWebsite":{ "name":"GetBucketWebsite", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?website" }, "input":{"shape":"GetBucketWebsiteRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetBucketWebsiteOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns the website configuration for a bucket. To host website on Amazon S3, you can configure a bucket as website by adding a website configuration. For more information about hosting websites, see Hosting Websites on Amazon S3.

This GET action requires the S3:GetBucketWebsite permission. By default, only the bucket owner can read the bucket website configuration. However, bucket owners can allow other users to read the website configuration by writing a bucket policy granting them the S3:GetBucketWebsite permission.

The following operations are related to GetBucketWebsite:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "GetObject":{ "name":"GetObject", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}" }, "input":{"shape":"GetObjectRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetObjectOutput"}, "errors":[ {"shape":"NoSuchKey"}, {"shape":"InvalidObjectState"} ], "documentation":"

Retrieves an object from Amazon S3.

In the GetObject request, specify the full key name for the object.

General purpose buckets - Both the virtual-hosted-style requests and the path-style requests are supported. For a virtual hosted-style request example, if you have the object photos/2006/February/sample.jpg, specify the object key name as /photos/2006/February/sample.jpg. For a path-style request example, if you have the object photos/2006/February/sample.jpg in the bucket named examplebucket, specify the object key name as /examplebucket/photos/2006/February/sample.jpg. For more information about request types, see HTTP Host Header Bucket Specification in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory buckets - Only virtual-hosted-style requests are supported. For a virtual hosted-style request example, if you have the object photos/2006/February/sample.jpg in the bucket named amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3, specify the object key name as /photos/2006/February/sample.jpg. Also, when you make requests to this API operation, your requests are sent to the Zonal endpoint. These endpoints support virtual-hosted-style requests in the format https://bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com/key-name . Path-style requests are not supported. For more information about endpoints in Availability Zones, see Regional and Zonal endpoints for directory buckets in Availability Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about endpoints in Local Zones, see Concepts for directory buckets in Local Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions
Storage classes

If the object you are retrieving is stored in the S3 Glacier Flexible Retrieval storage class, the S3 Glacier Deep Archive storage class, the S3 Intelligent-Tiering Archive Access tier, or the S3 Intelligent-Tiering Deep Archive Access tier, before you can retrieve the object you must first restore a copy using RestoreObject. Otherwise, this operation returns an InvalidObjectState error. For information about restoring archived objects, see Restoring Archived Objects in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory buckets - Directory buckets only support EXPRESS_ONEZONE (the S3 Express One Zone storage class) in Availability Zones and ONEZONE_IA (the S3 One Zone-Infrequent Access storage class) in Dedicated Local Zones. Unsupported storage class values won't write a destination object and will respond with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request.

Encryption

Encryption request headers, like x-amz-server-side-encryption, should not be sent for the GetObject requests, if your object uses server-side encryption with Amazon S3 managed encryption keys (SSE-S3), server-side encryption with Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS), or dual-layer server-side encryption with Amazon Web Services KMS keys (DSSE-KMS). If you include the header in your GetObject requests for the object that uses these types of keys, you’ll get an HTTP 400 Bad Request error.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, there are only two supported options for server-side encryption: SSE-S3 and SSE-KMS. SSE-C isn't supported. For more information, see Protecting data with server-side encryption in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Overriding response header values through the request

There are times when you want to override certain response header values of a GetObject response. For example, you might override the Content-Disposition response header value through your GetObject request.

You can override values for a set of response headers. These modified response header values are included only in a successful response, that is, when the HTTP status code 200 OK is returned. The headers you can override using the following query parameters in the request are a subset of the headers that Amazon S3 accepts when you create an object.

The response headers that you can override for the GetObject response are Cache-Control, Content-Disposition, Content-Encoding, Content-Language, Content-Type, and Expires.

To override values for a set of response headers in the GetObject response, you can use the following query parameters in the request.

When you use these parameters, you must sign the request by using either an Authorization header or a presigned URL. These parameters cannot be used with an unsigned (anonymous) request.

HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to GetObject:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestValidationModeMember":"ChecksumMode", "responseAlgorithms":[ "CRC64NVME", "CRC32", "CRC32C", "SHA256", "SHA1" ] } }, "GetObjectAcl":{ "name":"GetObjectAcl", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}?acl" }, "input":{"shape":"GetObjectAclRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetObjectAclOutput"}, "errors":[ {"shape":"NoSuchKey"} ], "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns the access control list (ACL) of an object. To use this operation, you must have s3:GetObjectAcl permissions or READ_ACP access to the object. For more information, see Mapping of ACL permissions and access policy permissions in the Amazon S3 User Guide

This functionality is not supported for Amazon S3 on Outposts.

By default, GET returns ACL information about the current version of an object. To return ACL information about a different version, use the versionId subresource.

If your bucket uses the bucket owner enforced setting for S3 Object Ownership, requests to read ACLs are still supported and return the bucket-owner-full-control ACL with the owner being the account that created the bucket. For more information, see Controlling object ownership and disabling ACLs in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The following operations are related to GetObjectAcl:

" }, "GetObjectAttributes":{ "name":"GetObjectAttributes", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}?attributes" }, "input":{"shape":"GetObjectAttributesRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetObjectAttributesOutput"}, "errors":[ {"shape":"NoSuchKey"} ], "documentation":"

Retrieves all of the metadata from an object without returning the object itself. This operation is useful if you're interested only in an object's metadata.

GetObjectAttributes combines the functionality of HeadObject and ListParts. All of the data returned with both of those individual calls can be returned with a single call to GetObjectAttributes.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, you must make requests for this API operation to the Zonal endpoint. These endpoints support virtual-hosted-style requests in the format https://amzn-s3-demo-bucket.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com/key-name . Path-style requests are not supported. For more information about endpoints in Availability Zones, see Regional and Zonal endpoints for directory buckets in Availability Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about endpoints in Local Zones, see Concepts for directory buckets in Local Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions
Encryption

Encryption request headers, like x-amz-server-side-encryption, should not be sent for HEAD requests if your object uses server-side encryption with Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS), dual-layer server-side encryption with Amazon Web Services KMS keys (DSSE-KMS), or server-side encryption with Amazon S3 managed encryption keys (SSE-S3). The x-amz-server-side-encryption header is used when you PUT an object to S3 and want to specify the encryption method. If you include this header in a GET request for an object that uses these types of keys, you’ll get an HTTP 400 Bad Request error. It's because the encryption method can't be changed when you retrieve the object.

If you encrypted an object when you stored the object in Amazon S3 by using server-side encryption with customer-provided encryption keys (SSE-C), then when you retrieve the metadata from the object, you must use the following headers. These headers provide the server with the encryption key required to retrieve the object's metadata. The headers are:

For more information about SSE-C, see Server-Side Encryption (Using Customer-Provided Encryption Keys) in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory bucket permissions - For directory buckets, there are only two supported options for server-side encryption: server-side encryption with Amazon S3 managed keys (SSE-S3) (AES256) and server-side encryption with KMS keys (SSE-KMS) (aws:kms). We recommend that the bucket's default encryption uses the desired encryption configuration and you don't override the bucket default encryption in your CreateSession requests or PUT object requests. Then, new objects are automatically encrypted with the desired encryption settings. For more information, see Protecting data with server-side encryption in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about the encryption overriding behaviors in directory buckets, see Specifying server-side encryption with KMS for new object uploads.

Versioning

Directory buckets - S3 Versioning isn't enabled and supported for directory buckets. For this API operation, only the null value of the version ID is supported by directory buckets. You can only specify null to the versionId query parameter in the request.

Conditional request headers

Consider the following when using request headers:

HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following actions are related to GetObjectAttributes:

" }, "GetObjectLegalHold":{ "name":"GetObjectLegalHold", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}?legal-hold" }, "input":{"shape":"GetObjectLegalHoldRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetObjectLegalHoldOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Gets an object's current legal hold status. For more information, see Locking Objects.

This functionality is not supported for Amazon S3 on Outposts.

The following action is related to GetObjectLegalHold:

" }, "GetObjectLockConfiguration":{ "name":"GetObjectLockConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?object-lock" }, "input":{"shape":"GetObjectLockConfigurationRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetObjectLockConfigurationOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Gets the Object Lock configuration for a bucket. The rule specified in the Object Lock configuration will be applied by default to every new object placed in the specified bucket. For more information, see Locking Objects.

The following action is related to GetObjectLockConfiguration:

" }, "GetObjectRetention":{ "name":"GetObjectRetention", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}?retention" }, "input":{"shape":"GetObjectRetentionRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetObjectRetentionOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Retrieves an object's retention settings. For more information, see Locking Objects.

This functionality is not supported for Amazon S3 on Outposts.

The following action is related to GetObjectRetention:

" }, "GetObjectTagging":{ "name":"GetObjectTagging", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}?tagging" }, "input":{"shape":"GetObjectTaggingRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetObjectTaggingOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns the tag-set of an object. You send the GET request against the tagging subresource associated with the object.

To use this operation, you must have permission to perform the s3:GetObjectTagging action. By default, the GET action returns information about current version of an object. For a versioned bucket, you can have multiple versions of an object in your bucket. To retrieve tags of any other version, use the versionId query parameter. You also need permission for the s3:GetObjectVersionTagging action.

By default, the bucket owner has this permission and can grant this permission to others.

For information about the Amazon S3 object tagging feature, see Object Tagging.

The following actions are related to GetObjectTagging:

" }, "GetObjectTorrent":{ "name":"GetObjectTorrent", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}?torrent" }, "input":{"shape":"GetObjectTorrentRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetObjectTorrentOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns torrent files from a bucket. BitTorrent can save you bandwidth when you're distributing large files.

You can get torrent only for objects that are less than 5 GB in size, and that are not encrypted using server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key.

To use GET, you must have READ access to the object.

This functionality is not supported for Amazon S3 on Outposts.

The following action is related to GetObjectTorrent:

" }, "GetPublicAccessBlock":{ "name":"GetPublicAccessBlock", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?publicAccessBlock" }, "input":{"shape":"GetPublicAccessBlockRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"GetPublicAccessBlockOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Retrieves the PublicAccessBlock configuration for an Amazon S3 bucket. To use this operation, you must have the s3:GetBucketPublicAccessBlock permission. For more information about Amazon S3 permissions, see Specifying Permissions in a Policy.

When Amazon S3 evaluates the PublicAccessBlock configuration for a bucket or an object, it checks the PublicAccessBlock configuration for both the bucket (or the bucket that contains the object) and the bucket owner's account. If the PublicAccessBlock settings are different between the bucket and the account, Amazon S3 uses the most restrictive combination of the bucket-level and account-level settings.

For more information about when Amazon S3 considers a bucket or an object public, see The Meaning of \"Public\".

The following operations are related to GetPublicAccessBlock:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "HeadBucket":{ "name":"HeadBucket", "http":{ "method":"HEAD", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}" }, "input":{"shape":"HeadBucketRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"HeadBucketOutput"}, "errors":[ {"shape":"NoSuchBucket"} ], "documentation":"

You can use this operation to determine if a bucket exists and if you have permission to access it. The action returns a 200 OK if the bucket exists and you have permission to access it.

If the bucket does not exist or you do not have permission to access it, the HEAD request returns a generic 400 Bad Request, 403 Forbidden or 404 Not Found code. A message body is not included, so you cannot determine the exception beyond these HTTP response codes.

Authentication and authorization

General purpose buckets - Request to public buckets that grant the s3:ListBucket permission publicly do not need to be signed. All other HeadBucket requests must be authenticated and signed by using IAM credentials (access key ID and secret access key for the IAM identities). All headers with the x-amz- prefix, including x-amz-copy-source, must be signed. For more information, see REST Authentication.

Directory buckets - You must use IAM credentials to authenticate and authorize your access to the HeadBucket API operation, instead of using the temporary security credentials through the CreateSession API operation.

Amazon Web Services CLI or SDKs handles authentication and authorization on your behalf.

Permissions

HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

You must make requests for this API operation to the Zonal endpoint. These endpoints support virtual-hosted-style requests in the format https://bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. For more information about endpoints in Availability Zones, see Regional and Zonal endpoints for directory buckets in Availability Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about endpoints in Local Zones, see Concepts for directory buckets in Local Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "HeadObject":{ "name":"HeadObject", "http":{ "method":"HEAD", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}" }, "input":{"shape":"HeadObjectRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"HeadObjectOutput"}, "errors":[ {"shape":"NoSuchKey"} ], "documentation":"

The HEAD operation retrieves metadata from an object without returning the object itself. This operation is useful if you're interested only in an object's metadata.

A HEAD request has the same options as a GET operation on an object. The response is identical to the GET response except that there is no response body. Because of this, if the HEAD request generates an error, it returns a generic code, such as 400 Bad Request, 403 Forbidden, 404 Not Found, 405 Method Not Allowed, 412 Precondition Failed, or 304 Not Modified. It's not possible to retrieve the exact exception of these error codes.

Request headers are limited to 8 KB in size. For more information, see Common Request Headers.

Permissions

Encryption

Encryption request headers, like x-amz-server-side-encryption, should not be sent for HEAD requests if your object uses server-side encryption with Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS), dual-layer server-side encryption with Amazon Web Services KMS keys (DSSE-KMS), or server-side encryption with Amazon S3 managed encryption keys (SSE-S3). The x-amz-server-side-encryption header is used when you PUT an object to S3 and want to specify the encryption method. If you include this header in a HEAD request for an object that uses these types of keys, you’ll get an HTTP 400 Bad Request error. It's because the encryption method can't be changed when you retrieve the object.

If you encrypt an object by using server-side encryption with customer-provided encryption keys (SSE-C) when you store the object in Amazon S3, then when you retrieve the metadata from the object, you must use the following headers to provide the encryption key for the server to be able to retrieve the object's metadata. The headers are:

For more information about SSE-C, see Server-Side Encryption (Using Customer-Provided Encryption Keys) in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory bucket - For directory buckets, there are only two supported options for server-side encryption: SSE-S3 and SSE-KMS. SSE-C isn't supported. For more information, see Protecting data with server-side encryption in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Versioning
  • Directory buckets - Delete marker is not supported for directory buckets.

  • Directory buckets - S3 Versioning isn't enabled and supported for directory buckets. For this API operation, only the null value of the version ID is supported by directory buckets. You can only specify null to the versionId query parameter in the request.

HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

For directory buckets, you must make requests for this API operation to the Zonal endpoint. These endpoints support virtual-hosted-style requests in the format https://amzn-s3-demo-bucket.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com/key-name . Path-style requests are not supported. For more information about endpoints in Availability Zones, see Regional and Zonal endpoints for directory buckets in Availability Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about endpoints in Local Zones, see Concepts for directory buckets in Local Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The following actions are related to HeadObject:

" }, "ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurations":{ "name":"ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurations", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?analytics" }, "input":{"shape":"ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Lists the analytics configurations for the bucket. You can have up to 1,000 analytics configurations per bucket.

This action supports list pagination and does not return more than 100 configurations at a time. You should always check the IsTruncated element in the response. If there are no more configurations to list, IsTruncated is set to false. If there are more configurations to list, IsTruncated is set to true, and there will be a value in NextContinuationToken. You use the NextContinuationToken value to continue the pagination of the list by passing the value in continuation-token in the request to GET the next page.

To use this operation, you must have permissions to perform the s3:GetAnalyticsConfiguration action. The bucket owner has this permission by default. The bucket owner can grant this permission to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources.

For information about Amazon S3 analytics feature, see Amazon S3 Analytics – Storage Class Analysis.

The following operations are related to ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurations:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "ListBucketIntelligentTieringConfigurations":{ "name":"ListBucketIntelligentTieringConfigurations", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?intelligent-tiering" }, "input":{"shape":"ListBucketIntelligentTieringConfigurationsRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"ListBucketIntelligentTieringConfigurationsOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Lists the S3 Intelligent-Tiering configuration from the specified bucket.

The S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class is designed to optimize storage costs by automatically moving data to the most cost-effective storage access tier, without performance impact or operational overhead. S3 Intelligent-Tiering delivers automatic cost savings in three low latency and high throughput access tiers. To get the lowest storage cost on data that can be accessed in minutes to hours, you can choose to activate additional archiving capabilities.

The S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class is the ideal storage class for data with unknown, changing, or unpredictable access patterns, independent of object size or retention period. If the size of an object is less than 128 KB, it is not monitored and not eligible for auto-tiering. Smaller objects can be stored, but they are always charged at the Frequent Access tier rates in the S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class.

For more information, see Storage class for automatically optimizing frequently and infrequently accessed objects.

Operations related to ListBucketIntelligentTieringConfigurations include:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "ListBucketInventoryConfigurations":{ "name":"ListBucketInventoryConfigurations", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?inventory" }, "input":{"shape":"ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns a list of S3 Inventory configurations for the bucket. You can have up to 1,000 analytics configurations per bucket.

This action supports list pagination and does not return more than 100 configurations at a time. Always check the IsTruncated element in the response. If there are no more configurations to list, IsTruncated is set to false. If there are more configurations to list, IsTruncated is set to true, and there is a value in NextContinuationToken. You use the NextContinuationToken value to continue the pagination of the list by passing the value in continuation-token in the request to GET the next page.

To use this operation, you must have permissions to perform the s3:GetInventoryConfiguration action. The bucket owner has this permission by default. The bucket owner can grant this permission to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources.

For information about the Amazon S3 inventory feature, see Amazon S3 Inventory

The following operations are related to ListBucketInventoryConfigurations:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "ListBucketMetricsConfigurations":{ "name":"ListBucketMetricsConfigurations", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?metrics" }, "input":{"shape":"ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Lists the metrics configurations for the bucket. The metrics configurations are only for the request metrics of the bucket and do not provide information on daily storage metrics. You can have up to 1,000 configurations per bucket.

This action supports list pagination and does not return more than 100 configurations at a time. Always check the IsTruncated element in the response. If there are no more configurations to list, IsTruncated is set to false. If there are more configurations to list, IsTruncated is set to true, and there is a value in NextContinuationToken. You use the NextContinuationToken value to continue the pagination of the list by passing the value in continuation-token in the request to GET the next page.

To use this operation, you must have permissions to perform the s3:GetMetricsConfiguration action. The bucket owner has this permission by default. The bucket owner can grant this permission to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources.

For more information about metrics configurations and CloudWatch request metrics, see Monitoring Metrics with Amazon CloudWatch.

The following operations are related to ListBucketMetricsConfigurations:

" }, "ListBuckets":{ "name":"ListBuckets", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/" }, "input":{"shape":"ListBucketsRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"ListBucketsOutput"}, "documentation":"

End of support notice: Beginning October 1, 2025, Amazon S3 will stop returning DisplayName. Update your applications to use canonical IDs (unique identifier for Amazon Web Services accounts), Amazon Web Services account ID (12 digit identifier) or IAM ARNs (full resource naming) as a direct replacement of DisplayName.

This change affects the following Amazon Web Services Regions: US East (N. Virginia) Region, US West (N. California) Region, US West (Oregon) Region, Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region, Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region, Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region, Europe (Ireland) Region, and South America (São Paulo) Region.

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns a list of all buckets owned by the authenticated sender of the request. To grant IAM permission to use this operation, you must add the s3:ListAllMyBuckets policy action.

For information about Amazon S3 buckets, see Creating, configuring, and working with Amazon S3 buckets.

We strongly recommend using only paginated ListBuckets requests. Unpaginated ListBuckets requests are only supported for Amazon Web Services accounts set to the default general purpose bucket quota of 10,000. If you have an approved general purpose bucket quota above 10,000, you must send paginated ListBuckets requests to list your account’s buckets. All unpaginated ListBuckets requests will be rejected for Amazon Web Services accounts with a general purpose bucket quota greater than 10,000.

" }, "ListDirectoryBuckets":{ "name":"ListDirectoryBuckets", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/" }, "input":{"shape":"ListDirectoryBucketsRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"ListDirectoryBucketsOutput"}, "documentation":"

Returns a list of all Amazon S3 directory buckets owned by the authenticated sender of the request. For more information about directory buckets, see Directory buckets in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, you must make requests for this API operation to the Regional endpoint. These endpoints support path-style requests in the format https://s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com/bucket-name . Virtual-hosted-style requests aren't supported. For more information about endpoints in Availability Zones, see Regional and Zonal endpoints for directory buckets in Availability Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about endpoints in Local Zones, see Concepts for directory buckets in Local Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions

You must have the s3express:ListAllMyDirectoryBuckets permission in an IAM identity-based policy instead of a bucket policy. Cross-account access to this API operation isn't supported. This operation can only be performed by the Amazon Web Services account that owns the resource. For more information about directory bucket policies and permissions, see Amazon Web Services Identity and Access Management (IAM) for S3 Express One Zone in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is s3express-control.region.amazonaws.com.

The BucketRegion response element is not part of the ListDirectoryBuckets Response Syntax.

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "ListMultipartUploads":{ "name":"ListMultipartUploads", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?uploads" }, "input":{"shape":"ListMultipartUploadsRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"ListMultipartUploadsOutput"}, "documentation":"

End of support notice: Beginning October 1, 2025, Amazon S3 will stop returning DisplayName. Update your applications to use canonical IDs (unique identifier for Amazon Web Services accounts), Amazon Web Services account ID (12 digit identifier) or IAM ARNs (full resource naming) as a direct replacement of DisplayName.

This change affects the following Amazon Web Services Regions: US East (N. Virginia) Region, US West (N. California) Region, US West (Oregon) Region, Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region, Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region, Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region, Europe (Ireland) Region, and South America (São Paulo) Region.

This operation lists in-progress multipart uploads in a bucket. An in-progress multipart upload is a multipart upload that has been initiated by the CreateMultipartUpload request, but has not yet been completed or aborted.

Directory buckets - If multipart uploads in a directory bucket are in progress, you can't delete the bucket until all the in-progress multipart uploads are aborted or completed. To delete these in-progress multipart uploads, use the ListMultipartUploads operation to list the in-progress multipart uploads in the bucket and use the AbortMultipartUpload operation to abort all the in-progress multipart uploads.

The ListMultipartUploads operation returns a maximum of 1,000 multipart uploads in the response. The limit of 1,000 multipart uploads is also the default value. You can further limit the number of uploads in a response by specifying the max-uploads request parameter. If there are more than 1,000 multipart uploads that satisfy your ListMultipartUploads request, the response returns an IsTruncated element with the value of true, a NextKeyMarker element, and a NextUploadIdMarker element. To list the remaining multipart uploads, you need to make subsequent ListMultipartUploads requests. In these requests, include two query parameters: key-marker and upload-id-marker. Set the value of key-marker to the NextKeyMarker value from the previous response. Similarly, set the value of upload-id-marker to the NextUploadIdMarker value from the previous response.

Directory buckets - The upload-id-marker element and the NextUploadIdMarker element aren't supported by directory buckets. To list the additional multipart uploads, you only need to set the value of key-marker to the NextKeyMarker value from the previous response.

For more information about multipart uploads, see Uploading Objects Using Multipart Upload in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, you must make requests for this API operation to the Zonal endpoint. These endpoints support virtual-hosted-style requests in the format https://amzn-s3-demo-bucket.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com/key-name . Path-style requests are not supported. For more information about endpoints in Availability Zones, see Regional and Zonal endpoints for directory buckets in Availability Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about endpoints in Local Zones, see Concepts for directory buckets in Local Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions
Sorting of multipart uploads in response
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to ListMultipartUploads:

" }, "ListObjectVersions":{ "name":"ListObjectVersions", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?versions" }, "input":{"shape":"ListObjectVersionsRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"ListObjectVersionsOutput"}, "documentation":"

End of support notice: Beginning October 1, 2025, Amazon S3 will stop returning DisplayName. Update your applications to use canonical IDs (unique identifier for Amazon Web Services accounts), Amazon Web Services account ID (12 digit identifier) or IAM ARNs (full resource naming) as a direct replacement of DisplayName.

This change affects the following Amazon Web Services Regions: US East (N. Virginia) Region, US West (N. California) Region, US West (Oregon) Region, Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region, Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region, Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region, Europe (Ireland) Region, and South America (São Paulo) Region.

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns metadata about all versions of the objects in a bucket. You can also use request parameters as selection criteria to return metadata about a subset of all the object versions.

To use this operation, you must have permission to perform the s3:ListBucketVersions action. Be aware of the name difference.

A 200 OK response can contain valid or invalid XML. Make sure to design your application to parse the contents of the response and handle it appropriately.

To use this operation, you must have READ access to the bucket.

The following operations are related to ListObjectVersions:

" }, "ListObjects":{ "name":"ListObjects", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}" }, "input":{"shape":"ListObjectsRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"ListObjectsOutput"}, "errors":[ {"shape":"NoSuchBucket"} ], "documentation":"

End of support notice: Beginning October 1, 2025, Amazon S3 will stop returning DisplayName. Update your applications to use canonical IDs (unique identifier for Amazon Web Services accounts), Amazon Web Services account ID (12 digit identifier) or IAM ARNs (full resource naming) as a direct replacement of DisplayName.

This change affects the following Amazon Web Services Regions: US East (N. Virginia) Region, US West (N. California) Region, US West (Oregon) Region, Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region, Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region, Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region, Europe (Ireland) Region, and South America (São Paulo) Region.

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Returns some or all (up to 1,000) of the objects in a bucket. You can use the request parameters as selection criteria to return a subset of the objects in a bucket. A 200 OK response can contain valid or invalid XML. Be sure to design your application to parse the contents of the response and handle it appropriately.

This action has been revised. We recommend that you use the newer version, ListObjectsV2, when developing applications. For backward compatibility, Amazon S3 continues to support ListObjects.

The following operations are related to ListObjects:

" }, "ListObjectsV2":{ "name":"ListObjectsV2", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?list-type=2" }, "input":{"shape":"ListObjectsV2Request"}, "output":{"shape":"ListObjectsV2Output"}, "errors":[ {"shape":"NoSuchBucket"} ], "documentation":"

Returns some or all (up to 1,000) of the objects in a bucket with each request. You can use the request parameters as selection criteria to return a subset of the objects in a bucket. A 200 OK response can contain valid or invalid XML. Make sure to design your application to parse the contents of the response and handle it appropriately. For more information about listing objects, see Listing object keys programmatically in the Amazon S3 User Guide. To get a list of your buckets, see ListBuckets.

Permissions
Sorting order of returned objects
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

This section describes the latest revision of this action. We recommend that you use this revised API operation for application development. For backward compatibility, Amazon S3 continues to support the prior version of this API operation, ListObjects.

The following operations are related to ListObjectsV2:

" }, "ListParts":{ "name":"ListParts", "http":{ "method":"GET", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}" }, "input":{"shape":"ListPartsRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"ListPartsOutput"}, "documentation":"

End of support notice: Beginning October 1, 2025, Amazon S3 will stop returning DisplayName. Update your applications to use canonical IDs (unique identifier for Amazon Web Services accounts), Amazon Web Services account ID (12 digit identifier) or IAM ARNs (full resource naming) as a direct replacement of DisplayName.

This change affects the following Amazon Web Services Regions: US East (N. Virginia) Region, US West (N. California) Region, US West (Oregon) Region, Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region, Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region, Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region, Europe (Ireland) Region, and South America (São Paulo) Region.

Lists the parts that have been uploaded for a specific multipart upload.

To use this operation, you must provide the upload ID in the request. You obtain this uploadID by sending the initiate multipart upload request through CreateMultipartUpload.

The ListParts request returns a maximum of 1,000 uploaded parts. The limit of 1,000 parts is also the default value. You can restrict the number of parts in a response by specifying the max-parts request parameter. If your multipart upload consists of more than 1,000 parts, the response returns an IsTruncated field with the value of true, and a NextPartNumberMarker element. To list remaining uploaded parts, in subsequent ListParts requests, include the part-number-marker query string parameter and set its value to the NextPartNumberMarker field value from the previous response.

For more information on multipart uploads, see Uploading Objects Using Multipart Upload in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, you must make requests for this API operation to the Zonal endpoint. These endpoints support virtual-hosted-style requests in the format https://amzn-s3-demo-bucket.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com/key-name . Path-style requests are not supported. For more information about endpoints in Availability Zones, see Regional and Zonal endpoints for directory buckets in Availability Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about endpoints in Local Zones, see Concepts for directory buckets in Local Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to ListParts:

" }, "PutBucketAccelerateConfiguration":{ "name":"PutBucketAccelerateConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?accelerate" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Sets the accelerate configuration of an existing bucket. Amazon S3 Transfer Acceleration is a bucket-level feature that enables you to perform faster data transfers to Amazon S3.

To use this operation, you must have permission to perform the s3:PutAccelerateConfiguration action. The bucket owner has this permission by default. The bucket owner can grant this permission to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources.

The Transfer Acceleration state of a bucket can be set to one of the following two values:

The GetBucketAccelerateConfiguration action returns the transfer acceleration state of a bucket.

After setting the Transfer Acceleration state of a bucket to Enabled, it might take up to thirty minutes before the data transfer rates to the bucket increase.

The name of the bucket used for Transfer Acceleration must be DNS-compliant and must not contain periods (\".\").

For more information about transfer acceleration, see Transfer Acceleration.

The following operations are related to PutBucketAccelerateConfiguration:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":false }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketAcl":{ "name":"PutBucketAcl", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?acl" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketAclRequest"}, "documentation":"

End of support notice: Beginning October 1, 2025, Amazon S3 will discontinue support for creating new Email Grantee Access Control Lists (ACL). Email Grantee ACLs created prior to this date will continue to work and remain accessible through the Amazon Web Services Management Console, Command Line Interface (CLI), SDKs, and REST API. However, you will no longer be able to create new Email Grantee ACLs.

This change affects the following Amazon Web Services Regions: US East (N. Virginia) Region, US West (N. California) Region, US West (Oregon) Region, Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region, Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region, Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region, Europe (Ireland) Region, and South America (São Paulo) Region.

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Sets the permissions on an existing bucket using access control lists (ACL). For more information, see Using ACLs. To set the ACL of a bucket, you must have the WRITE_ACP permission.

You can use one of the following two ways to set a bucket's permissions:

You cannot specify access permission using both the body and the request headers.

Depending on your application needs, you may choose to set the ACL on a bucket using either the request body or the headers. For example, if you have an existing application that updates a bucket ACL using the request body, then you can continue to use that approach.

If your bucket uses the bucket owner enforced setting for S3 Object Ownership, ACLs are disabled and no longer affect permissions. You must use policies to grant access to your bucket and the objects in it. Requests to set ACLs or update ACLs fail and return the AccessControlListNotSupported error code. Requests to read ACLs are still supported. For more information, see Controlling object ownership in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions

You can set access permissions by using one of the following methods:

You can use either a canned ACL or specify access permissions explicitly. You cannot do both.

Grantee Values

You can specify the person (grantee) to whom you're assigning access rights (using request elements) in the following ways. For examples of how to specify these grantee values in JSON format, see the Amazon Web Services CLI example in Enabling Amazon S3 server access logging in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The following operations are related to PutBucketAcl:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration":{ "name":"PutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?analytics" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Sets an analytics configuration for the bucket (specified by the analytics configuration ID). You can have up to 1,000 analytics configurations per bucket.

You can choose to have storage class analysis export analysis reports sent to a comma-separated values (CSV) flat file. See the DataExport request element. Reports are updated daily and are based on the object filters that you configure. When selecting data export, you specify a destination bucket and an optional destination prefix where the file is written. You can export the data to a destination bucket in a different account. However, the destination bucket must be in the same Region as the bucket that you are making the PUT analytics configuration to. For more information, see Amazon S3 Analytics – Storage Class Analysis.

You must create a bucket policy on the destination bucket where the exported file is written to grant permissions to Amazon S3 to write objects to the bucket. For an example policy, see Granting Permissions for Amazon S3 Inventory and Storage Class Analysis.

To use this operation, you must have permissions to perform the s3:PutAnalyticsConfiguration action. The bucket owner has this permission by default. The bucket owner can grant this permission to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources.

PutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration has the following special errors:

The following operations are related to PutBucketAnalyticsConfiguration:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketCors":{ "name":"PutBucketCors", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?cors" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketCorsRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Sets the cors configuration for your bucket. If the configuration exists, Amazon S3 replaces it.

To use this operation, you must be allowed to perform the s3:PutBucketCORS action. By default, the bucket owner has this permission and can grant it to others.

You set this configuration on a bucket so that the bucket can service cross-origin requests. For example, you might want to enable a request whose origin is http://www.example.com to access your Amazon S3 bucket at my.example.bucket.com by using the browser's XMLHttpRequest capability.

To enable cross-origin resource sharing (CORS) on a bucket, you add the cors subresource to the bucket. The cors subresource is an XML document in which you configure rules that identify origins and the HTTP methods that can be executed on your bucket. The document is limited to 64 KB in size.

When Amazon S3 receives a cross-origin request (or a pre-flight OPTIONS request) against a bucket, it evaluates the cors configuration on the bucket and uses the first CORSRule rule that matches the incoming browser request to enable a cross-origin request. For a rule to match, the following conditions must be met:

For more information about CORS, go to Enabling Cross-Origin Resource Sharing in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The following operations are related to PutBucketCors:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketEncryption":{ "name":"PutBucketEncryption", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?encryption" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketEncryptionRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation configures default encryption and Amazon S3 Bucket Keys for an existing bucket.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, you must make requests for this API operation to the Regional endpoint. These endpoints support path-style requests in the format https://s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com/bucket-name . Virtual-hosted-style requests aren't supported. For more information about endpoints in Availability Zones, see Regional and Zonal endpoints for directory buckets in Availability Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about endpoints in Local Zones, see Concepts for directory buckets in Local Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

By default, all buckets have a default encryption configuration that uses server-side encryption with Amazon S3 managed keys (SSE-S3).

If you're specifying a customer managed KMS key, we recommend using a fully qualified KMS key ARN. If you use a KMS key alias instead, then KMS resolves the key within the requester’s account. This behavior can result in data that's encrypted with a KMS key that belongs to the requester, and not the bucket owner.

Also, this action requires Amazon Web Services Signature Version 4. For more information, see Authenticating Requests (Amazon Web Services Signature Version 4).

Permissions
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to PutBucketEncryption:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketIntelligentTieringConfiguration":{ "name":"PutBucketIntelligentTieringConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?intelligent-tiering" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketIntelligentTieringConfigurationRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Puts a S3 Intelligent-Tiering configuration to the specified bucket. You can have up to 1,000 S3 Intelligent-Tiering configurations per bucket.

The S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class is designed to optimize storage costs by automatically moving data to the most cost-effective storage access tier, without performance impact or operational overhead. S3 Intelligent-Tiering delivers automatic cost savings in three low latency and high throughput access tiers. To get the lowest storage cost on data that can be accessed in minutes to hours, you can choose to activate additional archiving capabilities.

The S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class is the ideal storage class for data with unknown, changing, or unpredictable access patterns, independent of object size or retention period. If the size of an object is less than 128 KB, it is not monitored and not eligible for auto-tiering. Smaller objects can be stored, but they are always charged at the Frequent Access tier rates in the S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class.

For more information, see Storage class for automatically optimizing frequently and infrequently accessed objects.

Operations related to PutBucketIntelligentTieringConfiguration include:

You only need S3 Intelligent-Tiering enabled on a bucket if you want to automatically move objects stored in the S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class to the Archive Access or Deep Archive Access tier.

PutBucketIntelligentTieringConfiguration has the following special errors:

HTTP 400 Bad Request Error

Code: InvalidArgument

Cause: Invalid Argument

HTTP 400 Bad Request Error

Code: TooManyConfigurations

Cause: You are attempting to create a new configuration but have already reached the 1,000-configuration limit.

HTTP 403 Forbidden Error

Cause: You are not the owner of the specified bucket, or you do not have the s3:PutIntelligentTieringConfiguration bucket permission to set the configuration on the bucket.

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketInventoryConfiguration":{ "name":"PutBucketInventoryConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?inventory" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

This implementation of the PUT action adds an S3 Inventory configuration (identified by the inventory ID) to the bucket. You can have up to 1,000 inventory configurations per bucket.

Amazon S3 inventory generates inventories of the objects in the bucket on a daily or weekly basis, and the results are published to a flat file. The bucket that is inventoried is called the source bucket, and the bucket where the inventory flat file is stored is called the destination bucket. The destination bucket must be in the same Amazon Web Services Region as the source bucket.

When you configure an inventory for a source bucket, you specify the destination bucket where you want the inventory to be stored, and whether to generate the inventory daily or weekly. You can also configure what object metadata to include and whether to inventory all object versions or only current versions. For more information, see Amazon S3 Inventory in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

You must create a bucket policy on the destination bucket to grant permissions to Amazon S3 to write objects to the bucket in the defined location. For an example policy, see Granting Permissions for Amazon S3 Inventory and Storage Class Analysis.

Permissions

To use this operation, you must have permission to perform the s3:PutInventoryConfiguration action. The bucket owner has this permission by default and can grant this permission to others.

The s3:PutInventoryConfiguration permission allows a user to create an S3 Inventory report that includes all object metadata fields available and to specify the destination bucket to store the inventory. A user with read access to objects in the destination bucket can also access all object metadata fields that are available in the inventory report.

To restrict access to an inventory report, see Restricting access to an Amazon S3 Inventory report in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about the metadata fields available in S3 Inventory, see Amazon S3 Inventory lists in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about permissions, see Permissions related to bucket subresource operations and Identity and access management in Amazon S3 in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

PutBucketInventoryConfiguration has the following special errors:

HTTP 400 Bad Request Error

Code: InvalidArgument

Cause: Invalid Argument

HTTP 400 Bad Request Error

Code: TooManyConfigurations

Cause: You are attempting to create a new configuration but have already reached the 1,000-configuration limit.

HTTP 403 Forbidden Error

Cause: You are not the owner of the specified bucket, or you do not have the s3:PutInventoryConfiguration bucket permission to set the configuration on the bucket.

The following operations are related to PutBucketInventoryConfiguration:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketLifecycle":{ "name":"PutBucketLifecycle", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?lifecycle" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketLifecycleRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

For an updated version of this API, see PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration. This version has been deprecated. Existing lifecycle configurations will work. For new lifecycle configurations, use the updated API.

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Creates a new lifecycle configuration for the bucket or replaces an existing lifecycle configuration. For information about lifecycle configuration, see Object Lifecycle Management in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

By default, all Amazon S3 resources, including buckets, objects, and related subresources (for example, lifecycle configuration and website configuration) are private. Only the resource owner, the Amazon Web Services account that created the resource, can access it. The resource owner can optionally grant access permissions to others by writing an access policy. For this operation, users must get the s3:PutLifecycleConfiguration permission.

You can also explicitly deny permissions. Explicit denial also supersedes any other permissions. If you want to prevent users or accounts from removing or deleting objects from your bucket, you must deny them permissions for the following actions:

For more information about permissions, see Managing Access Permissions to your Amazon S3 Resources in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

For more examples of transitioning objects to storage classes such as STANDARD_IA or ONEZONE_IA, see Examples of Lifecycle Configuration.

The following operations are related to PutBucketLifecycle:

", "deprecated":true, "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration":{ "name":"PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?lifecycle" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput"}, "documentation":"

Creates a new lifecycle configuration for the bucket or replaces an existing lifecycle configuration. Keep in mind that this will overwrite an existing lifecycle configuration, so if you want to retain any configuration details, they must be included in the new lifecycle configuration. For information about lifecycle configuration, see Managing your storage lifecycle.

Bucket lifecycle configuration now supports specifying a lifecycle rule using an object key name prefix, one or more object tags, object size, or any combination of these. Accordingly, this section describes the latest API. The previous version of the API supported filtering based only on an object key name prefix, which is supported for backward compatibility. For the related API description, see PutBucketLifecycle.

Rules
Permissions
HTTP Host header syntax

You specify the lifecycle configuration in your request body. The lifecycle configuration is specified as XML consisting of one or more rules. An Amazon S3 Lifecycle configuration can have up to 1,000 rules. This limit is not adjustable.

Bucket lifecycle configuration supports specifying a lifecycle rule using an object key name prefix, one or more object tags, object size, or any combination of these. Accordingly, this section describes the latest API. The previous version of the API supported filtering based only on an object key name prefix, which is supported for backward compatibility for general purpose buckets. For the related API description, see PutBucketLifecycle.

Lifecyle configurations for directory buckets only support expiring objects and cancelling multipart uploads. Expiring of versioned objects,transitions and tag filters are not supported.

A lifecycle rule consists of the following:

For more information, see Object Lifecycle Management and Lifecycle Configuration Elements.

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is s3express-control.region.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketLogging":{ "name":"PutBucketLogging", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?logging" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketLoggingRequest"}, "documentation":"

End of support notice: Beginning October 1, 2025, Amazon S3 will discontinue support for creating new Email Grantee Access Control Lists (ACL). Email Grantee ACLs created prior to this date will continue to work and remain accessible through the Amazon Web Services Management Console, Command Line Interface (CLI), SDKs, and REST API. However, you will no longer be able to create new Email Grantee ACLs.

This change affects the following Amazon Web Services Regions: US East (N. Virginia) Region, US West (N. California) Region, US West (Oregon) Region, Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region, Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region, Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region, Europe (Ireland) Region, and South America (São Paulo) Region.

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Set the logging parameters for a bucket and to specify permissions for who can view and modify the logging parameters. All logs are saved to buckets in the same Amazon Web Services Region as the source bucket. To set the logging status of a bucket, you must be the bucket owner.

The bucket owner is automatically granted FULL_CONTROL to all logs. You use the Grantee request element to grant access to other people. The Permissions request element specifies the kind of access the grantee has to the logs.

If the target bucket for log delivery uses the bucket owner enforced setting for S3 Object Ownership, you can't use the Grantee request element to grant access to others. Permissions can only be granted using policies. For more information, see Permissions for server access log delivery in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Grantee Values

You can specify the person (grantee) to whom you're assigning access rights (by using request elements) in the following ways. For examples of how to specify these grantee values in JSON format, see the Amazon Web Services CLI example in Enabling Amazon S3 server access logging in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

To enable logging, you use LoggingEnabled and its children request elements. To disable logging, you use an empty BucketLoggingStatus request element:

<BucketLoggingStatus xmlns=\"http://doc.s3.amazonaws.com/2006-03-01\" />

For more information about server access logging, see Server Access Logging in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

For more information about creating a bucket, see CreateBucket. For more information about returning the logging status of a bucket, see GetBucketLogging.

The following operations are related to PutBucketLogging:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketMetricsConfiguration":{ "name":"PutBucketMetricsConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?metrics" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Sets a metrics configuration (specified by the metrics configuration ID) for the bucket. You can have up to 1,000 metrics configurations per bucket. If you're updating an existing metrics configuration, note that this is a full replacement of the existing metrics configuration. If you don't include the elements you want to keep, they are erased.

To use this operation, you must have permissions to perform the s3:PutMetricsConfiguration action. The bucket owner has this permission by default. The bucket owner can grant this permission to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources.

For information about CloudWatch request metrics for Amazon S3, see Monitoring Metrics with Amazon CloudWatch.

The following operations are related to PutBucketMetricsConfiguration:

PutBucketMetricsConfiguration has the following special error:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketNotification":{ "name":"PutBucketNotification", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?notification" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketNotificationRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

No longer used, see the PutBucketNotificationConfiguration operation.

", "deprecated":true, "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketNotificationConfiguration":{ "name":"PutBucketNotificationConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?notification" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Enables notifications of specified events for a bucket. For more information about event notifications, see Configuring Event Notifications.

Using this API, you can replace an existing notification configuration. The configuration is an XML file that defines the event types that you want Amazon S3 to publish and the destination where you want Amazon S3 to publish an event notification when it detects an event of the specified type.

By default, your bucket has no event notifications configured. That is, the notification configuration will be an empty NotificationConfiguration.

<NotificationConfiguration>

</NotificationConfiguration>

This action replaces the existing notification configuration with the configuration you include in the request body.

After Amazon S3 receives this request, it first verifies that any Amazon Simple Notification Service (Amazon SNS) or Amazon Simple Queue Service (Amazon SQS) destination exists, and that the bucket owner has permission to publish to it by sending a test notification. In the case of Lambda destinations, Amazon S3 verifies that the Lambda function permissions grant Amazon S3 permission to invoke the function from the Amazon S3 bucket. For more information, see Configuring Notifications for Amazon S3 Events.

You can disable notifications by adding the empty NotificationConfiguration element.

For more information about the number of event notification configurations that you can create per bucket, see Amazon S3 service quotas in Amazon Web Services General Reference.

By default, only the bucket owner can configure notifications on a bucket. However, bucket owners can use a bucket policy to grant permission to other users to set this configuration with the required s3:PutBucketNotification permission.

The PUT notification is an atomic operation. For example, suppose your notification configuration includes SNS topic, SQS queue, and Lambda function configurations. When you send a PUT request with this configuration, Amazon S3 sends test messages to your SNS topic. If the message fails, the entire PUT action will fail, and Amazon S3 will not add the configuration to your bucket.

If the configuration in the request body includes only one TopicConfiguration specifying only the s3:ReducedRedundancyLostObject event type, the response will also include the x-amz-sns-test-message-id header containing the message ID of the test notification sent to the topic.

The following action is related to PutBucketNotificationConfiguration:

", "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketOwnershipControls":{ "name":"PutBucketOwnershipControls", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?ownershipControls" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketOwnershipControlsRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Creates or modifies OwnershipControls for an Amazon S3 bucket. To use this operation, you must have the s3:PutBucketOwnershipControls permission. For more information about Amazon S3 permissions, see Specifying permissions in a policy.

For information about Amazon S3 Object Ownership, see Using object ownership.

The following operations are related to PutBucketOwnershipControls:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketPolicy":{ "name":"PutBucketPolicy", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?policy" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketPolicyRequest"}, "documentation":"

Applies an Amazon S3 bucket policy to an Amazon S3 bucket.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, you must make requests for this API operation to the Regional endpoint. These endpoints support path-style requests in the format https://s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com/bucket-name . Virtual-hosted-style requests aren't supported. For more information about endpoints in Availability Zones, see Regional and Zonal endpoints for directory buckets in Availability Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about endpoints in Local Zones, see Concepts for directory buckets in Local Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions

If you are using an identity other than the root user of the Amazon Web Services account that owns the bucket, the calling identity must both have the PutBucketPolicy permissions on the specified bucket and belong to the bucket owner's account in order to use this operation.

If you don't have PutBucketPolicy permissions, Amazon S3 returns a 403 Access Denied error. If you have the correct permissions, but you're not using an identity that belongs to the bucket owner's account, Amazon S3 returns a 405 Method Not Allowed error.

To ensure that bucket owners don't inadvertently lock themselves out of their own buckets, the root principal in a bucket owner's Amazon Web Services account can perform the GetBucketPolicy, PutBucketPolicy, and DeleteBucketPolicy API actions, even if their bucket policy explicitly denies the root principal's access. Bucket owner root principals can only be blocked from performing these API actions by VPC endpoint policies and Amazon Web Services Organizations policies.

Example bucket policies

General purpose buckets example bucket policies - See Bucket policy examples in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory bucket example bucket policies - See Example bucket policies for S3 Express One Zone in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to PutBucketPolicy:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketReplication":{ "name":"PutBucketReplication", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?replication" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketReplicationRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Creates a replication configuration or replaces an existing one. For more information, see Replication in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Specify the replication configuration in the request body. In the replication configuration, you provide the name of the destination bucket or buckets where you want Amazon S3 to replicate objects, the IAM role that Amazon S3 can assume to replicate objects on your behalf, and other relevant information. You can invoke this request for a specific Amazon Web Services Region by using the aws:RequestedRegion condition key.

A replication configuration must include at least one rule, and can contain a maximum of 1,000. Each rule identifies a subset of objects to replicate by filtering the objects in the source bucket. To choose additional subsets of objects to replicate, add a rule for each subset.

To specify a subset of the objects in the source bucket to apply a replication rule to, add the Filter element as a child of the Rule element. You can filter objects based on an object key prefix, one or more object tags, or both. When you add the Filter element in the configuration, you must also add the following elements: DeleteMarkerReplication, Status, and Priority.

If you are using an earlier version of the replication configuration, Amazon S3 handles replication of delete markers differently. For more information, see Backward Compatibility.

For information about enabling versioning on a bucket, see Using Versioning.

Handling Replication of Encrypted Objects

By default, Amazon S3 doesn't replicate objects that are stored at rest using server-side encryption with KMS keys. To replicate Amazon Web Services KMS-encrypted objects, add the following: SourceSelectionCriteria, SseKmsEncryptedObjects, Status, EncryptionConfiguration, and ReplicaKmsKeyID. For information about replication configuration, see Replicating Objects Created with SSE Using KMS keys.

For information on PutBucketReplication errors, see List of replication-related error codes

Permissions

To create a PutBucketReplication request, you must have s3:PutReplicationConfiguration permissions for the bucket.

By default, a resource owner, in this case the Amazon Web Services account that created the bucket, can perform this operation. The resource owner can also grant others permissions to perform the operation. For more information about permissions, see Specifying Permissions in a Policy and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources.

To perform this operation, the user or role performing the action must have the iam:PassRole permission.

The following operations are related to PutBucketReplication:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketRequestPayment":{ "name":"PutBucketRequestPayment", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?requestPayment" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketRequestPaymentRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Sets the request payment configuration for a bucket. By default, the bucket owner pays for downloads from the bucket. This configuration parameter enables the bucket owner (only) to specify that the person requesting the download will be charged for the download. For more information, see Requester Pays Buckets.

The following operations are related to PutBucketRequestPayment:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketTagging":{ "name":"PutBucketTagging", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?tagging" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketTaggingRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Sets the tags for a bucket.

Use tags to organize your Amazon Web Services bill to reflect your own cost structure. To do this, sign up to get your Amazon Web Services account bill with tag key values included. Then, to see the cost of combined resources, organize your billing information according to resources with the same tag key values. For example, you can tag several resources with a specific application name, and then organize your billing information to see the total cost of that application across several services. For more information, see Cost Allocation and Tagging and Using Cost Allocation in Amazon S3 Bucket Tags.

When this operation sets the tags for a bucket, it will overwrite any current tags the bucket already has. You cannot use this operation to add tags to an existing list of tags.

To use this operation, you must have permissions to perform the s3:PutBucketTagging action. The bucket owner has this permission by default and can grant this permission to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources.

PutBucketTagging has the following special errors. For more Amazon S3 errors see, Error Responses.

The following operations are related to PutBucketTagging:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketVersioning":{ "name":"PutBucketVersioning", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?versioning" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketVersioningRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

When you enable versioning on a bucket for the first time, it might take a short amount of time for the change to be fully propagated. While this change is propagating, you might encounter intermittent HTTP 404 NoSuchKey errors for requests to objects created or updated after enabling versioning. We recommend that you wait for 15 minutes after enabling versioning before issuing write operations (PUT or DELETE) on objects in the bucket.

Sets the versioning state of an existing bucket.

You can set the versioning state with one of the following values:

Enabled—Enables versioning for the objects in the bucket. All objects added to the bucket receive a unique version ID.

Suspended—Disables versioning for the objects in the bucket. All objects added to the bucket receive the version ID null.

If the versioning state has never been set on a bucket, it has no versioning state; a GetBucketVersioning request does not return a versioning state value.

In order to enable MFA Delete, you must be the bucket owner. If you are the bucket owner and want to enable MFA Delete in the bucket versioning configuration, you must include the x-amz-mfa request header and the Status and the MfaDelete request elements in a request to set the versioning state of the bucket.

If you have an object expiration lifecycle configuration in your non-versioned bucket and you want to maintain the same permanent delete behavior when you enable versioning, you must add a noncurrent expiration policy. The noncurrent expiration lifecycle configuration will manage the deletes of the noncurrent object versions in the version-enabled bucket. (A version-enabled bucket maintains one current and zero or more noncurrent object versions.) For more information, see Lifecycle and Versioning.

The following operations are related to PutBucketVersioning:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutBucketWebsite":{ "name":"PutBucketWebsite", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?website" }, "input":{"shape":"PutBucketWebsiteRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Sets the configuration of the website that is specified in the website subresource. To configure a bucket as a website, you can add this subresource on the bucket with website configuration information such as the file name of the index document and any redirect rules. For more information, see Hosting Websites on Amazon S3.

This PUT action requires the S3:PutBucketWebsite permission. By default, only the bucket owner can configure the website attached to a bucket; however, bucket owners can allow other users to set the website configuration by writing a bucket policy that grants them the S3:PutBucketWebsite permission.

To redirect all website requests sent to the bucket's website endpoint, you add a website configuration with the following elements. Because all requests are sent to another website, you don't need to provide index document name for the bucket.

If you want granular control over redirects, you can use the following elements to add routing rules that describe conditions for redirecting requests and information about the redirect destination. In this case, the website configuration must provide an index document for the bucket, because some requests might not be redirected.

Amazon S3 has a limitation of 50 routing rules per website configuration. If you require more than 50 routing rules, you can use object redirect. For more information, see Configuring an Object Redirect in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The maximum request length is limited to 128 KB.

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "PutObject":{ "name":"PutObject", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}" }, "input":{"shape":"PutObjectRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"PutObjectOutput"}, "errors":[ {"shape":"InvalidRequest"}, {"shape":"InvalidWriteOffset"}, {"shape":"TooManyParts"}, {"shape":"EncryptionTypeMismatch"} ], "documentation":"

End of support notice: Beginning October 1, 2025, Amazon S3 will discontinue support for creating new Email Grantee Access Control Lists (ACL). Email Grantee ACLs created prior to this date will continue to work and remain accessible through the Amazon Web Services Management Console, Command Line Interface (CLI), SDKs, and REST API. However, you will no longer be able to create new Email Grantee ACLs.

This change affects the following Amazon Web Services Regions: US East (N. Virginia) Region, US West (N. California) Region, US West (Oregon) Region, Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region, Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region, Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region, Europe (Ireland) Region, and South America (São Paulo) Region.

Adds an object to a bucket.

Amazon S3 is a distributed system. If it receives multiple write requests for the same object simultaneously, it overwrites all but the last object written. However, Amazon S3 provides features that can modify this behavior:

Permissions
Data integrity with Content-MD5
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

For more information about related Amazon S3 APIs, see the following:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":false } }, "PutObjectAcl":{ "name":"PutObjectAcl", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}?acl" }, "input":{"shape":"PutObjectAclRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"PutObjectAclOutput"}, "errors":[ {"shape":"NoSuchKey"} ], "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Uses the acl subresource to set the access control list (ACL) permissions for a new or existing object in an S3 bucket. You must have the WRITE_ACP permission to set the ACL of an object. For more information, see What permissions can I grant? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for Amazon S3 on Outposts.

Depending on your application needs, you can choose to set the ACL on an object using either the request body or the headers. For example, if you have an existing application that updates a bucket ACL using the request body, you can continue to use that approach. For more information, see Access Control List (ACL) Overview in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If your bucket uses the bucket owner enforced setting for S3 Object Ownership, ACLs are disabled and no longer affect permissions. You must use policies to grant access to your bucket and the objects in it. Requests to set ACLs or update ACLs fail and return the AccessControlListNotSupported error code. Requests to read ACLs are still supported. For more information, see Controlling object ownership in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions

You can set access permissions using one of the following methods:

You can use either a canned ACL or specify access permissions explicitly. You cannot do both.

Grantee Values

You can specify the person (grantee) to whom you're assigning access rights (using request elements) in the following ways. For examples of how to specify these grantee values in JSON format, see the Amazon Web Services CLI example in Enabling Amazon S3 server access logging in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Versioning

The ACL of an object is set at the object version level. By default, PUT sets the ACL of the current version of an object. To set the ACL of a different version, use the versionId subresource.

The following operations are related to PutObjectAcl:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true } }, "PutObjectLegalHold":{ "name":"PutObjectLegalHold", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}?legal-hold" }, "input":{"shape":"PutObjectLegalHoldRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"PutObjectLegalHoldOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Applies a legal hold configuration to the specified object. For more information, see Locking Objects.

This functionality is not supported for Amazon S3 on Outposts.

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true } }, "PutObjectLockConfiguration":{ "name":"PutObjectLockConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?object-lock" }, "input":{"shape":"PutObjectLockConfigurationRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"PutObjectLockConfigurationOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Places an Object Lock configuration on the specified bucket. The rule specified in the Object Lock configuration will be applied by default to every new object placed in the specified bucket. For more information, see Locking Objects.

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true } }, "PutObjectRetention":{ "name":"PutObjectRetention", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}?retention" }, "input":{"shape":"PutObjectRetentionRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"PutObjectRetentionOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Places an Object Retention configuration on an object. For more information, see Locking Objects. Users or accounts require the s3:PutObjectRetention permission in order to place an Object Retention configuration on objects. Bypassing a Governance Retention configuration requires the s3:BypassGovernanceRetention permission.

This functionality is not supported for Amazon S3 on Outposts.

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true } }, "PutObjectTagging":{ "name":"PutObjectTagging", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}?tagging" }, "input":{"shape":"PutObjectTaggingRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"PutObjectTaggingOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Sets the supplied tag-set to an object that already exists in a bucket. A tag is a key-value pair. For more information, see Object Tagging.

You can associate tags with an object by sending a PUT request against the tagging subresource that is associated with the object. You can retrieve tags by sending a GET request. For more information, see GetObjectTagging.

For tagging-related restrictions related to characters and encodings, see Tag Restrictions. Note that Amazon S3 limits the maximum number of tags to 10 tags per object.

To use this operation, you must have permission to perform the s3:PutObjectTagging action. By default, the bucket owner has this permission and can grant this permission to others.

To put tags of any other version, use the versionId query parameter. You also need permission for the s3:PutObjectVersionTagging action.

PutObjectTagging has the following special errors. For more Amazon S3 errors see, Error Responses.

The following operations are related to PutObjectTagging:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true } }, "PutPublicAccessBlock":{ "name":"PutPublicAccessBlock", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?publicAccessBlock" }, "input":{"shape":"PutPublicAccessBlockRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Creates or modifies the PublicAccessBlock configuration for an Amazon S3 bucket. To use this operation, you must have the s3:PutBucketPublicAccessBlock permission. For more information about Amazon S3 permissions, see Specifying Permissions in a Policy.

When Amazon S3 evaluates the PublicAccessBlock configuration for a bucket or an object, it checks the PublicAccessBlock configuration for both the bucket (or the bucket that contains the object) and the bucket owner's account. If the PublicAccessBlock configurations are different between the bucket and the account, Amazon S3 uses the most restrictive combination of the bucket-level and account-level settings.

For more information about when Amazon S3 considers a bucket or an object public, see The Meaning of \"Public\".

The following operations are related to PutPublicAccessBlock:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "RenameObject":{ "name":"RenameObject", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}?renameObject" }, "input":{"shape":"RenameObjectRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"RenameObjectOutput"}, "errors":[ {"shape":"IdempotencyParameterMismatch"} ], "documentation":"

Renames an existing object in a directory bucket that uses the S3 Express One Zone storage class. You can use RenameObject by specifying an existing object’s name as the source and the new name of the object as the destination within the same directory bucket.

RenameObject is only supported for objects stored in the S3 Express One Zone storage class.

To prevent overwriting an object, you can use the If-None-Match conditional header.

Permissions

To grant access to the RenameObject operation on a directory bucket, we recommend that you use the CreateSession operation for session-based authorization. Specifically, you grant the s3express:CreateSession permission to the directory bucket in a bucket policy or an IAM identity-based policy. Then, you make the CreateSession API call on the directory bucket to obtain a session token. With the session token in your request header, you can make API requests to this operation. After the session token expires, you make another CreateSession API call to generate a new session token for use. The Amazon Web Services CLI and SDKs will create and manage your session including refreshing the session token automatically to avoid service interruptions when a session expires. In your bucket policy, you can specify the s3express:SessionMode condition key to control who can create a ReadWrite or ReadOnly session. A ReadWrite session is required for executing all the Zonal endpoint API operations, including RenameObject. For more information about authorization, see CreateSession . To learn more about Zonal endpoint API operations, see Authorizing Zonal endpoint API operations with CreateSession in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

" }, "RestoreObject":{ "name":"RestoreObject", "http":{ "method":"POST", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}?restore" }, "input":{"shape":"RestoreObjectRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"RestoreObjectOutput"}, "errors":[ {"shape":"ObjectAlreadyInActiveTierError"} ], "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Restores an archived copy of an object back into Amazon S3

This functionality is not supported for Amazon S3 on Outposts.

This action performs the following types of requests:

For more information about the S3 structure in the request body, see the following:

Permissions

To use this operation, you must have permissions to perform the s3:RestoreObject action. The bucket owner has this permission by default and can grant this permission to others. For more information about permissions, see Permissions Related to Bucket Subresource Operations and Managing Access Permissions to Your Amazon S3 Resources in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Restoring objects

Objects that you archive to the S3 Glacier Flexible Retrieval or S3 Glacier Deep Archive storage class, and S3 Intelligent-Tiering Archive or S3 Intelligent-Tiering Deep Archive tiers, are not accessible in real time. For objects in the S3 Glacier Flexible Retrieval or S3 Glacier Deep Archive storage classes, you must first initiate a restore request, and then wait until a temporary copy of the object is available. If you want a permanent copy of the object, create a copy of it in the Amazon S3 Standard storage class in your S3 bucket. To access an archived object, you must restore the object for the duration (number of days) that you specify. For objects in the Archive Access or Deep Archive Access tiers of S3 Intelligent-Tiering, you must first initiate a restore request, and then wait until the object is moved into the Frequent Access tier.

To restore a specific object version, you can provide a version ID. If you don't provide a version ID, Amazon S3 restores the current version.

When restoring an archived object, you can specify one of the following data access tier options in the Tier element of the request body:

For more information about archive retrieval options and provisioned capacity for Expedited data access, see Restoring Archived Objects in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

You can use Amazon S3 restore speed upgrade to change the restore speed to a faster speed while it is in progress. For more information, see Upgrading the speed of an in-progress restore in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

To get the status of object restoration, you can send a HEAD request. Operations return the x-amz-restore header, which provides information about the restoration status, in the response. You can use Amazon S3 event notifications to notify you when a restore is initiated or completed. For more information, see Configuring Amazon S3 Event Notifications in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

After restoring an archived object, you can update the restoration period by reissuing the request with a new period. Amazon S3 updates the restoration period relative to the current time and charges only for the request-there are no data transfer charges. You cannot update the restoration period when Amazon S3 is actively processing your current restore request for the object.

If your bucket has a lifecycle configuration with a rule that includes an expiration action, the object expiration overrides the life span that you specify in a restore request. For example, if you restore an object copy for 10 days, but the object is scheduled to expire in 3 days, Amazon S3 deletes the object in 3 days. For more information about lifecycle configuration, see PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration and Object Lifecycle Management in Amazon S3 User Guide.

Responses

A successful action returns either the 200 OK or 202 Accepted status code.

The following operations are related to RestoreObject:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":false } }, "SelectObjectContent":{ "name":"SelectObjectContent", "http":{ "method":"POST", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}?select&select-type=2" }, "input":{ "shape":"SelectObjectContentRequest", "locationName":"SelectObjectContentRequest", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "output":{"shape":"SelectObjectContentOutput"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

This action filters the contents of an Amazon S3 object based on a simple structured query language (SQL) statement. In the request, along with the SQL expression, you must also specify a data serialization format (JSON, CSV, or Apache Parquet) of the object. Amazon S3 uses this format to parse object data into records, and returns only records that match the specified SQL expression. You must also specify the data serialization format for the response.

This functionality is not supported for Amazon S3 on Outposts.

For more information about Amazon S3 Select, see Selecting Content from Objects and SELECT Command in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions

You must have the s3:GetObject permission for this operation. Amazon S3 Select does not support anonymous access. For more information about permissions, see Specifying Permissions in a Policy in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Data Formats

You can use Amazon S3 Select to query objects that have the following format properties:

Working with the Response Body

Given the response size is unknown, Amazon S3 Select streams the response as a series of messages and includes a Transfer-Encoding header with chunked as its value in the response. For more information, see Appendix: SelectObjectContent Response.

GetObject Support

The SelectObjectContent action does not support the following GetObject functionality. For more information, see GetObject.

Special Errors

For a list of special errors for this operation, see List of SELECT Object Content Error Codes

The following operations are related to SelectObjectContent:

" }, "UpdateBucketMetadataInventoryTableConfiguration":{ "name":"UpdateBucketMetadataInventoryTableConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?metadataInventoryTable" }, "input":{"shape":"UpdateBucketMetadataInventoryTableConfigurationRequest"}, "documentation":"

Enables or disables a live inventory table for an S3 Metadata configuration on a general purpose bucket. For more information, see Accelerating data discovery with S3 Metadata in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions

To use this operation, you must have the following permissions. For more information, see Setting up permissions for configuring metadata tables in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you want to encrypt your inventory table with server-side encryption with Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS), you need additional permissions in your KMS key policy. For more information, see Setting up permissions for configuring metadata tables in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The following operations are related to UpdateBucketMetadataInventoryTableConfiguration:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "UpdateBucketMetadataJournalTableConfiguration":{ "name":"UpdateBucketMetadataJournalTableConfiguration", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}?metadataJournalTable" }, "input":{"shape":"UpdateBucketMetadataJournalTableConfigurationRequest"}, "documentation":"

Enables or disables journal table record expiration for an S3 Metadata configuration on a general purpose bucket. For more information, see Accelerating data discovery with S3 Metadata in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions

To use this operation, you must have the s3:UpdateBucketMetadataJournalTableConfiguration permission. For more information, see Setting up permissions for configuring metadata tables in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The following operations are related to UpdateBucketMetadataJournalTableConfiguration:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":true }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseS3ExpressControlEndpoint":{"value":true} } }, "UploadPart":{ "name":"UploadPart", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}" }, "input":{"shape":"UploadPartRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"UploadPartOutput"}, "documentation":"

Uploads a part in a multipart upload.

In this operation, you provide new data as a part of an object in your request. However, you have an option to specify your existing Amazon S3 object as a data source for the part you are uploading. To upload a part from an existing object, you use the UploadPartCopy operation.

You must initiate a multipart upload (see CreateMultipartUpload) before you can upload any part. In response to your initiate request, Amazon S3 returns an upload ID, a unique identifier that you must include in your upload part request.

Part numbers can be any number from 1 to 10,000, inclusive. A part number uniquely identifies a part and also defines its position within the object being created. If you upload a new part using the same part number that was used with a previous part, the previously uploaded part is overwritten.

For information about maximum and minimum part sizes and other multipart upload specifications, see Multipart upload limits in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

After you initiate multipart upload and upload one or more parts, you must either complete or abort multipart upload in order to stop getting charged for storage of the uploaded parts. Only after you either complete or abort multipart upload, Amazon S3 frees up the parts storage and stops charging you for the parts storage.

For more information on multipart uploads, go to Multipart Upload Overview in the Amazon S3 User Guide .

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, you must make requests for this API operation to the Zonal endpoint. These endpoints support virtual-hosted-style requests in the format https://amzn-s3-demo-bucket.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com/key-name . Path-style requests are not supported. For more information about endpoints in Availability Zones, see Regional and Zonal endpoints for directory buckets in Availability Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about endpoints in Local Zones, see Concepts for directory buckets in Local Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Permissions
Data integrity

General purpose bucket - To ensure that data is not corrupted traversing the network, specify the Content-MD5 header in the upload part request. Amazon S3 checks the part data against the provided MD5 value. If they do not match, Amazon S3 returns an error. If the upload request is signed with Signature Version 4, then Amazon Web Services S3 uses the x-amz-content-sha256 header as a checksum instead of Content-MD5. For more information see Authenticating Requests: Using the Authorization Header (Amazon Web Services Signature Version 4).

Directory buckets - MD5 is not supported by directory buckets. You can use checksum algorithms to check object integrity.

Encryption
Special errors
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to UploadPart:

", "httpChecksum":{ "requestAlgorithmMember":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "requestChecksumRequired":false } }, "UploadPartCopy":{ "name":"UploadPartCopy", "http":{ "method":"PUT", "requestUri":"/{Bucket}/{Key+}" }, "input":{"shape":"UploadPartCopyRequest"}, "output":{"shape":"UploadPartCopyOutput"}, "documentation":"

Uploads a part by copying data from an existing object as data source. To specify the data source, you add the request header x-amz-copy-source in your request. To specify a byte range, you add the request header x-amz-copy-source-range in your request.

For information about maximum and minimum part sizes and other multipart upload specifications, see Multipart upload limits in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Instead of copying data from an existing object as part data, you might use the UploadPart action to upload new data as a part of an object in your request.

You must initiate a multipart upload before you can upload any part. In response to your initiate request, Amazon S3 returns the upload ID, a unique identifier that you must include in your upload part request.

For conceptual information about multipart uploads, see Uploading Objects Using Multipart Upload in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For information about copying objects using a single atomic action vs. a multipart upload, see Operations on Objects in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, you must make requests for this API operation to the Zonal endpoint. These endpoints support virtual-hosted-style requests in the format https://amzn-s3-demo-bucket.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com/key-name . Path-style requests are not supported. For more information about endpoints in Availability Zones, see Regional and Zonal endpoints for directory buckets in Availability Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For more information about endpoints in Local Zones, see Concepts for directory buckets in Local Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Authentication and authorization

All UploadPartCopy requests must be authenticated and signed by using IAM credentials (access key ID and secret access key for the IAM identities). All headers with the x-amz- prefix, including x-amz-copy-source, must be signed. For more information, see REST Authentication.

Directory buckets - You must use IAM credentials to authenticate and authorize your access to the UploadPartCopy API operation, instead of using the temporary security credentials through the CreateSession API operation.

Amazon Web Services CLI or SDKs handles authentication and authorization on your behalf.

Permissions

You must have READ access to the source object and WRITE access to the destination bucket.

Encryption
Special errors
HTTP Host header syntax

Directory buckets - The HTTP Host header syntax is Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com.

The following operations are related to UploadPartCopy:

", "staticContextParams":{ "DisableS3ExpressSessionAuth":{"value":true} } }, "WriteGetObjectResponse":{ "name":"WriteGetObjectResponse", "http":{ "method":"POST", "requestUri":"/WriteGetObjectResponse" }, "input":{"shape":"WriteGetObjectResponseRequest"}, "documentation":"

This operation is not supported for directory buckets.

Passes transformed objects to a GetObject operation when using Object Lambda access points. For information about Object Lambda access points, see Transforming objects with Object Lambda access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This operation supports metadata that can be returned by GetObject, in addition to RequestRoute, RequestToken, StatusCode, ErrorCode, and ErrorMessage. The GetObject response metadata is supported so that the WriteGetObjectResponse caller, typically an Lambda function, can provide the same metadata when it internally invokes GetObject. When WriteGetObjectResponse is called by a customer-owned Lambda function, the metadata returned to the end user GetObject call might differ from what Amazon S3 would normally return.

You can include any number of metadata headers. When including a metadata header, it should be prefaced with x-amz-meta. For example, x-amz-meta-my-custom-header: MyCustomValue. The primary use case for this is to forward GetObject metadata.

Amazon Web Services provides some prebuilt Lambda functions that you can use with S3 Object Lambda to detect and redact personally identifiable information (PII) and decompress S3 objects. These Lambda functions are available in the Amazon Web Services Serverless Application Repository, and can be selected through the Amazon Web Services Management Console when you create your Object Lambda access point.

Example 1: PII Access Control - This Lambda function uses Amazon Comprehend, a natural language processing (NLP) service using machine learning to find insights and relationships in text. It automatically detects personally identifiable information (PII) such as names, addresses, dates, credit card numbers, and social security numbers from documents in your Amazon S3 bucket.

Example 2: PII Redaction - This Lambda function uses Amazon Comprehend, a natural language processing (NLP) service using machine learning to find insights and relationships in text. It automatically redacts personally identifiable information (PII) such as names, addresses, dates, credit card numbers, and social security numbers from documents in your Amazon S3 bucket.

Example 3: Decompression - The Lambda function S3ObjectLambdaDecompression, is equipped to decompress objects stored in S3 in one of six compressed file formats including bzip2, gzip, snappy, zlib, zstandard and ZIP.

For information on how to view and use these functions, see Using Amazon Web Services built Lambda functions in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "authtype":"v4-unsigned-body", "endpoint":{ "hostPrefix":"{RequestRoute}." }, "staticContextParams":{ "UseObjectLambdaEndpoint":{"value":true} }, "unsignedPayload":true } }, "shapes":{ "AbortDate":{"type":"timestamp"}, "AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "DaysAfterInitiation":{ "shape":"DaysAfterInitiation", "documentation":"

Specifies the number of days after which Amazon S3 aborts an incomplete multipart upload.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the days since the initiation of an incomplete multipart upload that Amazon S3 will wait before permanently removing all parts of the upload. For more information, see Aborting Incomplete Multipart Uploads Using a Bucket Lifecycle Configuration in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "AbortMultipartUploadOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } } }, "AbortMultipartUploadRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key", "UploadId" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name to which the upload was taking place.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Key of the object for which the multipart upload was initiated.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Key"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "UploadId":{ "shape":"MultipartUploadId", "documentation":"

Upload ID that identifies the multipart upload.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"uploadId" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "IfMatchInitiatedTime":{ "shape":"IfMatchInitiatedTime", "documentation":"

If present, this header aborts an in progress multipart upload only if it was initiated on the provided timestamp. If the initiated timestamp of the multipart upload does not match the provided value, the operation returns a 412 Precondition Failed error. If the initiated timestamp matches or if the multipart upload doesn’t exist, the operation returns a 204 Success (No Content) response.

This functionality is only supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-if-match-initiated-time" } } }, "AbortRuleId":{"type":"string"}, "AccelerateConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Status":{ "shape":"BucketAccelerateStatus", "documentation":"

Specifies the transfer acceleration status of the bucket.

" } }, "documentation":"

Configures the transfer acceleration state for an Amazon S3 bucket. For more information, see Amazon S3 Transfer Acceleration in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "AcceptRanges":{"type":"string"}, "AccessControlPolicy":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Grants":{ "shape":"Grants", "documentation":"

A list of grants.

", "locationName":"AccessControlList" }, "Owner":{ "shape":"Owner", "documentation":"

Container for the bucket owner's display name and ID.

" } }, "documentation":"

Contains the elements that set the ACL permissions for an object per grantee.

" }, "AccessControlTranslation":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Owner"], "members":{ "Owner":{ "shape":"OwnerOverride", "documentation":"

Specifies the replica ownership. For default and valid values, see PUT bucket replication in the Amazon S3 API Reference.

" } }, "documentation":"

A container for information about access control for replicas.

" }, "AccessKeyIdValue":{"type":"string"}, "AccessPointAlias":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "AccessPointArn":{"type":"string"}, "AccountId":{"type":"string"}, "AllowQuotedRecordDelimiter":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "AllowedHeader":{"type":"string"}, "AllowedHeaders":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"AllowedHeader"}, "flattened":true }, "AllowedMethod":{"type":"string"}, "AllowedMethods":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"AllowedMethod"}, "flattened":true }, "AllowedOrigin":{"type":"string"}, "AllowedOrigins":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"AllowedOrigin"}, "flattened":true }, "AnalyticsAndOperator":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

The prefix to use when evaluating an AND predicate: The prefix that an object must have to be included in the metrics results.

" }, "Tags":{ "shape":"TagSet", "documentation":"

The list of tags to use when evaluating an AND predicate.

", "flattened":true, "locationName":"Tag" } }, "documentation":"

A conjunction (logical AND) of predicates, which is used in evaluating a metrics filter. The operator must have at least two predicates in any combination, and an object must match all of the predicates for the filter to apply.

" }, "AnalyticsConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Id", "StorageClassAnalysis" ], "members":{ "Id":{ "shape":"AnalyticsId", "documentation":"

The ID that identifies the analytics configuration.

" }, "Filter":{ "shape":"AnalyticsFilter", "documentation":"

The filter used to describe a set of objects for analyses. A filter must have exactly one prefix, one tag, or one conjunction (AnalyticsAndOperator). If no filter is provided, all objects will be considered in any analysis.

" }, "StorageClassAnalysis":{ "shape":"StorageClassAnalysis", "documentation":"

Contains data related to access patterns to be collected and made available to analyze the tradeoffs between different storage classes.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the configuration and any analyses for the analytics filter of an Amazon S3 bucket.

" }, "AnalyticsConfigurationList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"AnalyticsConfiguration"}, "flattened":true }, "AnalyticsExportDestination":{ "type":"structure", "required":["S3BucketDestination"], "members":{ "S3BucketDestination":{ "shape":"AnalyticsS3BucketDestination", "documentation":"

A destination signifying output to an S3 bucket.

" } }, "documentation":"

Where to publish the analytics results.

" }, "AnalyticsFilter":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

The prefix to use when evaluating an analytics filter.

" }, "Tag":{ "shape":"Tag", "documentation":"

The tag to use when evaluating an analytics filter.

" }, "And":{ "shape":"AnalyticsAndOperator", "documentation":"

A conjunction (logical AND) of predicates, which is used in evaluating an analytics filter. The operator must have at least two predicates.

" } }, "documentation":"

The filter used to describe a set of objects for analyses. A filter must have exactly one prefix, one tag, or one conjunction (AnalyticsAndOperator). If no filter is provided, all objects will be considered in any analysis.

" }, "AnalyticsId":{"type":"string"}, "AnalyticsS3BucketDestination":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Format", "Bucket" ], "members":{ "Format":{ "shape":"AnalyticsS3ExportFileFormat", "documentation":"

Specifies the file format used when exporting data to Amazon S3.

" }, "BucketAccountId":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID that owns the destination S3 bucket. If no account ID is provided, the owner is not validated before exporting data.

Although this value is optional, we strongly recommend that you set it to help prevent problems if the destination bucket ownership changes.

" }, "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the bucket to which data is exported.

" }, "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

The prefix to use when exporting data. The prefix is prepended to all results.

" } }, "documentation":"

Contains information about where to publish the analytics results.

" }, "AnalyticsS3ExportFileFormat":{ "type":"string", "enum":["CSV"] }, "ArchiveStatus":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "ARCHIVE_ACCESS", "DEEP_ARCHIVE_ACCESS" ] }, "Body":{"type":"blob"}, "Bucket":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Name":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket.

" }, "CreationDate":{ "shape":"CreationDate", "documentation":"

Date the bucket was created. This date can change when making changes to your bucket, such as editing its bucket policy.

" }, "BucketRegion":{ "shape":"BucketRegion", "documentation":"

BucketRegion indicates the Amazon Web Services region where the bucket is located. If the request contains at least one valid parameter, it is included in the response.

" }, "BucketArn":{ "shape":"S3RegionalOrS3ExpressBucketArnString", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the S3 bucket. ARNs uniquely identify Amazon Web Services resources across all of Amazon Web Services.

This parameter is only supported for S3 directory buckets. For more information, see Using tags with directory buckets.

" } }, "documentation":"

In terms of implementation, a Bucket is a resource.

" }, "BucketAccelerateStatus":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Enabled", "Suspended" ] }, "BucketAlreadyExists":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

The requested bucket name is not available. The bucket namespace is shared by all users of the system. Select a different name and try again.

", "error":{"httpStatusCode":409}, "exception":true }, "BucketAlreadyOwnedByYou":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

The bucket you tried to create already exists, and you own it. Amazon S3 returns this error in all Amazon Web Services Regions except in the North Virginia Region. For legacy compatibility, if you re-create an existing bucket that you already own in the North Virginia Region, Amazon S3 returns 200 OK and resets the bucket access control lists (ACLs).

", "error":{"httpStatusCode":409}, "exception":true }, "BucketCannedACL":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "private", "public-read", "public-read-write", "authenticated-read" ] }, "BucketInfo":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "DataRedundancy":{ "shape":"DataRedundancy", "documentation":"

The number of Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone) that's used for redundancy for the bucket.

" }, "Type":{ "shape":"BucketType", "documentation":"

The type of bucket.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the information about the bucket that will be created. For more information about directory buckets, see Directory buckets in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is only supported by directory buckets.

" }, "BucketKeyEnabled":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "BucketLifecycleConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Rules"], "members":{ "Rules":{ "shape":"LifecycleRules", "documentation":"

A lifecycle rule for individual objects in an Amazon S3 bucket.

", "locationName":"Rule" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the lifecycle configuration for objects in an Amazon S3 bucket. For more information, see Object Lifecycle Management in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "BucketLocationConstraint":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "af-south-1", "ap-east-1", "ap-northeast-1", "ap-northeast-2", "ap-northeast-3", "ap-south-1", "ap-south-2", "ap-southeast-1", "ap-southeast-2", "ap-southeast-3", "ap-southeast-4", "ap-southeast-5", "ca-central-1", "cn-north-1", "cn-northwest-1", "EU", "eu-central-1", "eu-central-2", "eu-north-1", "eu-south-1", "eu-south-2", "eu-west-1", "eu-west-2", "eu-west-3", "il-central-1", "me-central-1", "me-south-1", "sa-east-1", "us-east-2", "us-gov-east-1", "us-gov-west-1", "us-west-1", "us-west-2" ] }, "BucketLocationName":{"type":"string"}, "BucketLoggingStatus":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "LoggingEnabled":{"shape":"LoggingEnabled"} }, "documentation":"

Container for logging status information.

" }, "BucketLogsPermission":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "FULL_CONTROL", "READ", "WRITE" ] }, "BucketName":{"type":"string"}, "BucketRegion":{"type":"string"}, "BucketType":{ "type":"string", "enum":["Directory"] }, "BucketVersioningStatus":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Enabled", "Suspended" ] }, "Buckets":{ "type":"list", "member":{ "shape":"Bucket", "locationName":"Bucket" } }, "BypassGovernanceRetention":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "BytesProcessed":{ "type":"long", "box":true }, "BytesReturned":{ "type":"long", "box":true }, "BytesScanned":{ "type":"long", "box":true }, "CORSConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":["CORSRules"], "members":{ "CORSRules":{ "shape":"CORSRules", "documentation":"

A set of origins and methods (cross-origin access that you want to allow). You can add up to 100 rules to the configuration.

", "locationName":"CORSRule" } }, "documentation":"

Describes the cross-origin access configuration for objects in an Amazon S3 bucket. For more information, see Enabling Cross-Origin Resource Sharing in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "CORSRule":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "AllowedMethods", "AllowedOrigins" ], "members":{ "ID":{ "shape":"ID", "documentation":"

Unique identifier for the rule. The value cannot be longer than 255 characters.

" }, "AllowedHeaders":{ "shape":"AllowedHeaders", "documentation":"

Headers that are specified in the Access-Control-Request-Headers header. These headers are allowed in a preflight OPTIONS request. In response to any preflight OPTIONS request, Amazon S3 returns any requested headers that are allowed.

", "locationName":"AllowedHeader" }, "AllowedMethods":{ "shape":"AllowedMethods", "documentation":"

An HTTP method that you allow the origin to execute. Valid values are GET, PUT, HEAD, POST, and DELETE.

", "locationName":"AllowedMethod" }, "AllowedOrigins":{ "shape":"AllowedOrigins", "documentation":"

One or more origins you want customers to be able to access the bucket from.

", "locationName":"AllowedOrigin" }, "ExposeHeaders":{ "shape":"ExposeHeaders", "documentation":"

One or more headers in the response that you want customers to be able to access from their applications (for example, from a JavaScript XMLHttpRequest object).

", "locationName":"ExposeHeader" }, "MaxAgeSeconds":{ "shape":"MaxAgeSeconds", "documentation":"

The time in seconds that your browser is to cache the preflight response for the specified resource.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies a cross-origin access rule for an Amazon S3 bucket.

" }, "CORSRules":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"CORSRule"}, "flattened":true }, "CSVInput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "FileHeaderInfo":{ "shape":"FileHeaderInfo", "documentation":"

Describes the first line of input. Valid values are:

" }, "Comments":{ "shape":"Comments", "documentation":"

A single character used to indicate that a row should be ignored when the character is present at the start of that row. You can specify any character to indicate a comment line. The default character is #.

Default: #

" }, "QuoteEscapeCharacter":{ "shape":"QuoteEscapeCharacter", "documentation":"

A single character used for escaping the quotation mark character inside an already escaped value. For example, the value \"\"\" a , b \"\"\" is parsed as \" a , b \".

" }, "RecordDelimiter":{ "shape":"RecordDelimiter", "documentation":"

A single character used to separate individual records in the input. Instead of the default value, you can specify an arbitrary delimiter.

" }, "FieldDelimiter":{ "shape":"FieldDelimiter", "documentation":"

A single character used to separate individual fields in a record. You can specify an arbitrary delimiter.

" }, "QuoteCharacter":{ "shape":"QuoteCharacter", "documentation":"

A single character used for escaping when the field delimiter is part of the value. For example, if the value is a, b, Amazon S3 wraps this field value in quotation marks, as follows: \" a , b \".

Type: String

Default: \"

Ancestors: CSV

" }, "AllowQuotedRecordDelimiter":{ "shape":"AllowQuotedRecordDelimiter", "documentation":"

Specifies that CSV field values may contain quoted record delimiters and such records should be allowed. Default value is FALSE. Setting this value to TRUE may lower performance.

" } }, "documentation":"

Describes how an uncompressed comma-separated values (CSV)-formatted input object is formatted.

" }, "CSVOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "QuoteFields":{ "shape":"QuoteFields", "documentation":"

Indicates whether to use quotation marks around output fields.

" }, "QuoteEscapeCharacter":{ "shape":"QuoteEscapeCharacter", "documentation":"

The single character used for escaping the quote character inside an already escaped value.

" }, "RecordDelimiter":{ "shape":"RecordDelimiter", "documentation":"

A single character used to separate individual records in the output. Instead of the default value, you can specify an arbitrary delimiter.

" }, "FieldDelimiter":{ "shape":"FieldDelimiter", "documentation":"

The value used to separate individual fields in a record. You can specify an arbitrary delimiter.

" }, "QuoteCharacter":{ "shape":"QuoteCharacter", "documentation":"

A single character used for escaping when the field delimiter is part of the value. For example, if the value is a, b, Amazon S3 wraps this field value in quotation marks, as follows: \" a , b \".

" } }, "documentation":"

Describes how uncompressed comma-separated values (CSV)-formatted results are formatted.

" }, "CacheControl":{"type":"string"}, "Checksum":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ChecksumCRC32":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32 checksum of the object. This checksum is only be present if the checksum was uploaded with the object. When you use an API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumCRC32C":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32C", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32C checksum of the object. This checksum is only present if the checksum was uploaded with the object. When you use an API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumCRC64NVME":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC64NVME", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 64-bit CRC64NVME checksum of the object. This checksum is present if the object was uploaded with the CRC64NVME checksum algorithm, or if the object was uploaded without a checksum (and Amazon S3 added the default checksum, CRC64NVME, to the uploaded object). For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumSHA1":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA1", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 160-bit SHA1 digest of the object. This will only be present if the object was uploaded with the object. When you use the API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumSHA256":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA256", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 256-bit SHA256 digest of the object. This will only be present if the object was uploaded with the object. When you use an API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumType":{ "shape":"ChecksumType", "documentation":"

The checksum type that is used to calculate the object’s checksum value. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" } }, "documentation":"

Contains all the possible checksum or digest values for an object.

" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "CRC32", "CRC32C", "SHA1", "SHA256", "CRC64NVME" ] }, "ChecksumAlgorithmList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm"}, "flattened":true }, "ChecksumCRC32":{"type":"string"}, "ChecksumCRC32C":{"type":"string"}, "ChecksumCRC64NVME":{"type":"string"}, "ChecksumMode":{ "type":"string", "enum":["ENABLED"] }, "ChecksumSHA1":{"type":"string"}, "ChecksumSHA256":{"type":"string"}, "ChecksumType":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "COMPOSITE", "FULL_OBJECT" ] }, "ClientToken":{"type":"string"}, "CloudFunction":{"type":"string"}, "CloudFunctionConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Id":{"shape":"NotificationId"}, "Event":{ "shape":"Event", "deprecated":true }, "Events":{ "shape":"EventList", "documentation":"

Bucket events for which to send notifications.

", "locationName":"Event" }, "CloudFunction":{ "shape":"CloudFunction", "documentation":"

Lambda cloud function ARN that Amazon S3 can invoke when it detects events of the specified type.

" }, "InvocationRole":{ "shape":"CloudFunctionInvocationRole", "documentation":"

The role supporting the invocation of the Lambda function

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for specifying the Lambda notification configuration.

" }, "CloudFunctionInvocationRole":{"type":"string"}, "Code":{"type":"string"}, "Comments":{"type":"string"}, "CommonPrefix":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

Container for the specified common prefix.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for all (if there are any) keys between Prefix and the next occurrence of the string specified by a delimiter. CommonPrefixes lists keys that act like subdirectories in the directory specified by Prefix. For example, if the prefix is notes/ and the delimiter is a slash (/) as in notes/summer/july, the common prefix is notes/summer/.

" }, "CommonPrefixList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"CommonPrefix"}, "flattened":true }, "CompleteMultipartUploadOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Location":{ "shape":"Location", "documentation":"

The URI that identifies the newly created object.

" }, "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket that contains the newly created object. Does not return the access point ARN or access point alias if used.

Access points are not supported by directory buckets.

" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The object key of the newly created object.

" }, "Expiration":{ "shape":"Expiration", "documentation":"

If the object expiration is configured, this will contain the expiration date (expiry-date) and rule ID (rule-id). The value of rule-id is URL-encoded.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expiration" }, "ETag":{ "shape":"ETag", "documentation":"

Entity tag that identifies the newly created object's data. Objects with different object data will have different entity tags. The entity tag is an opaque string. The entity tag may or may not be an MD5 digest of the object data. If the entity tag is not an MD5 digest of the object data, it will contain one or more nonhexadecimal characters and/or will consist of less than 32 or more than 32 hexadecimal digits. For more information about how the entity tag is calculated, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumCRC32":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32 checksum of the object. This checksum is only be present if the checksum was uploaded with the object. When you use an API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumCRC32C":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32C", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32C checksum of the object. This checksum is only present if the checksum was uploaded with the object. When you use an API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumCRC64NVME":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC64NVME", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 64-bit CRC64NVME checksum of the object. The CRC64NVME checksum is always a full object checksum. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumSHA1":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA1", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 160-bit SHA1 digest of the object. This will only be present if the object was uploaded with the object. When you use the API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumSHA256":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA256", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 256-bit SHA256 digest of the object. This will only be present if the object was uploaded with the object. When you use an API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumType":{ "shape":"ChecksumType", "documentation":"

The checksum type, which determines how part-level checksums are combined to create an object-level checksum for multipart objects. You can use this header as a data integrity check to verify that the checksum type that is received is the same checksum type that was specified during the CreateMultipartUpload request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ServerSideEncryption":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryption", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in Amazon S3.

When accessing data stored in Amazon FSx file systems using S3 access points, the only valid server side encryption option is aws:fsx.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

Version ID of the newly created object, in case the bucket has versioning turned on.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-version-id" }, "SSEKMSKeyId":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

If present, indicates the ID of the KMS key that was used for object encryption.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" }, "BucketKeyEnabled":{ "shape":"BucketKeyEnabled", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the multipart upload uses an S3 Bucket Key for server-side encryption with Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-bucket-key-enabled" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } } }, "CompleteMultipartUploadRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key", "UploadId" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

Name of the bucket to which the multipart upload was initiated.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Object key for which the multipart upload was initiated.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Key"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "MultipartUpload":{ "shape":"CompletedMultipartUpload", "documentation":"

The container for the multipart upload request information.

", "locationName":"CompleteMultipartUpload", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "UploadId":{ "shape":"MultipartUploadId", "documentation":"

ID for the initiated multipart upload.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"uploadId" }, "ChecksumCRC32":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32 checksum of the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc32" }, "ChecksumCRC32C":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32C", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32C checksum of the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc32c" }, "ChecksumCRC64NVME":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC64NVME", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 64-bit CRC64NVME checksum of the object. The CRC64NVME checksum is always a full object checksum. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc64nvme" }, "ChecksumSHA1":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA1", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 160-bit SHA1 digest of the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-sha1" }, "ChecksumSHA256":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA256", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 256-bit SHA256 digest of the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-sha256" }, "ChecksumType":{ "shape":"ChecksumType", "documentation":"

This header specifies the checksum type of the object, which determines how part-level checksums are combined to create an object-level checksum for multipart objects. You can use this header as a data integrity check to verify that the checksum type that is received is the same checksum that was specified. If the checksum type doesn’t match the checksum type that was specified for the object during the CreateMultipartUpload request, it’ll result in a BadDigest error. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-type" }, "MpuObjectSize":{ "shape":"MpuObjectSize", "documentation":"

The expected total object size of the multipart upload request. If there’s a mismatch between the specified object size value and the actual object size value, it results in an HTTP 400 InvalidRequest error.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-mp-object-size" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "IfMatch":{ "shape":"IfMatch", "documentation":"

Uploads the object only if the ETag (entity tag) value provided during the WRITE operation matches the ETag of the object in S3. If the ETag values do not match, the operation returns a 412 Precondition Failed error.

If a conflicting operation occurs during the upload S3 returns a 409 ConditionalRequestConflict response. On a 409 failure you should fetch the object's ETag, re-initiate the multipart upload with CreateMultipartUpload, and re-upload each part.

Expects the ETag value as a string.

For more information about conditional requests, see RFC 7232, or Conditional requests in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-Match" }, "IfNoneMatch":{ "shape":"IfNoneMatch", "documentation":"

Uploads the object only if the object key name does not already exist in the bucket specified. Otherwise, Amazon S3 returns a 412 Precondition Failed error.

If a conflicting operation occurs during the upload S3 returns a 409 ConditionalRequestConflict response. On a 409 failure you should re-initiate the multipart upload with CreateMultipartUpload and re-upload each part.

Expects the '*' (asterisk) character.

For more information about conditional requests, see RFC 7232, or Conditional requests in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-None-Match" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption (SSE) algorithm used to encrypt the object. This parameter is required only when the object was created using a checksum algorithm or if your bucket policy requires the use of SSE-C. For more information, see Protecting data using SSE-C keys in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKey":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKey", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption (SSE) customer managed key. This parameter is needed only when the object was created using a checksum algorithm. For more information, see Protecting data using SSE-C keys in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

The MD5 server-side encryption (SSE) customer managed key. This parameter is needed only when the object was created using a checksum algorithm. For more information, see Protecting data using SSE-C keys in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" } }, "payload":"MultipartUpload" }, "CompletedMultipartUpload":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Parts":{ "shape":"CompletedPartList", "documentation":"

Array of CompletedPart data types.

If you do not supply a valid Part with your request, the service sends back an HTTP 400 response.

", "locationName":"Part" } }, "documentation":"

The container for the completed multipart upload details.

" }, "CompletedPart":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ETag":{ "shape":"ETag", "documentation":"

Entity tag returned when the part was uploaded.

" }, "ChecksumCRC32":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32 checksum of the part. This checksum is present if the multipart upload request was created with the CRC32 checksum algorithm. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumCRC32C":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32C", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32C checksum of the part. This checksum is present if the multipart upload request was created with the CRC32C checksum algorithm. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumCRC64NVME":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC64NVME", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 64-bit CRC64NVME checksum of the part. This checksum is present if the multipart upload request was created with the CRC64NVME checksum algorithm to the uploaded object). For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumSHA1":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA1", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 160-bit SHA1 checksum of the part. This checksum is present if the multipart upload request was created with the SHA1 checksum algorithm. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumSHA256":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA256", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 256-bit SHA256 checksum of the part. This checksum is present if the multipart upload request was created with the SHA256 checksum algorithm. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "PartNumber":{ "shape":"PartNumber", "documentation":"

Part number that identifies the part. This is a positive integer between 1 and 10,000.

" } }, "documentation":"

Details of the parts that were uploaded.

" }, "CompletedPartList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"CompletedPart"}, "flattened":true }, "CompressionType":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "NONE", "GZIP", "BZIP2" ] }, "Condition":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "HttpErrorCodeReturnedEquals":{ "shape":"HttpErrorCodeReturnedEquals", "documentation":"

The HTTP error code when the redirect is applied. In the event of an error, if the error code equals this value, then the specified redirect is applied. Required when parent element Condition is specified and sibling KeyPrefixEquals is not specified. If both are specified, then both must be true for the redirect to be applied.

" }, "KeyPrefixEquals":{ "shape":"KeyPrefixEquals", "documentation":"

The object key name prefix when the redirect is applied. For example, to redirect requests for ExamplePage.html, the key prefix will be ExamplePage.html. To redirect request for all pages with the prefix docs/, the key prefix will be /docs, which identifies all objects in the docs/ folder. Required when the parent element Condition is specified and sibling HttpErrorCodeReturnedEquals is not specified. If both conditions are specified, both must be true for the redirect to be applied.

Replacement must be made for object keys containing special characters (such as carriage returns) when using XML requests. For more information, see XML related object key constraints.

" } }, "documentation":"

A container for describing a condition that must be met for the specified redirect to apply. For example, 1. If request is for pages in the /docs folder, redirect to the /documents folder. 2. If request results in HTTP error 4xx, redirect request to another host where you might process the error.

" }, "ConfirmRemoveSelfBucketAccess":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "ContentDisposition":{"type":"string"}, "ContentEncoding":{"type":"string"}, "ContentLanguage":{"type":"string"}, "ContentLength":{"type":"long"}, "ContentMD5":{"type":"string"}, "ContentRange":{"type":"string"}, "ContentType":{"type":"string"}, "ContinuationEvent":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

", "event":true }, "CopyObjectOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "CopyObjectResult":{ "shape":"CopyObjectResult", "documentation":"

Container for all response elements.

" }, "Expiration":{ "shape":"Expiration", "documentation":"

If the object expiration is configured, the response includes this header.

Object expiration information is not returned in directory buckets and this header returns the value \"NotImplemented\" in all responses for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expiration" }, "CopySourceVersionId":{ "shape":"CopySourceVersionId", "documentation":"

Version ID of the source object that was copied.

This functionality is not supported when the source object is in a directory bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-version-id" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

Version ID of the newly created copy.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-version-id" }, "ServerSideEncryption":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryption", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption algorithm used when you store this object in Amazon S3 or Amazon FSx.

When accessing data stored in Amazon FSx file systems using S3 access points, the only valid server side encryption option is aws:fsx.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested, the response will include this header to confirm the encryption algorithm that's used.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested, the response will include this header to provide the round-trip message integrity verification of the customer-provided encryption key.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "SSEKMSKeyId":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

If present, indicates the ID of the KMS key that was used for object encryption.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" }, "SSEKMSEncryptionContext":{ "shape":"SSEKMSEncryptionContext", "documentation":"

If present, indicates the Amazon Web Services KMS Encryption Context to use for object encryption. The value of this header is a Base64 encoded UTF-8 string holding JSON with the encryption context key-value pairs.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-context" }, "BucketKeyEnabled":{ "shape":"BucketKeyEnabled", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the copied object uses an S3 Bucket Key for server-side encryption with Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-bucket-key-enabled" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } }, "payload":"CopyObjectResult" }, "CopyObjectRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "CopySource", "Key" ], "members":{ "ACL":{ "shape":"ObjectCannedACL", "documentation":"

The canned access control list (ACL) to apply to the object.

When you copy an object, the ACL metadata is not preserved and is set to private by default. Only the owner has full access control. To override the default ACL setting, specify a new ACL when you generate a copy request. For more information, see Using ACLs.

If the destination bucket that you're copying objects to uses the bucket owner enforced setting for S3 Object Ownership, ACLs are disabled and no longer affect permissions. Buckets that use this setting only accept PUT requests that don't specify an ACL or PUT requests that specify bucket owner full control ACLs, such as the bucket-owner-full-control canned ACL or an equivalent form of this ACL expressed in the XML format. For more information, see Controlling ownership of objects and disabling ACLs in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-acl" }, "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the destination bucket.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Copying objects across different Amazon Web Services Regions isn't supported when the source or destination bucket is in Amazon Web Services Local Zones. The source and destination buckets must have the same parent Amazon Web Services Region. Otherwise, you get an HTTP 400 Bad Request error with the error code InvalidRequest.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must use the Outpost bucket access point ARN or the access point alias for the destination bucket. You can only copy objects within the same Outpost bucket. It's not supported to copy objects across different Amazon Web Services Outposts, between buckets on the same Outposts, or between Outposts buckets and any other bucket types. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the S3 on Outposts guide. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts through the REST API, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname, in the format AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. The hostname isn't required when you use the Amazon Web Services CLI or SDKs.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "CacheControl":{ "shape":"CacheControl", "documentation":"

Specifies the caching behavior along the request/reply chain.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Cache-Control" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm that you want Amazon S3 to use to create the checksum for the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

When you copy an object, if the source object has a checksum, that checksum value will be copied to the new object by default. If the CopyObject request does not include this x-amz-checksum-algorithm header, the checksum algorithm will be copied from the source object to the destination object (if it's present on the source object). You can optionally specify a different checksum algorithm to use with the x-amz-checksum-algorithm header. Unrecognized or unsupported values will respond with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request.

For directory buckets, when you use Amazon Web Services SDKs, CRC32 is the default checksum algorithm that's used for performance.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-algorithm" }, "ContentDisposition":{ "shape":"ContentDisposition", "documentation":"

Specifies presentational information for the object. Indicates whether an object should be displayed in a web browser or downloaded as a file. It allows specifying the desired filename for the downloaded file.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Disposition" }, "ContentEncoding":{ "shape":"ContentEncoding", "documentation":"

Specifies what content encodings have been applied to the object and thus what decoding mechanisms must be applied to obtain the media-type referenced by the Content-Type header field.

For directory buckets, only the aws-chunked value is supported in this header field.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Encoding" }, "ContentLanguage":{ "shape":"ContentLanguage", "documentation":"

The language the content is in.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Language" }, "ContentType":{ "shape":"ContentType", "documentation":"

A standard MIME type that describes the format of the object data.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Type" }, "CopySource":{ "shape":"CopySource", "documentation":"

Specifies the source object for the copy operation. The source object can be up to 5 GB. If the source object is an object that was uploaded by using a multipart upload, the object copy will be a single part object after the source object is copied to the destination bucket.

You specify the value of the copy source in one of two formats, depending on whether you want to access the source object through an access point:

If your source bucket versioning is enabled, the x-amz-copy-source header by default identifies the current version of an object to copy. If the current version is a delete marker, Amazon S3 behaves as if the object was deleted. To copy a different version, use the versionId query parameter. Specifically, append ?versionId=<version-id> to the value (for example, awsexamplebucket/reports/january.pdf?versionId=QUpfdndhfd8438MNFDN93jdnJFkdmqnh893). If you don't specify a version ID, Amazon S3 copies the latest version of the source object.

If you enable versioning on the destination bucket, Amazon S3 generates a unique version ID for the copied object. This version ID is different from the version ID of the source object. Amazon S3 returns the version ID of the copied object in the x-amz-version-id response header in the response.

If you do not enable versioning or suspend it on the destination bucket, the version ID that Amazon S3 generates in the x-amz-version-id response header is always null.

Directory buckets - S3 Versioning isn't enabled and supported for directory buckets.

", "contextParam":{"name":"CopySource"}, "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source" }, "CopySourceIfMatch":{ "shape":"CopySourceIfMatch", "documentation":"

Copies the object if its entity tag (ETag) matches the specified tag.

If both the x-amz-copy-source-if-match and x-amz-copy-source-if-unmodified-since headers are present in the request and evaluate as follows, Amazon S3 returns 200 OK and copies the data:

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-if-match" }, "CopySourceIfModifiedSince":{ "shape":"CopySourceIfModifiedSince", "documentation":"

Copies the object if it has been modified since the specified time.

If both the x-amz-copy-source-if-none-match and x-amz-copy-source-if-modified-since headers are present in the request and evaluate as follows, Amazon S3 returns the 412 Precondition Failed response code:

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-if-modified-since" }, "CopySourceIfNoneMatch":{ "shape":"CopySourceIfNoneMatch", "documentation":"

Copies the object if its entity tag (ETag) is different than the specified ETag.

If both the x-amz-copy-source-if-none-match and x-amz-copy-source-if-modified-since headers are present in the request and evaluate as follows, Amazon S3 returns the 412 Precondition Failed response code:

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-if-none-match" }, "CopySourceIfUnmodifiedSince":{ "shape":"CopySourceIfUnmodifiedSince", "documentation":"

Copies the object if it hasn't been modified since the specified time.

If both the x-amz-copy-source-if-match and x-amz-copy-source-if-unmodified-since headers are present in the request and evaluate as follows, Amazon S3 returns 200 OK and copies the data:

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-if-unmodified-since" }, "Expires":{ "shape":"Expires", "documentation":"

The date and time at which the object is no longer cacheable.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Expires" }, "GrantFullControl":{ "shape":"GrantFullControl", "documentation":"

Gives the grantee READ, READ_ACP, and WRITE_ACP permissions on the object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-full-control" }, "GrantRead":{ "shape":"GrantRead", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to read the object data and its metadata.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-read" }, "GrantReadACP":{ "shape":"GrantReadACP", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to read the object ACL.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-read-acp" }, "GrantWriteACP":{ "shape":"GrantWriteACP", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to write the ACL for the applicable object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-write-acp" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The key of the destination object.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Key"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "Metadata":{ "shape":"Metadata", "documentation":"

A map of metadata to store with the object in S3.

", "location":"headers", "locationName":"x-amz-meta-" }, "MetadataDirective":{ "shape":"MetadataDirective", "documentation":"

Specifies whether the metadata is copied from the source object or replaced with metadata that's provided in the request. When copying an object, you can preserve all metadata (the default) or specify new metadata. If this header isn’t specified, COPY is the default behavior.

General purpose bucket - For general purpose buckets, when you grant permissions, you can use the s3:x-amz-metadata-directive condition key to enforce certain metadata behavior when objects are uploaded. For more information, see Amazon S3 condition key examples in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

x-amz-website-redirect-location is unique to each object and is not copied when using the x-amz-metadata-directive header. To copy the value, you must specify x-amz-website-redirect-location in the request header.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-metadata-directive" }, "TaggingDirective":{ "shape":"TaggingDirective", "documentation":"

Specifies whether the object tag-set is copied from the source object or replaced with the tag-set that's provided in the request.

The default value is COPY.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets in a CopyObject operation, only the empty tag-set is supported. Any requests that attempt to write non-empty tags into directory buckets will receive a 501 Not Implemented status code. When the destination bucket is a directory bucket, you will receive a 501 Not Implemented response in any of the following situations:

Because only the empty tag-set is supported for directory buckets in a CopyObject operation, the following situations are allowed:

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-tagging-directive" }, "ServerSideEncryption":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryption", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in Amazon S3. Unrecognized or unsupported values won’t write a destination object and will receive a 400 Bad Request response.

Amazon S3 automatically encrypts all new objects that are copied to an S3 bucket. When copying an object, if you don't specify encryption information in your copy request, the encryption setting of the target object is set to the default encryption configuration of the destination bucket. By default, all buckets have a base level of encryption configuration that uses server-side encryption with Amazon S3 managed keys (SSE-S3). If the destination bucket has a different default encryption configuration, Amazon S3 uses the corresponding encryption key to encrypt the target object copy.

With server-side encryption, Amazon S3 encrypts your data as it writes your data to disks in its data centers and decrypts the data when you access it. For more information about server-side encryption, see Using Server-Side Encryption in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

General purpose buckets

Directory buckets

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption" }, "StorageClass":{ "shape":"StorageClass", "documentation":"

If the x-amz-storage-class header is not used, the copied object will be stored in the STANDARD Storage Class by default. The STANDARD storage class provides high durability and high availability. Depending on performance needs, you can specify a different Storage Class.

You can use the CopyObject action to change the storage class of an object that is already stored in Amazon S3 by using the x-amz-storage-class header. For more information, see Storage Classes in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Before using an object as a source object for the copy operation, you must restore a copy of it if it meets any of the following conditions:

For more information, see RestoreObject and Copying Objects in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-storage-class" }, "WebsiteRedirectLocation":{ "shape":"WebsiteRedirectLocation", "documentation":"

If the destination bucket is configured as a website, redirects requests for this object copy to another object in the same bucket or to an external URL. Amazon S3 stores the value of this header in the object metadata. This value is unique to each object and is not copied when using the x-amz-metadata-directive header. Instead, you may opt to provide this header in combination with the x-amz-metadata-directive header.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-website-redirect-location" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Specifies the algorithm to use when encrypting the object (for example, AES256).

When you perform a CopyObject operation, if you want to use a different type of encryption setting for the target object, you can specify appropriate encryption-related headers to encrypt the target object with an Amazon S3 managed key, a KMS key, or a customer-provided key. If the encryption setting in your request is different from the default encryption configuration of the destination bucket, the encryption setting in your request takes precedence.

This functionality is not supported when the destination bucket is a directory bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKey":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKey", "documentation":"

Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use in encrypting data. This value is used to store the object and then it is discarded. Amazon S3 does not store the encryption key. The key must be appropriate for use with the algorithm specified in the x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm header.

This functionality is not supported when the destination bucket is a directory bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321. Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure that the encryption key was transmitted without error.

This functionality is not supported when the destination bucket is a directory bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "SSEKMSKeyId":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

Specifies the KMS key ID (Key ID, Key ARN, or Key Alias) to use for object encryption. All GET and PUT requests for an object protected by KMS will fail if they're not made via SSL or using SigV4. For information about configuring any of the officially supported Amazon Web Services SDKs and Amazon Web Services CLI, see Specifying the Signature Version in Request Authentication in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory buckets - To encrypt data using SSE-KMS, it's recommended to specify the x-amz-server-side-encryption header to aws:kms. Then, the x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id header implicitly uses the bucket's default KMS customer managed key ID. If you want to explicitly set the x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id header, it must match the bucket's default customer managed key (using key ID or ARN, not alias). Your SSE-KMS configuration can only support 1 customer managed key per directory bucket's lifetime. The Amazon Web Services managed key (aws/s3) isn't supported. Incorrect key specification results in an HTTP 400 Bad Request error.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" }, "SSEKMSEncryptionContext":{ "shape":"SSEKMSEncryptionContext", "documentation":"

Specifies the Amazon Web Services KMS Encryption Context as an additional encryption context to use for the destination object encryption. The value of this header is a base64-encoded UTF-8 string holding JSON with the encryption context key-value pairs.

General purpose buckets - This value must be explicitly added to specify encryption context for CopyObject requests if you want an additional encryption context for your destination object. The additional encryption context of the source object won't be copied to the destination object. For more information, see Encryption context in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory buckets - You can optionally provide an explicit encryption context value. The value must match the default encryption context - the bucket Amazon Resource Name (ARN). An additional encryption context value is not supported.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-context" }, "BucketKeyEnabled":{ "shape":"BucketKeyEnabled", "documentation":"

Specifies whether Amazon S3 should use an S3 Bucket Key for object encryption with server-side encryption using Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS). If a target object uses SSE-KMS, you can enable an S3 Bucket Key for the object.

Setting this header to true causes Amazon S3 to use an S3 Bucket Key for object encryption with SSE-KMS. Specifying this header with a COPY action doesn’t affect bucket-level settings for S3 Bucket Key.

For more information, see Amazon S3 Bucket Keys in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory buckets - S3 Bucket Keys aren't supported, when you copy SSE-KMS encrypted objects from general purpose buckets to directory buckets, from directory buckets to general purpose buckets, or between directory buckets, through CopyObject. In this case, Amazon S3 makes a call to KMS every time a copy request is made for a KMS-encrypted object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-bucket-key-enabled" }, "CopySourceSSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"CopySourceSSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Specifies the algorithm to use when decrypting the source object (for example, AES256).

If the source object for the copy is stored in Amazon S3 using SSE-C, you must provide the necessary encryption information in your request so that Amazon S3 can decrypt the object for copying.

This functionality is not supported when the source object is in a directory bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "CopySourceSSECustomerKey":{ "shape":"CopySourceSSECustomerKey", "documentation":"

Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use to decrypt the source object. The encryption key provided in this header must be the same one that was used when the source object was created.

If the source object for the copy is stored in Amazon S3 using SSE-C, you must provide the necessary encryption information in your request so that Amazon S3 can decrypt the object for copying.

This functionality is not supported when the source object is in a directory bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-server-side-encryption-customer-key" }, "CopySourceSSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"CopySourceSSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321. Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure that the encryption key was transmitted without error.

If the source object for the copy is stored in Amazon S3 using SSE-C, you must provide the necessary encryption information in your request so that Amazon S3 can decrypt the object for copying.

This functionality is not supported when the source object is in a directory bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "Tagging":{ "shape":"TaggingHeader", "documentation":"

The tag-set for the object copy in the destination bucket. This value must be used in conjunction with the x-amz-tagging-directive if you choose REPLACE for the x-amz-tagging-directive. If you choose COPY for the x-amz-tagging-directive, you don't need to set the x-amz-tagging header, because the tag-set will be copied from the source object directly. The tag-set must be encoded as URL Query parameters.

The default value is the empty value.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets in a CopyObject operation, only the empty tag-set is supported. Any requests that attempt to write non-empty tags into directory buckets will receive a 501 Not Implemented status code. When the destination bucket is a directory bucket, you will receive a 501 Not Implemented response in any of the following situations:

Because only the empty tag-set is supported for directory buckets in a CopyObject operation, the following situations are allowed:

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-tagging" }, "ObjectLockMode":{ "shape":"ObjectLockMode", "documentation":"

The Object Lock mode that you want to apply to the object copy.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-lock-mode" }, "ObjectLockRetainUntilDate":{ "shape":"ObjectLockRetainUntilDate", "documentation":"

The date and time when you want the Object Lock of the object copy to expire.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-lock-retain-until-date" }, "ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus":{ "shape":"ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus", "documentation":"

Specifies whether you want to apply a legal hold to the object copy.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-lock-legal-hold" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected destination bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the destination bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "ExpectedSourceBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected source bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the source bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-source-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "CopyObjectResult":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ETag":{ "shape":"ETag", "documentation":"

Returns the ETag of the new object. The ETag reflects only changes to the contents of an object, not its metadata.

" }, "LastModified":{ "shape":"LastModified", "documentation":"

Creation date of the object.

" }, "ChecksumType":{ "shape":"ChecksumType", "documentation":"

The checksum type that is used to calculate the object’s checksum value. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumCRC32":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32 checksum of the object. This checksum is only present if the object was uploaded with the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumCRC32C":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32C", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32C checksum of the object. This will only be present if the object was uploaded with the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumCRC64NVME":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC64NVME", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 64-bit CRC64NVME checksum of the object. This checksum is present if the object being copied was uploaded with the CRC64NVME checksum algorithm, or if the object was uploaded without a checksum (and Amazon S3 added the default checksum, CRC64NVME, to the uploaded object). For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumSHA1":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA1", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 160-bit SHA1 digest of the object. This will only be present if the object was uploaded with the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumSHA256":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA256", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 256-bit SHA256 digest of the object. This will only be present if the object was uploaded with the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for all response elements.

" }, "CopyPartResult":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ETag":{ "shape":"ETag", "documentation":"

Entity tag of the object.

" }, "LastModified":{ "shape":"LastModified", "documentation":"

Date and time at which the object was uploaded.

" }, "ChecksumCRC32":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32 checksum of the part. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumCRC32C":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32C", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32C checksum of the part. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumCRC64NVME":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC64NVME", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 64-bit CRC64NVME checksum of the part. This checksum is present if the multipart upload request was created with the CRC64NVME checksum algorithm to the uploaded object). For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumSHA1":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA1", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 160-bit SHA1 checksum of the part. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumSHA256":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA256", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 256-bit SHA256 checksum of the part. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for all response elements.

" }, "CopySource":{ "type":"string", "pattern":"\\/?.+\\/.+" }, "CopySourceIfMatch":{"type":"string"}, "CopySourceIfModifiedSince":{"type":"timestamp"}, "CopySourceIfNoneMatch":{"type":"string"}, "CopySourceIfUnmodifiedSince":{"type":"timestamp"}, "CopySourceRange":{"type":"string"}, "CopySourceSSECustomerAlgorithm":{"type":"string"}, "CopySourceSSECustomerKey":{ "type":"string", "sensitive":true }, "CopySourceSSECustomerKeyMD5":{"type":"string"}, "CopySourceVersionId":{"type":"string"}, "CreateBucketConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "LocationConstraint":{ "shape":"BucketLocationConstraint", "documentation":"

Specifies the Region where the bucket will be created. You might choose a Region to optimize latency, minimize costs, or address regulatory requirements. For example, if you reside in Europe, you will probably find it advantageous to create buckets in the Europe (Ireland) Region.

If you don't specify a Region, the bucket is created in the US East (N. Virginia) Region (us-east-1) by default. Configurations using the value EU will create a bucket in eu-west-1.

For a list of the valid values for all of the Amazon Web Services Regions, see Regions and Endpoints.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

" }, "Location":{ "shape":"LocationInfo", "documentation":"

Specifies the location where the bucket will be created.

Directory buckets - The location type is Availability Zone or Local Zone. To use the Local Zone location type, your account must be enabled for Local Zones. Otherwise, you get an HTTP 403 Forbidden error with the error code AccessDenied. To learn more, see Enable accounts for Local Zones in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is only supported by directory buckets.

" }, "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketInfo", "documentation":"

Specifies the information about the bucket that will be created.

This functionality is only supported by directory buckets.

" }, "Tags":{ "shape":"TagSet", "documentation":"

An array of tags that you can apply to the bucket that you're creating. Tags are key-value pairs of metadata used to categorize and organize your buckets, track costs, and control access.

This parameter is only supported for S3 directory buckets. For more information, see Using tags with directory buckets.

" } }, "documentation":"

The configuration information for the bucket.

" }, "CreateBucketMetadataConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "MetadataConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The general purpose bucket that you want to create the metadata configuration for.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The Content-MD5 header for the metadata configuration.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

The checksum algorithm to use with your metadata configuration.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "MetadataConfiguration":{ "shape":"MetadataConfiguration", "documentation":"

The contents of your metadata configuration.

", "locationName":"MetadataConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The expected owner of the general purpose bucket that corresponds to your metadata configuration.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"MetadataConfiguration" }, "CreateBucketMetadataTableConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "MetadataTableConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The general purpose bucket that you want to create the metadata table configuration for.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The Content-MD5 header for the metadata table configuration.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

The checksum algorithm to use with your metadata table configuration.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "MetadataTableConfiguration":{ "shape":"MetadataTableConfiguration", "documentation":"

The contents of your metadata table configuration.

", "locationName":"MetadataTableConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The expected owner of the general purpose bucket that corresponds to your metadata table configuration.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"MetadataTableConfiguration" }, "CreateBucketOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Location":{ "shape":"Location", "documentation":"

A forward slash followed by the name of the bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Location" }, "BucketArn":{ "shape":"S3RegionalOrS3ExpressBucketArnString", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the S3 bucket. ARNs uniquely identify Amazon Web Services resources across all of Amazon Web Services.

This parameter is only supported for S3 directory buckets. For more information, see Using tags with directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-bucket-arn" } } }, "CreateBucketRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "ACL":{ "shape":"BucketCannedACL", "documentation":"

The canned ACL to apply to the bucket.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-acl" }, "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket to create.

General purpose buckets - For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use path-style requests in the format https://s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com/bucket-name . Virtual-hosted-style requests aren't supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must also follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, DOC-EXAMPLE-BUCKET--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "CreateBucketConfiguration":{ "shape":"CreateBucketConfiguration", "documentation":"

The configuration information for the bucket.

", "locationName":"CreateBucketConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "GrantFullControl":{ "shape":"GrantFullControl", "documentation":"

Allows grantee the read, write, read ACP, and write ACP permissions on the bucket.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-full-control" }, "GrantRead":{ "shape":"GrantRead", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to list the objects in the bucket.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-read" }, "GrantReadACP":{ "shape":"GrantReadACP", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to read the bucket ACL.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-read-acp" }, "GrantWrite":{ "shape":"GrantWrite", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to create new objects in the bucket.

For the bucket and object owners of existing objects, also allows deletions and overwrites of those objects.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-write" }, "GrantWriteACP":{ "shape":"GrantWriteACP", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to write the ACL for the applicable bucket.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-write-acp" }, "ObjectLockEnabledForBucket":{ "shape":"ObjectLockEnabledForBucket", "documentation":"

Specifies whether you want S3 Object Lock to be enabled for the new bucket.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-bucket-object-lock-enabled" }, "ObjectOwnership":{ "shape":"ObjectOwnership", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-ownership" } }, "payload":"CreateBucketConfiguration" }, "CreateMultipartUploadOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "AbortDate":{ "shape":"AbortDate", "documentation":"

If the bucket has a lifecycle rule configured with an action to abort incomplete multipart uploads and the prefix in the lifecycle rule matches the object name in the request, the response includes this header. The header indicates when the initiated multipart upload becomes eligible for an abort operation. For more information, see Aborting Incomplete Multipart Uploads Using a Bucket Lifecycle Configuration in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

The response also includes the x-amz-abort-rule-id header that provides the ID of the lifecycle configuration rule that defines the abort action.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-abort-date" }, "AbortRuleId":{ "shape":"AbortRuleId", "documentation":"

This header is returned along with the x-amz-abort-date header. It identifies the applicable lifecycle configuration rule that defines the action to abort incomplete multipart uploads.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-abort-rule-id" }, "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket to which the multipart upload was initiated. Does not return the access point ARN or access point alias if used.

Access points are not supported by directory buckets.

", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Object key for which the multipart upload was initiated.

" }, "UploadId":{ "shape":"MultipartUploadId", "documentation":"

ID for the initiated multipart upload.

" }, "ServerSideEncryption":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryption", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption algorithm used when you store this object in Amazon S3 or Amazon FSx.

When accessing data stored in Amazon FSx file systems using S3 access points, the only valid server side encryption option is aws:fsx.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested, the response will include this header to confirm the encryption algorithm that's used.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested, the response will include this header to provide the round-trip message integrity verification of the customer-provided encryption key.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "SSEKMSKeyId":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

If present, indicates the ID of the KMS key that was used for object encryption.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" }, "SSEKMSEncryptionContext":{ "shape":"SSEKMSEncryptionContext", "documentation":"

If present, indicates the Amazon Web Services KMS Encryption Context to use for object encryption. The value of this header is a Base64 encoded string of a UTF-8 encoded JSON, which contains the encryption context as key-value pairs.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-context" }, "BucketKeyEnabled":{ "shape":"BucketKeyEnabled", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the multipart upload uses an S3 Bucket Key for server-side encryption with Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-bucket-key-enabled" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

The algorithm that was used to create a checksum of the object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-algorithm" }, "ChecksumType":{ "shape":"ChecksumType", "documentation":"

Indicates the checksum type that you want Amazon S3 to use to calculate the object’s checksum value. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-type" } } }, "CreateMultipartUploadRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key" ], "members":{ "ACL":{ "shape":"ObjectCannedACL", "documentation":"

The canned ACL to apply to the object. Amazon S3 supports a set of predefined ACLs, known as canned ACLs. Each canned ACL has a predefined set of grantees and permissions. For more information, see Canned ACL in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

By default, all objects are private. Only the owner has full access control. When uploading an object, you can grant access permissions to individual Amazon Web Services accounts or to predefined groups defined by Amazon S3. These permissions are then added to the access control list (ACL) on the new object. For more information, see Using ACLs. One way to grant the permissions using the request headers is to specify a canned ACL with the x-amz-acl request header.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-acl" }, "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket where the multipart upload is initiated and where the object is uploaded.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "CacheControl":{ "shape":"CacheControl", "documentation":"

Specifies caching behavior along the request/reply chain.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Cache-Control" }, "ContentDisposition":{ "shape":"ContentDisposition", "documentation":"

Specifies presentational information for the object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Disposition" }, "ContentEncoding":{ "shape":"ContentEncoding", "documentation":"

Specifies what content encodings have been applied to the object and thus what decoding mechanisms must be applied to obtain the media-type referenced by the Content-Type header field.

For directory buckets, only the aws-chunked value is supported in this header field.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Encoding" }, "ContentLanguage":{ "shape":"ContentLanguage", "documentation":"

The language that the content is in.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Language" }, "ContentType":{ "shape":"ContentType", "documentation":"

A standard MIME type describing the format of the object data.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Type" }, "Expires":{ "shape":"Expires", "documentation":"

The date and time at which the object is no longer cacheable.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Expires" }, "GrantFullControl":{ "shape":"GrantFullControl", "documentation":"

Specify access permissions explicitly to give the grantee READ, READ_ACP, and WRITE_ACP permissions on the object.

By default, all objects are private. Only the owner has full access control. When uploading an object, you can use this header to explicitly grant access permissions to specific Amazon Web Services accounts or groups. This header maps to specific permissions that Amazon S3 supports in an ACL. For more information, see Access Control List (ACL) Overview in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

You specify each grantee as a type=value pair, where the type is one of the following:

For example, the following x-amz-grant-read header grants the Amazon Web Services accounts identified by account IDs permissions to read object data and its metadata:

x-amz-grant-read: id=\"11112222333\", id=\"444455556666\"

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-full-control" }, "GrantRead":{ "shape":"GrantRead", "documentation":"

Specify access permissions explicitly to allow grantee to read the object data and its metadata.

By default, all objects are private. Only the owner has full access control. When uploading an object, you can use this header to explicitly grant access permissions to specific Amazon Web Services accounts or groups. This header maps to specific permissions that Amazon S3 supports in an ACL. For more information, see Access Control List (ACL) Overview in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

You specify each grantee as a type=value pair, where the type is one of the following:

For example, the following x-amz-grant-read header grants the Amazon Web Services accounts identified by account IDs permissions to read object data and its metadata:

x-amz-grant-read: id=\"11112222333\", id=\"444455556666\"

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-read" }, "GrantReadACP":{ "shape":"GrantReadACP", "documentation":"

Specify access permissions explicitly to allows grantee to read the object ACL.

By default, all objects are private. Only the owner has full access control. When uploading an object, you can use this header to explicitly grant access permissions to specific Amazon Web Services accounts or groups. This header maps to specific permissions that Amazon S3 supports in an ACL. For more information, see Access Control List (ACL) Overview in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

You specify each grantee as a type=value pair, where the type is one of the following:

For example, the following x-amz-grant-read header grants the Amazon Web Services accounts identified by account IDs permissions to read object data and its metadata:

x-amz-grant-read: id=\"11112222333\", id=\"444455556666\"

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-read-acp" }, "GrantWriteACP":{ "shape":"GrantWriteACP", "documentation":"

Specify access permissions explicitly to allows grantee to allow grantee to write the ACL for the applicable object.

By default, all objects are private. Only the owner has full access control. When uploading an object, you can use this header to explicitly grant access permissions to specific Amazon Web Services accounts or groups. This header maps to specific permissions that Amazon S3 supports in an ACL. For more information, see Access Control List (ACL) Overview in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

You specify each grantee as a type=value pair, where the type is one of the following:

For example, the following x-amz-grant-read header grants the Amazon Web Services accounts identified by account IDs permissions to read object data and its metadata:

x-amz-grant-read: id=\"11112222333\", id=\"444455556666\"

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-write-acp" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Object key for which the multipart upload is to be initiated.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Key"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "Metadata":{ "shape":"Metadata", "documentation":"

A map of metadata to store with the object in S3.

", "location":"headers", "locationName":"x-amz-meta-" }, "ServerSideEncryption":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryption", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption algorithm used when you store this object in Amazon S3 or Amazon FSx.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption" }, "StorageClass":{ "shape":"StorageClass", "documentation":"

By default, Amazon S3 uses the STANDARD Storage Class to store newly created objects. The STANDARD storage class provides high durability and high availability. Depending on performance needs, you can specify a different Storage Class. For more information, see Storage Classes in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-storage-class" }, "WebsiteRedirectLocation":{ "shape":"WebsiteRedirectLocation", "documentation":"

If the bucket is configured as a website, redirects requests for this object to another object in the same bucket or to an external URL. Amazon S3 stores the value of this header in the object metadata.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-website-redirect-location" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Specifies the algorithm to use when encrypting the object (for example, AES256).

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKey":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKey", "documentation":"

Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use in encrypting data. This value is used to store the object and then it is discarded; Amazon S3 does not store the encryption key. The key must be appropriate for use with the algorithm specified in the x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm header.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the customer-provided encryption key according to RFC 1321. Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure that the encryption key was transmitted without error.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "SSEKMSKeyId":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

Specifies the KMS key ID (Key ID, Key ARN, or Key Alias) to use for object encryption. If the KMS key doesn't exist in the same account that's issuing the command, you must use the full Key ARN not the Key ID.

General purpose buckets - If you specify x-amz-server-side-encryption with aws:kms or aws:kms:dsse, this header specifies the ID (Key ID, Key ARN, or Key Alias) of the KMS key to use. If you specify x-amz-server-side-encryption:aws:kms or x-amz-server-side-encryption:aws:kms:dsse, but do not provide x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id, Amazon S3 uses the Amazon Web Services managed key (aws/s3) to protect the data.

Directory buckets - To encrypt data using SSE-KMS, it's recommended to specify the x-amz-server-side-encryption header to aws:kms. Then, the x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id header implicitly uses the bucket's default KMS customer managed key ID. If you want to explicitly set the x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id header, it must match the bucket's default customer managed key (using key ID or ARN, not alias). Your SSE-KMS configuration can only support 1 customer managed key per directory bucket's lifetime. The Amazon Web Services managed key (aws/s3) isn't supported. Incorrect key specification results in an HTTP 400 Bad Request error.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" }, "SSEKMSEncryptionContext":{ "shape":"SSEKMSEncryptionContext", "documentation":"

Specifies the Amazon Web Services KMS Encryption Context to use for object encryption. The value of this header is a Base64 encoded string of a UTF-8 encoded JSON, which contains the encryption context as key-value pairs.

Directory buckets - You can optionally provide an explicit encryption context value. The value must match the default encryption context - the bucket Amazon Resource Name (ARN). An additional encryption context value is not supported.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-context" }, "BucketKeyEnabled":{ "shape":"BucketKeyEnabled", "documentation":"

Specifies whether Amazon S3 should use an S3 Bucket Key for object encryption with server-side encryption using Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS).

General purpose buckets - Setting this header to true causes Amazon S3 to use an S3 Bucket Key for object encryption with SSE-KMS. Also, specifying this header with a PUT action doesn't affect bucket-level settings for S3 Bucket Key.

Directory buckets - S3 Bucket Keys are always enabled for GET and PUT operations in a directory bucket and can’t be disabled. S3 Bucket Keys aren't supported, when you copy SSE-KMS encrypted objects from general purpose buckets to directory buckets, from directory buckets to general purpose buckets, or between directory buckets, through CopyObject, UploadPartCopy, the Copy operation in Batch Operations, or the import jobs. In this case, Amazon S3 makes a call to KMS every time a copy request is made for a KMS-encrypted object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-bucket-key-enabled" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "Tagging":{ "shape":"TaggingHeader", "documentation":"

The tag-set for the object. The tag-set must be encoded as URL Query parameters.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-tagging" }, "ObjectLockMode":{ "shape":"ObjectLockMode", "documentation":"

Specifies the Object Lock mode that you want to apply to the uploaded object.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-lock-mode" }, "ObjectLockRetainUntilDate":{ "shape":"ObjectLockRetainUntilDate", "documentation":"

Specifies the date and time when you want the Object Lock to expire.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-lock-retain-until-date" }, "ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus":{ "shape":"ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus", "documentation":"

Specifies whether you want to apply a legal hold to the uploaded object.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-lock-legal-hold" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm that you want Amazon S3 to use to create the checksum for the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-algorithm" }, "ChecksumType":{ "shape":"ChecksumType", "documentation":"

Indicates the checksum type that you want Amazon S3 to use to calculate the object’s checksum value. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-type" } } }, "CreateSessionOutput":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Credentials"], "members":{ "ServerSideEncryption":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryption", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption algorithm used when you store objects in the directory bucket.

When accessing data stored in Amazon FSx file systems using S3 access points, the only valid server side encryption option is aws:fsx.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption" }, "SSEKMSKeyId":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

If you specify x-amz-server-side-encryption with aws:kms, this header indicates the ID of the KMS symmetric encryption customer managed key that was used for object encryption.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" }, "SSEKMSEncryptionContext":{ "shape":"SSEKMSEncryptionContext", "documentation":"

If present, indicates the Amazon Web Services KMS Encryption Context to use for object encryption. The value of this header is a Base64 encoded string of a UTF-8 encoded JSON, which contains the encryption context as key-value pairs. This value is stored as object metadata and automatically gets passed on to Amazon Web Services KMS for future GetObject operations on this object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-context" }, "BucketKeyEnabled":{ "shape":"BucketKeyEnabled", "documentation":"

Indicates whether to use an S3 Bucket Key for server-side encryption with KMS keys (SSE-KMS).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-bucket-key-enabled" }, "Credentials":{ "shape":"SessionCredentials", "documentation":"

The established temporary security credentials for the created session.

", "locationName":"Credentials" } } }, "CreateSessionRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "SessionMode":{ "shape":"SessionMode", "documentation":"

Specifies the mode of the session that will be created, either ReadWrite or ReadOnly. By default, a ReadWrite session is created. A ReadWrite session is capable of executing all the Zonal endpoint API operations on a directory bucket. A ReadOnly session is constrained to execute the following Zonal endpoint API operations: GetObject, HeadObject, ListObjectsV2, GetObjectAttributes, ListParts, and ListMultipartUploads.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-create-session-mode" }, "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket that you create a session for.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ServerSideEncryption":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryption", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption algorithm to use when you store objects in the directory bucket.

For directory buckets, there are only two supported options for server-side encryption: server-side encryption with Amazon S3 managed keys (SSE-S3) (AES256) and server-side encryption with KMS keys (SSE-KMS) (aws:kms). By default, Amazon S3 encrypts data with SSE-S3. For more information, see Protecting data with server-side encryption in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

S3 access points for Amazon FSx - When accessing data stored in Amazon FSx file systems using S3 access points, the only valid server side encryption option is aws:fsx. All Amazon FSx file systems have encryption configured by default and are encrypted at rest. Data is automatically encrypted before being written to the file system, and automatically decrypted as it is read. These processes are handled transparently by Amazon FSx.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption" }, "SSEKMSKeyId":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

If you specify x-amz-server-side-encryption with aws:kms, you must specify the x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id header with the ID (Key ID or Key ARN) of the KMS symmetric encryption customer managed key to use. Otherwise, you get an HTTP 400 Bad Request error. Only use the key ID or key ARN. The key alias format of the KMS key isn't supported. Also, if the KMS key doesn't exist in the same account that't issuing the command, you must use the full Key ARN not the Key ID.

Your SSE-KMS configuration can only support 1 customer managed key per directory bucket's lifetime. The Amazon Web Services managed key (aws/s3) isn't supported.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" }, "SSEKMSEncryptionContext":{ "shape":"SSEKMSEncryptionContext", "documentation":"

Specifies the Amazon Web Services KMS Encryption Context as an additional encryption context to use for object encryption. The value of this header is a Base64 encoded string of a UTF-8 encoded JSON, which contains the encryption context as key-value pairs. This value is stored as object metadata and automatically gets passed on to Amazon Web Services KMS for future GetObject operations on this object.

General purpose buckets - This value must be explicitly added during CopyObject operations if you want an additional encryption context for your object. For more information, see Encryption context in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory buckets - You can optionally provide an explicit encryption context value. The value must match the default encryption context - the bucket Amazon Resource Name (ARN). An additional encryption context value is not supported.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-context" }, "BucketKeyEnabled":{ "shape":"BucketKeyEnabled", "documentation":"

Specifies whether Amazon S3 should use an S3 Bucket Key for object encryption with server-side encryption using KMS keys (SSE-KMS).

S3 Bucket Keys are always enabled for GET and PUT operations in a directory bucket and can’t be disabled. S3 Bucket Keys aren't supported, when you copy SSE-KMS encrypted objects from general purpose buckets to directory buckets, from directory buckets to general purpose buckets, or between directory buckets, through CopyObject, UploadPartCopy, the Copy operation in Batch Operations, or the import jobs. In this case, Amazon S3 makes a call to KMS every time a copy request is made for a KMS-encrypted object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-bucket-key-enabled" } } }, "CreationDate":{"type":"timestamp"}, "DataRedundancy":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "SingleAvailabilityZone", "SingleLocalZone" ] }, "Date":{ "type":"timestamp", "timestampFormat":"iso8601" }, "Days":{ "type":"integer", "box":true }, "DaysAfterInitiation":{ "type":"integer", "box":true }, "DefaultRetention":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Mode":{ "shape":"ObjectLockRetentionMode", "documentation":"

The default Object Lock retention mode you want to apply to new objects placed in the specified bucket. Must be used with either Days or Years.

" }, "Days":{ "shape":"Days", "documentation":"

The number of days that you want to specify for the default retention period. Must be used with Mode.

" }, "Years":{ "shape":"Years", "documentation":"

The number of years that you want to specify for the default retention period. Must be used with Mode.

" } }, "documentation":"

The container element for optionally specifying the default Object Lock retention settings for new objects placed in the specified bucket.

" }, "Delete":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Objects"], "members":{ "Objects":{ "shape":"ObjectIdentifierList", "documentation":"

The object to delete.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, an object that's composed entirely of whitespace characters is not supported by the DeleteObjects API operation. The request will receive a 400 Bad Request error and none of the objects in the request will be deleted.

", "locationName":"Object" }, "Quiet":{ "shape":"Quiet", "documentation":"

Element to enable quiet mode for the request. When you add this element, you must set its value to true.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for the objects to delete.

" }, "DeleteBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Id" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket from which an analytics configuration is deleted.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Id":{ "shape":"AnalyticsId", "documentation":"

The ID that identifies the analytics configuration.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"id" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeleteBucketCorsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

Specifies the bucket whose cors configuration is being deleted.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeleteBucketEncryptionRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket containing the server-side encryption configuration to delete.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use path-style requests in the format https://s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com/bucket-name . Virtual-hosted-style requests aren't supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must also follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, DOC-EXAMPLE-BUCKET--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

For directory buckets, this header is not supported in this API operation. If you specify this header, the request fails with the HTTP status code 501 Not Implemented.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeleteBucketIntelligentTieringConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Id" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the Amazon S3 bucket whose configuration you want to modify or retrieve.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Id":{ "shape":"IntelligentTieringId", "documentation":"

The ID used to identify the S3 Intelligent-Tiering configuration.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"id" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeleteBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Id" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket containing the inventory configuration to delete.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Id":{ "shape":"InventoryId", "documentation":"

The ID used to identify the inventory configuration.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"id" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeleteBucketLifecycleRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name of the lifecycle to delete.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

This parameter applies to general purpose buckets only. It is not supported for directory bucket lifecycle configurations.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeleteBucketMetadataConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The general purpose bucket that you want to remove the metadata configuration from.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The expected bucket owner of the general purpose bucket that you want to remove the metadata table configuration from.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeleteBucketMetadataTableConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The general purpose bucket that you want to remove the metadata table configuration from.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The expected bucket owner of the general purpose bucket that you want to remove the metadata table configuration from.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeleteBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Id" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket containing the metrics configuration to delete.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Id":{ "shape":"MetricsId", "documentation":"

The ID used to identify the metrics configuration. The ID has a 64 character limit and can only contain letters, numbers, periods, dashes, and underscores.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"id" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeleteBucketOwnershipControlsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The Amazon S3 bucket whose OwnershipControls you want to delete.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeleteBucketPolicyRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use path-style requests in the format https://s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com/bucket-name . Virtual-hosted-style requests aren't supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must also follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, DOC-EXAMPLE-BUCKET--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

For directory buckets, this header is not supported in this API operation. If you specify this header, the request fails with the HTTP status code 501 Not Implemented.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeleteBucketReplicationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeleteBucketRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

Specifies the bucket being deleted.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use path-style requests in the format https://s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com/bucket-name . Virtual-hosted-style requests aren't supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must also follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, DOC-EXAMPLE-BUCKET--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

For directory buckets, this header is not supported in this API operation. If you specify this header, the request fails with the HTTP status code 501 Not Implemented.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeleteBucketTaggingRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket that has the tag set to be removed.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeleteBucketWebsiteRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name for which you want to remove the website configuration.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeleteMarker":{"type":"boolean"}, "DeleteMarkerEntry":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Owner":{ "shape":"Owner", "documentation":"

The account that created the delete marker.

" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The object key.

" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

Version ID of an object.

" }, "IsLatest":{ "shape":"IsLatest", "documentation":"

Specifies whether the object is (true) or is not (false) the latest version of an object.

" }, "LastModified":{ "shape":"LastModified", "documentation":"

Date and time when the object was last modified.

" } }, "documentation":"

Information about the delete marker.

" }, "DeleteMarkerReplication":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Status":{ "shape":"DeleteMarkerReplicationStatus", "documentation":"

Indicates whether to replicate delete markers.

Indicates whether to replicate delete markers.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies whether Amazon S3 replicates delete markers. If you specify a Filter in your replication configuration, you must also include a DeleteMarkerReplication element. If your Filter includes a Tag element, the DeleteMarkerReplication Status must be set to Disabled, because Amazon S3 does not support replicating delete markers for tag-based rules. For an example configuration, see Basic Rule Configuration.

For more information about delete marker replication, see Basic Rule Configuration.

If you are using an earlier version of the replication configuration, Amazon S3 handles replication of delete markers differently. For more information, see Backward Compatibility.

" }, "DeleteMarkerReplicationStatus":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Enabled", "Disabled" ] }, "DeleteMarkerVersionId":{"type":"string"}, "DeleteMarkers":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"DeleteMarkerEntry"}, "flattened":true }, "DeleteObjectOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "DeleteMarker":{ "shape":"DeleteMarker", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the specified object version that was permanently deleted was (true) or was not (false) a delete marker before deletion. In a simple DELETE, this header indicates whether (true) or not (false) the current version of the object is a delete marker. To learn more about delete markers, see Working with delete markers.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-delete-marker" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

Returns the version ID of the delete marker created as a result of the DELETE operation.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-version-id" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } } }, "DeleteObjectRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name of the bucket containing the object.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Key name of the object to delete.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Key"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "MFA":{ "shape":"MFA", "documentation":"

The concatenation of the authentication device's serial number, a space, and the value that is displayed on your authentication device. Required to permanently delete a versioned object if versioning is configured with MFA delete enabled.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-mfa" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

Version ID used to reference a specific version of the object.

For directory buckets in this API operation, only the null value of the version ID is supported.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"versionId" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "BypassGovernanceRetention":{ "shape":"BypassGovernanceRetention", "documentation":"

Indicates whether S3 Object Lock should bypass Governance-mode restrictions to process this operation. To use this header, you must have the s3:BypassGovernanceRetention permission.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-bypass-governance-retention" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "IfMatch":{ "shape":"IfMatch", "documentation":"

The If-Match header field makes the request method conditional on ETags. If the ETag value does not match, the operation returns a 412 Precondition Failed error. If the ETag matches or if the object doesn't exist, the operation will return a 204 Success (No Content) response.

For more information about conditional requests, see RFC 7232.

This functionality is only supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-Match" }, "IfMatchLastModifiedTime":{ "shape":"IfMatchLastModifiedTime", "documentation":"

If present, the object is deleted only if its modification times matches the provided Timestamp. If the Timestamp values do not match, the operation returns a 412 Precondition Failed error. If the Timestamp matches or if the object doesn’t exist, the operation returns a 204 Success (No Content) response.

This functionality is only supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-if-match-last-modified-time" }, "IfMatchSize":{ "shape":"IfMatchSize", "documentation":"

If present, the object is deleted only if its size matches the provided size in bytes. If the Size value does not match, the operation returns a 412 Precondition Failed error. If the Size matches or if the object doesn’t exist, the operation returns a 204 Success (No Content) response.

This functionality is only supported for directory buckets.

You can use the If-Match, x-amz-if-match-last-modified-time and x-amz-if-match-size conditional headers in conjunction with each-other or individually.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-if-match-size" } } }, "DeleteObjectTaggingOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

The versionId of the object the tag-set was removed from.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-version-id" } } }, "DeleteObjectTaggingRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name containing the objects from which to remove the tags.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The key that identifies the object in the bucket from which to remove all tags.

", "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

The versionId of the object that the tag-set will be removed from.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"versionId" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeleteObjectsOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Deleted":{ "shape":"DeletedObjects", "documentation":"

Container element for a successful delete. It identifies the object that was successfully deleted.

" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" }, "Errors":{ "shape":"Errors", "documentation":"

Container for a failed delete action that describes the object that Amazon S3 attempted to delete and the error it encountered.

", "locationName":"Error" } } }, "DeleteObjectsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Delete" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name containing the objects to delete.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Delete":{ "shape":"Delete", "documentation":"

Container for the request.

", "locationName":"Delete", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "MFA":{ "shape":"MFA", "documentation":"

The concatenation of the authentication device's serial number, a space, and the value that is displayed on your authentication device. Required to permanently delete a versioned object if versioning is configured with MFA delete enabled.

When performing the DeleteObjects operation on an MFA delete enabled bucket, which attempts to delete the specified versioned objects, you must include an MFA token. If you don't provide an MFA token, the entire request will fail, even if there are non-versioned objects that you are trying to delete. If you provide an invalid token, whether there are versioned object keys in the request or not, the entire Multi-Object Delete request will fail. For information about MFA Delete, see MFA Delete in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-mfa" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "BypassGovernanceRetention":{ "shape":"BypassGovernanceRetention", "documentation":"

Specifies whether you want to delete this object even if it has a Governance-type Object Lock in place. To use this header, you must have the s3:BypassGovernanceRetention permission.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-bypass-governance-retention" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the object when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum-algorithm or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request.

For the x-amz-checksum-algorithm header, replace algorithm with the supported algorithm from the following list:

For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If the individual checksum value you provide through x-amz-checksum-algorithm doesn't match the checksum algorithm you set through x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm, Amazon S3 fails the request with a BadDigest error.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" } }, "payload":"Delete" }, "DeletePublicAccessBlockRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The Amazon S3 bucket whose PublicAccessBlock configuration you want to delete.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "DeletedObject":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The name of the deleted object.

" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

The version ID of the deleted object.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

" }, "DeleteMarker":{ "shape":"DeleteMarker", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the specified object version that was permanently deleted was (true) or was not (false) a delete marker before deletion. In a simple DELETE, this header indicates whether (true) or not (false) the current version of the object is a delete marker. To learn more about delete markers, see Working with delete markers.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

" }, "DeleteMarkerVersionId":{ "shape":"DeleteMarkerVersionId", "documentation":"

The version ID of the delete marker created as a result of the DELETE operation. If you delete a specific object version, the value returned by this header is the version ID of the object version deleted.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

" } }, "documentation":"

Information about the deleted object.

" }, "DeletedObjects":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"DeletedObject"}, "flattened":true }, "Delimiter":{"type":"string"}, "Description":{"type":"string"}, "Destination":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the bucket where you want Amazon S3 to store the results.

" }, "Account":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

Destination bucket owner account ID. In a cross-account scenario, if you direct Amazon S3 to change replica ownership to the Amazon Web Services account that owns the destination bucket by specifying the AccessControlTranslation property, this is the account ID of the destination bucket owner. For more information, see Replication Additional Configuration: Changing the Replica Owner in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "StorageClass":{ "shape":"StorageClass", "documentation":"

The storage class to use when replicating objects, such as S3 Standard or reduced redundancy. By default, Amazon S3 uses the storage class of the source object to create the object replica.

For valid values, see the StorageClass element of the PUT Bucket replication action in the Amazon S3 API Reference.

FSX_OPENZFS is not an accepted value when replicating objects.

" }, "AccessControlTranslation":{ "shape":"AccessControlTranslation", "documentation":"

Specify this only in a cross-account scenario (where source and destination bucket owners are not the same), and you want to change replica ownership to the Amazon Web Services account that owns the destination bucket. If this is not specified in the replication configuration, the replicas are owned by same Amazon Web Services account that owns the source object.

" }, "EncryptionConfiguration":{ "shape":"EncryptionConfiguration", "documentation":"

A container that provides information about encryption. If SourceSelectionCriteria is specified, you must specify this element.

" }, "ReplicationTime":{ "shape":"ReplicationTime", "documentation":"

A container specifying S3 Replication Time Control (S3 RTC), including whether S3 RTC is enabled and the time when all objects and operations on objects must be replicated. Must be specified together with a Metrics block.

" }, "Metrics":{ "shape":"Metrics", "documentation":"

A container specifying replication metrics-related settings enabling replication metrics and events.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies information about where to publish analysis or configuration results for an Amazon S3 bucket and S3 Replication Time Control (S3 RTC).

" }, "DestinationResult":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "TableBucketType":{ "shape":"S3TablesBucketType", "documentation":"

The type of the table bucket where the metadata configuration is stored. The aws value indicates an Amazon Web Services managed table bucket, and the customer value indicates a customer-managed table bucket. V2 metadata configurations are stored in Amazon Web Services managed table buckets, and V1 metadata configurations are stored in customer-managed table buckets.

" }, "TableBucketArn":{ "shape":"S3TablesBucketArn", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the table bucket where the metadata configuration is stored.

" }, "TableNamespace":{ "shape":"S3TablesNamespace", "documentation":"

The namespace in the table bucket where the metadata tables for a metadata configuration are stored.

" } }, "documentation":"

The destination information for the S3 Metadata configuration.

" }, "DirectoryBucketToken":{ "type":"string", "max":1024, "min":0 }, "DisplayName":{"type":"string"}, "ETag":{"type":"string"}, "EmailAddress":{"type":"string"}, "EnableRequestProgress":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "EncodingType":{ "type":"string", "documentation":"

Encoding type used by Amazon S3 to encode the object keys in the response. Responses are encoded only in UTF-8. An object key can contain any Unicode character. However, the XML 1.0 parser can't parse certain characters, such as characters with an ASCII value from 0 to 10. For characters that aren't supported in XML 1.0, you can add this parameter to request that Amazon S3 encode the keys in the response. For more information about characters to avoid in object key names, see Object key naming guidelines.

When using the URL encoding type, non-ASCII characters that are used in an object's key name will be percent-encoded according to UTF-8 code values. For example, the object test_file(3).png will appear as test_file%283%29.png.

", "enum":["url"] }, "Encryption":{ "type":"structure", "required":["EncryptionType"], "members":{ "EncryptionType":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryption", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing job results in Amazon S3 (for example, AES256, aws:kms).

" }, "KMSKeyId":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

If the encryption type is aws:kms, this optional value specifies the ID of the symmetric encryption customer managed key to use for encryption of job results. Amazon S3 only supports symmetric encryption KMS keys. For more information, see Asymmetric keys in KMS in the Amazon Web Services Key Management Service Developer Guide.

" }, "KMSContext":{ "shape":"KMSContext", "documentation":"

If the encryption type is aws:kms, this optional value can be used to specify the encryption context for the restore results.

" } }, "documentation":"

Contains the type of server-side encryption used.

" }, "EncryptionConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ReplicaKmsKeyID":{ "shape":"ReplicaKmsKeyID", "documentation":"

Specifies the ID (Key ARN or Alias ARN) of the customer managed Amazon Web Services KMS key stored in Amazon Web Services Key Management Service (KMS) for the destination bucket. Amazon S3 uses this key to encrypt replica objects. Amazon S3 only supports symmetric encryption KMS keys. For more information, see Asymmetric keys in Amazon Web Services KMS in the Amazon Web Services Key Management Service Developer Guide.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies encryption-related information for an Amazon S3 bucket that is a destination for replicated objects.

If you're specifying a customer managed KMS key, we recommend using a fully qualified KMS key ARN. If you use a KMS key alias instead, then KMS resolves the key within the requester’s account. This behavior can result in data that's encrypted with a KMS key that belongs to the requester, and not the bucket owner.

" }, "EncryptionTypeMismatch":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

The existing object was created with a different encryption type. Subsequent write requests must include the appropriate encryption parameters in the request or while creating the session.

", "error":{"httpStatusCode":400}, "exception":true }, "End":{ "type":"long", "box":true }, "EndEvent":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

A message that indicates the request is complete and no more messages will be sent. You should not assume that the request is complete until the client receives an EndEvent.

", "event":true }, "Error":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The error key.

" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

The version ID of the error.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

" }, "Code":{ "shape":"Code", "documentation":"

The error code is a string that uniquely identifies an error condition. It is meant to be read and understood by programs that detect and handle errors by type. The following is a list of Amazon S3 error codes. For more information, see Error responses.

" }, "Message":{ "shape":"Message", "documentation":"

The error message contains a generic description of the error condition in English. It is intended for a human audience. Simple programs display the message directly to the end user if they encounter an error condition they don't know how or don't care to handle. Sophisticated programs with more exhaustive error handling and proper internationalization are more likely to ignore the error message.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for all error elements.

" }, "ErrorCode":{"type":"string"}, "ErrorDetails":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ErrorCode":{ "shape":"ErrorCode", "documentation":"

If the V1 CreateBucketMetadataTableConfiguration request succeeds, but S3 Metadata was unable to create the table, this structure contains the error code. The possible error codes and error messages are as follows:

If the V2 CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration request succeeds, but S3 Metadata was unable to create the table, this structure contains the error code. The possible error codes and error messages are as follows:

" }, "ErrorMessage":{ "shape":"ErrorMessage", "documentation":"

If the V1 CreateBucketMetadataTableConfiguration request succeeds, but S3 Metadata was unable to create the table, this structure contains the error message. The possible error codes and error messages are as follows:

If the V2 CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration request succeeds, but S3 Metadata was unable to create the table, this structure contains the error code. The possible error codes and error messages are as follows:

" } }, "documentation":"

If an S3 Metadata V1 CreateBucketMetadataTableConfiguration or V2 CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration request succeeds, but S3 Metadata was unable to create the table, this structure contains the error code and error message.

If you created your S3 Metadata configuration before July 15, 2025, we recommend that you delete and re-create your configuration by using CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration so that you can expire journal table records and create a live inventory table.

" }, "ErrorDocument":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Key"], "members":{ "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The object key name to use when a 4XX class error occurs.

Replacement must be made for object keys containing special characters (such as carriage returns) when using XML requests. For more information, see XML related object key constraints.

" } }, "documentation":"

The error information.

" }, "ErrorMessage":{"type":"string"}, "Errors":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"Error"}, "flattened":true }, "Event":{ "type":"string", "documentation":"

The bucket event for which to send notifications.

", "enum":[ "s3:ReducedRedundancyLostObject", "s3:ObjectCreated:*", "s3:ObjectCreated:Put", "s3:ObjectCreated:Post", "s3:ObjectCreated:Copy", "s3:ObjectCreated:CompleteMultipartUpload", "s3:ObjectRemoved:*", "s3:ObjectRemoved:Delete", "s3:ObjectRemoved:DeleteMarkerCreated", "s3:ObjectRestore:*", "s3:ObjectRestore:Post", "s3:ObjectRestore:Completed", "s3:Replication:*", "s3:Replication:OperationFailedReplication", "s3:Replication:OperationNotTracked", "s3:Replication:OperationMissedThreshold", "s3:Replication:OperationReplicatedAfterThreshold", "s3:ObjectRestore:Delete", "s3:LifecycleTransition", "s3:IntelligentTiering", "s3:ObjectAcl:Put", "s3:LifecycleExpiration:*", "s3:LifecycleExpiration:Delete", "s3:LifecycleExpiration:DeleteMarkerCreated", "s3:ObjectTagging:*", "s3:ObjectTagging:Put", "s3:ObjectTagging:Delete" ] }, "EventBridgeConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

A container for specifying the configuration for Amazon EventBridge.

" }, "EventList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"Event"}, "flattened":true }, "ExistingObjectReplication":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Status"], "members":{ "Status":{ "shape":"ExistingObjectReplicationStatus", "documentation":"

Specifies whether Amazon S3 replicates existing source bucket objects.

" } }, "documentation":"

Optional configuration to replicate existing source bucket objects.

This parameter is no longer supported. To replicate existing objects, see Replicating existing objects with S3 Batch Replication in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ExistingObjectReplicationStatus":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Enabled", "Disabled" ] }, "Expiration":{"type":"string"}, "ExpirationState":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "ENABLED", "DISABLED" ] }, "ExpirationStatus":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Enabled", "Disabled" ] }, "ExpiredObjectDeleteMarker":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "Expires":{"type":"string"}, "ExposeHeader":{"type":"string"}, "ExposeHeaders":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"ExposeHeader"}, "flattened":true }, "Expression":{"type":"string"}, "ExpressionType":{ "type":"string", "enum":["SQL"] }, "FetchOwner":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "FieldDelimiter":{"type":"string"}, "FileHeaderInfo":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "USE", "IGNORE", "NONE" ] }, "FilterRule":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Name":{ "shape":"FilterRuleName", "documentation":"

The object key name prefix or suffix identifying one or more objects to which the filtering rule applies. The maximum length is 1,024 characters. Overlapping prefixes and suffixes are not supported. For more information, see Configuring Event Notifications in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "Value":{ "shape":"FilterRuleValue", "documentation":"

The value that the filter searches for in object key names.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the Amazon S3 object key name to filter on. An object key name is the name assigned to an object in your Amazon S3 bucket. You specify whether to filter on the suffix or prefix of the object key name. A prefix is a specific string of characters at the beginning of an object key name, which you can use to organize objects. For example, you can start the key names of related objects with a prefix, such as 2023- or engineering/. Then, you can use FilterRule to find objects in a bucket with key names that have the same prefix. A suffix is similar to a prefix, but it is at the end of the object key name instead of at the beginning.

" }, "FilterRuleList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"FilterRule"}, "documentation":"

A list of containers for the key-value pair that defines the criteria for the filter rule.

", "flattened":true }, "FilterRuleName":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "prefix", "suffix" ] }, "FilterRuleValue":{"type":"string"}, "GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Status":{ "shape":"BucketAccelerateStatus", "documentation":"

The accelerate configuration of the bucket.

" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } } }, "GetBucketAccelerateConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket for which the accelerate configuration is retrieved.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" } } }, "GetBucketAclOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Owner":{ "shape":"Owner", "documentation":"

Container for the bucket owner's display name and ID.

" }, "Grants":{ "shape":"Grants", "documentation":"

A list of grants.

", "locationName":"AccessControlList" } } }, "GetBucketAclRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

Specifies the S3 bucket whose ACL is being requested.

When you use this API operation with an access point, provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name.

When you use this API operation with an Object Lambda access point, provide the alias of the Object Lambda access point in place of the bucket name. If the Object Lambda access point alias in a request is not valid, the error code InvalidAccessPointAliasError is returned. For more information about InvalidAccessPointAliasError, see List of Error Codes.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "AnalyticsConfiguration":{ "shape":"AnalyticsConfiguration", "documentation":"

The configuration and any analyses for the analytics filter.

" } }, "payload":"AnalyticsConfiguration" }, "GetBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Id" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket from which an analytics configuration is retrieved.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Id":{ "shape":"AnalyticsId", "documentation":"

The ID that identifies the analytics configuration.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"id" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketCorsOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "CORSRules":{ "shape":"CORSRules", "documentation":"

A set of origins and methods (cross-origin access that you want to allow). You can add up to 100 rules to the configuration.

", "locationName":"CORSRule" } } }, "GetBucketCorsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name for which to get the cors configuration.

When you use this API operation with an access point, provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name.

When you use this API operation with an Object Lambda access point, provide the alias of the Object Lambda access point in place of the bucket name. If the Object Lambda access point alias in a request is not valid, the error code InvalidAccessPointAliasError is returned. For more information about InvalidAccessPointAliasError, see List of Error Codes.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketEncryptionOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration":{"shape":"ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration"} }, "payload":"ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration" }, "GetBucketEncryptionRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket from which the server-side encryption configuration is retrieved.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use path-style requests in the format https://s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com/bucket-name . Virtual-hosted-style requests aren't supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must also follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, DOC-EXAMPLE-BUCKET--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

For directory buckets, this header is not supported in this API operation. If you specify this header, the request fails with the HTTP status code 501 Not Implemented.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketIntelligentTieringConfigurationOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "IntelligentTieringConfiguration":{ "shape":"IntelligentTieringConfiguration", "documentation":"

Container for S3 Intelligent-Tiering configuration.

" } }, "payload":"IntelligentTieringConfiguration" }, "GetBucketIntelligentTieringConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Id" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the Amazon S3 bucket whose configuration you want to modify or retrieve.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Id":{ "shape":"IntelligentTieringId", "documentation":"

The ID used to identify the S3 Intelligent-Tiering configuration.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"id" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketInventoryConfigurationOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "InventoryConfiguration":{ "shape":"InventoryConfiguration", "documentation":"

Specifies the inventory configuration.

" } }, "payload":"InventoryConfiguration" }, "GetBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Id" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket containing the inventory configuration to retrieve.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Id":{ "shape":"InventoryId", "documentation":"

The ID used to identify the inventory configuration.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"id" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Rules":{ "shape":"LifecycleRules", "documentation":"

Container for a lifecycle rule.

", "locationName":"Rule" }, "TransitionDefaultMinimumObjectSize":{ "shape":"TransitionDefaultMinimumObjectSize", "documentation":"

Indicates which default minimum object size behavior is applied to the lifecycle configuration.

This parameter applies to general purpose buckets only. It isn't supported for directory bucket lifecycle configurations.

To customize the minimum object size for any transition you can add a filter that specifies a custom ObjectSizeGreaterThan or ObjectSizeLessThan in the body of your transition rule. Custom filters always take precedence over the default transition behavior.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-transition-default-minimum-object-size" } } }, "GetBucketLifecycleConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket for which to get the lifecycle information.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

This parameter applies to general purpose buckets only. It is not supported for directory bucket lifecycle configurations.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketLifecycleOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Rules":{ "shape":"Rules", "documentation":"

Container for a lifecycle rule.

", "locationName":"Rule" } } }, "GetBucketLifecycleRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket for which to get the lifecycle information.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketLocationOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "LocationConstraint":{ "shape":"BucketLocationConstraint", "documentation":"

Specifies the Region where the bucket resides. For a list of all the Amazon S3 supported location constraints by Region, see Regions and Endpoints.

Buckets in Region us-east-1 have a LocationConstraint of null. Buckets with a LocationConstraint of EU reside in eu-west-1.

" } } }, "GetBucketLocationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket for which to get the location.

When you use this API operation with an access point, provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name.

When you use this API operation with an Object Lambda access point, provide the alias of the Object Lambda access point in place of the bucket name. If the Object Lambda access point alias in a request is not valid, the error code InvalidAccessPointAliasError is returned. For more information about InvalidAccessPointAliasError, see List of Error Codes.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketLoggingOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "LoggingEnabled":{"shape":"LoggingEnabled"} } }, "GetBucketLoggingRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name for which to get the logging information.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketMetadataConfigurationOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "GetBucketMetadataConfigurationResult":{ "shape":"GetBucketMetadataConfigurationResult", "documentation":"

The metadata configuration for the general purpose bucket.

" } }, "payload":"GetBucketMetadataConfigurationResult" }, "GetBucketMetadataConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The general purpose bucket that corresponds to the metadata configuration that you want to retrieve.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The expected owner of the general purpose bucket that you want to retrieve the metadata table configuration for.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketMetadataConfigurationResult":{ "type":"structure", "required":["MetadataConfigurationResult"], "members":{ "MetadataConfigurationResult":{ "shape":"MetadataConfigurationResult", "documentation":"

The metadata configuration for a general purpose bucket.

" } }, "documentation":"

The S3 Metadata configuration for a general purpose bucket.

" }, "GetBucketMetadataTableConfigurationOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "GetBucketMetadataTableConfigurationResult":{ "shape":"GetBucketMetadataTableConfigurationResult", "documentation":"

The metadata table configuration for the general purpose bucket.

" } }, "payload":"GetBucketMetadataTableConfigurationResult" }, "GetBucketMetadataTableConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The general purpose bucket that corresponds to the metadata table configuration that you want to retrieve.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The expected owner of the general purpose bucket that you want to retrieve the metadata table configuration for.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketMetadataTableConfigurationResult":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "MetadataTableConfigurationResult", "Status" ], "members":{ "MetadataTableConfigurationResult":{ "shape":"MetadataTableConfigurationResult", "documentation":"

The V1 S3 Metadata configuration for a general purpose bucket.

" }, "Status":{ "shape":"MetadataTableStatus", "documentation":"

The status of the metadata table. The status values are:

" }, "Error":{ "shape":"ErrorDetails", "documentation":"

If the CreateBucketMetadataTableConfiguration request succeeds, but S3 Metadata was unable to create the table, this structure contains the error code and error message.

" } }, "documentation":"

The V1 S3 Metadata configuration for a general purpose bucket.

If you created your S3 Metadata configuration before July 15, 2025, we recommend that you delete and re-create your configuration by using CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration so that you can expire journal table records and create a live inventory table.

" }, "GetBucketMetricsConfigurationOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "MetricsConfiguration":{ "shape":"MetricsConfiguration", "documentation":"

Specifies the metrics configuration.

" } }, "payload":"MetricsConfiguration" }, "GetBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Id" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket containing the metrics configuration to retrieve.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Id":{ "shape":"MetricsId", "documentation":"

The ID used to identify the metrics configuration. The ID has a 64 character limit and can only contain letters, numbers, periods, dashes, and underscores.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"id" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket for which to get the notification configuration.

When you use this API operation with an access point, provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name.

When you use this API operation with an Object Lambda access point, provide the alias of the Object Lambda access point in place of the bucket name. If the Object Lambda access point alias in a request is not valid, the error code InvalidAccessPointAliasError is returned. For more information about InvalidAccessPointAliasError, see List of Error Codes.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketOwnershipControlsOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "OwnershipControls":{ "shape":"OwnershipControls", "documentation":"

The OwnershipControls (BucketOwnerEnforced, BucketOwnerPreferred, or ObjectWriter) currently in effect for this Amazon S3 bucket.

" } }, "payload":"OwnershipControls" }, "GetBucketOwnershipControlsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the Amazon S3 bucket whose OwnershipControls you want to retrieve.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketPolicyOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Policy":{ "shape":"Policy", "documentation":"

The bucket policy as a JSON document.

" } }, "payload":"Policy" }, "GetBucketPolicyRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name to get the bucket policy for.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use path-style requests in the format https://s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com/bucket-name . Virtual-hosted-style requests aren't supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must also follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, DOC-EXAMPLE-BUCKET--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide

Access points - When you use this API operation with an access point, provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name.

Object Lambda access points - When you use this API operation with an Object Lambda access point, provide the alias of the Object Lambda access point in place of the bucket name. If the Object Lambda access point alias in a request is not valid, the error code InvalidAccessPointAliasError is returned. For more information about InvalidAccessPointAliasError, see List of Error Codes.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

For directory buckets, this header is not supported in this API operation. If you specify this header, the request fails with the HTTP status code 501 Not Implemented.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketPolicyStatusOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "PolicyStatus":{ "shape":"PolicyStatus", "documentation":"

The policy status for the specified bucket.

" } }, "payload":"PolicyStatus" }, "GetBucketPolicyStatusRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the Amazon S3 bucket whose policy status you want to retrieve.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketReplicationOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ReplicationConfiguration":{"shape":"ReplicationConfiguration"} }, "payload":"ReplicationConfiguration" }, "GetBucketReplicationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name for which to get the replication information.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketRequestPaymentOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Payer":{ "shape":"Payer", "documentation":"

Specifies who pays for the download and request fees.

" } } }, "GetBucketRequestPaymentRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket for which to get the payment request configuration

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketTaggingOutput":{ "type":"structure", "required":["TagSet"], "members":{ "TagSet":{ "shape":"TagSet", "documentation":"

Contains the tag set.

" } } }, "GetBucketTaggingRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket for which to get the tagging information.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketVersioningOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Status":{ "shape":"BucketVersioningStatus", "documentation":"

The versioning state of the bucket.

" }, "MFADelete":{ "shape":"MFADeleteStatus", "documentation":"

Specifies whether MFA delete is enabled in the bucket versioning configuration. This element is only returned if the bucket has been configured with MFA delete. If the bucket has never been so configured, this element is not returned.

", "locationName":"MfaDelete" } } }, "GetBucketVersioningRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket for which to get the versioning information.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetBucketWebsiteOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "RedirectAllRequestsTo":{ "shape":"RedirectAllRequestsTo", "documentation":"

Specifies the redirect behavior of all requests to a website endpoint of an Amazon S3 bucket.

" }, "IndexDocument":{ "shape":"IndexDocument", "documentation":"

The name of the index document for the website (for example index.html).

" }, "ErrorDocument":{ "shape":"ErrorDocument", "documentation":"

The object key name of the website error document to use for 4XX class errors.

" }, "RoutingRules":{ "shape":"RoutingRules", "documentation":"

Rules that define when a redirect is applied and the redirect behavior.

" } } }, "GetBucketWebsiteRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name for which to get the website configuration.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetObjectAclOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Owner":{ "shape":"Owner", "documentation":"

Container for the bucket owner's display name and ID.

" }, "Grants":{ "shape":"Grants", "documentation":"

A list of grants.

", "locationName":"AccessControlList" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } } }, "GetObjectAclRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name that contains the object for which to get the ACL information.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The key of the object for which to get the ACL information.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Key"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

Version ID used to reference a specific version of the object.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"versionId" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetObjectAttributesOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "DeleteMarker":{ "shape":"DeleteMarker", "documentation":"

Specifies whether the object retrieved was (true) or was not (false) a delete marker. If false, this response header does not appear in the response. To learn more about delete markers, see Working with delete markers.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-delete-marker" }, "LastModified":{ "shape":"LastModified", "documentation":"

Date and time when the object was last modified.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Last-Modified" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

The version ID of the object.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-version-id" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" }, "ETag":{ "shape":"ETag", "documentation":"

An ETag is an opaque identifier assigned by a web server to a specific version of a resource found at a URL.

" }, "Checksum":{ "shape":"Checksum", "documentation":"

The checksum or digest of the object.

" }, "ObjectParts":{ "shape":"GetObjectAttributesParts", "documentation":"

A collection of parts associated with a multipart upload.

" }, "StorageClass":{ "shape":"StorageClass", "documentation":"

Provides the storage class information of the object. Amazon S3 returns this header for all objects except for S3 Standard storage class objects.

For more information, see Storage Classes.

Directory buckets - Directory buckets only support EXPRESS_ONEZONE (the S3 Express One Zone storage class) in Availability Zones and ONEZONE_IA (the S3 One Zone-Infrequent Access storage class) in Dedicated Local Zones.

" }, "ObjectSize":{ "shape":"ObjectSize", "documentation":"

The size of the object in bytes.

" } } }, "GetObjectAttributesParts":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "TotalPartsCount":{ "shape":"PartsCount", "documentation":"

The total number of parts.

", "locationName":"PartsCount" }, "PartNumberMarker":{ "shape":"PartNumberMarker", "documentation":"

The marker for the current part.

" }, "NextPartNumberMarker":{ "shape":"NextPartNumberMarker", "documentation":"

When a list is truncated, this element specifies the last part in the list, as well as the value to use for the PartNumberMarker request parameter in a subsequent request.

" }, "MaxParts":{ "shape":"MaxParts", "documentation":"

The maximum number of parts allowed in the response.

" }, "IsTruncated":{ "shape":"IsTruncated", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the returned list of parts is truncated. A value of true indicates that the list was truncated. A list can be truncated if the number of parts exceeds the limit returned in the MaxParts element.

" }, "Parts":{ "shape":"PartsList", "documentation":"

A container for elements related to a particular part. A response can contain zero or more Parts elements.

", "locationName":"Part" } }, "documentation":"

A collection of parts associated with a multipart upload.

" }, "GetObjectAttributesRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key", "ObjectAttributes" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket that contains the object.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The object key.

", "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

The version ID used to reference a specific version of the object.

S3 Versioning isn't enabled and supported for directory buckets. For this API operation, only the null value of the version ID is supported by directory buckets. You can only specify null to the versionId query parameter in the request.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"versionId" }, "MaxParts":{ "shape":"MaxParts", "documentation":"

Sets the maximum number of parts to return. For more information, see Uploading and copying objects using multipart upload in Amazon S3 in the Amazon Simple Storage Service user guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-max-parts" }, "PartNumberMarker":{ "shape":"PartNumberMarker", "documentation":"

Specifies the part after which listing should begin. Only parts with higher part numbers will be listed. For more information, see Uploading and copying objects using multipart upload in Amazon S3 in the Amazon Simple Storage Service user guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-part-number-marker" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Specifies the algorithm to use when encrypting the object (for example, AES256).

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKey":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKey", "documentation":"

Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use in encrypting data. This value is used to store the object and then it is discarded; Amazon S3 does not store the encryption key. The key must be appropriate for use with the algorithm specified in the x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm header.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321. Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure that the encryption key was transmitted without error.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "ObjectAttributes":{ "shape":"ObjectAttributesList", "documentation":"

Specifies the fields at the root level that you want returned in the response. Fields that you do not specify are not returned.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-attributes" } } }, "GetObjectLegalHoldOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "LegalHold":{ "shape":"ObjectLockLegalHold", "documentation":"

The current legal hold status for the specified object.

", "locationName":"LegalHold" } }, "payload":"LegalHold" }, "GetObjectLegalHoldRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name containing the object whose legal hold status you want to retrieve.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The key name for the object whose legal hold status you want to retrieve.

", "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

The version ID of the object whose legal hold status you want to retrieve.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"versionId" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetObjectLockConfigurationOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ObjectLockConfiguration":{ "shape":"ObjectLockConfiguration", "documentation":"

The specified bucket's Object Lock configuration.

" } }, "payload":"ObjectLockConfiguration" }, "GetObjectLockConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket whose Object Lock configuration you want to retrieve.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetObjectOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Body":{ "shape":"Body", "documentation":"

Object data.

", "streaming":true }, "DeleteMarker":{ "shape":"DeleteMarker", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the object retrieved was (true) or was not (false) a Delete Marker. If false, this response header does not appear in the response.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-delete-marker" }, "AcceptRanges":{ "shape":"AcceptRanges", "documentation":"

Indicates that a range of bytes was specified in the request.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"accept-ranges" }, "Expiration":{ "shape":"Expiration", "documentation":"

If the object expiration is configured (see PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration ), the response includes this header. It includes the expiry-date and rule-id key-value pairs providing object expiration information. The value of the rule-id is URL-encoded.

Object expiration information is not returned in directory buckets and this header returns the value \"NotImplemented\" in all responses for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expiration" }, "Restore":{ "shape":"Restore", "documentation":"

Provides information about object restoration action and expiration time of the restored object copy.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets. Directory buckets only support EXPRESS_ONEZONE (the S3 Express One Zone storage class) in Availability Zones and ONEZONE_IA (the S3 One Zone-Infrequent Access storage class) in Dedicated Local Zones.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-restore" }, "LastModified":{ "shape":"LastModified", "documentation":"

Date and time when the object was last modified.

General purpose buckets - When you specify a versionId of the object in your request, if the specified version in the request is a delete marker, the response returns a 405 Method Not Allowed error and the Last-Modified: timestamp response header.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Last-Modified" }, "ContentLength":{ "shape":"ContentLength", "documentation":"

Size of the body in bytes.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Length" }, "ETag":{ "shape":"ETag", "documentation":"

An entity tag (ETag) is an opaque identifier assigned by a web server to a specific version of a resource found at a URL.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"ETag" }, "ChecksumCRC32":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32 checksum of the object. This checksum is only present if the object was uploaded with the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc32" }, "ChecksumCRC32C":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32C", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32C checksum of the object. This will only be present if the object was uploaded with the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc32c" }, "ChecksumCRC64NVME":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC64NVME", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 64-bit CRC64NVME checksum of the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc64nvme" }, "ChecksumSHA1":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA1", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 160-bit SHA1 digest of the object. This will only be present if the object was uploaded with the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-sha1" }, "ChecksumSHA256":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA256", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 256-bit SHA256 digest of the object. This will only be present if the object was uploaded with the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-sha256" }, "ChecksumType":{ "shape":"ChecksumType", "documentation":"

The checksum type, which determines how part-level checksums are combined to create an object-level checksum for multipart objects. You can use this header response to verify that the checksum type that is received is the same checksum type that was specified in the CreateMultipartUpload request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-type" }, "MissingMeta":{ "shape":"MissingMeta", "documentation":"

This is set to the number of metadata entries not returned in the headers that are prefixed with x-amz-meta-. This can happen if you create metadata using an API like SOAP that supports more flexible metadata than the REST API. For example, using SOAP, you can create metadata whose values are not legal HTTP headers.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-missing-meta" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

Version ID of the object.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-version-id" }, "CacheControl":{ "shape":"CacheControl", "documentation":"

Specifies caching behavior along the request/reply chain.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Cache-Control" }, "ContentDisposition":{ "shape":"ContentDisposition", "documentation":"

Specifies presentational information for the object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Disposition" }, "ContentEncoding":{ "shape":"ContentEncoding", "documentation":"

Indicates what content encodings have been applied to the object and thus what decoding mechanisms must be applied to obtain the media-type referenced by the Content-Type header field.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Encoding" }, "ContentLanguage":{ "shape":"ContentLanguage", "documentation":"

The language the content is in.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Language" }, "ContentRange":{ "shape":"ContentRange", "documentation":"

The portion of the object returned in the response.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Range" }, "ContentType":{ "shape":"ContentType", "documentation":"

A standard MIME type describing the format of the object data.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Type" }, "Expires":{ "shape":"Expires", "documentation":"

The date and time at which the object is no longer cacheable.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Expires" }, "WebsiteRedirectLocation":{ "shape":"WebsiteRedirectLocation", "documentation":"

If the bucket is configured as a website, redirects requests for this object to another object in the same bucket or to an external URL. Amazon S3 stores the value of this header in the object metadata.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-website-redirect-location" }, "ServerSideEncryption":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryption", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption algorithm used when you store this object in Amazon S3 or Amazon FSx.

When accessing data stored in Amazon FSx file systems using S3 access points, the only valid server side encryption option is aws:fsx.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption" }, "Metadata":{ "shape":"Metadata", "documentation":"

A map of metadata to store with the object in S3.

", "location":"headers", "locationName":"x-amz-meta-" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested, the response will include this header to confirm the encryption algorithm that's used.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested, the response will include this header to provide the round-trip message integrity verification of the customer-provided encryption key.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "SSEKMSKeyId":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

If present, indicates the ID of the KMS key that was used for object encryption.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" }, "BucketKeyEnabled":{ "shape":"BucketKeyEnabled", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the object uses an S3 Bucket Key for server-side encryption with Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-bucket-key-enabled" }, "StorageClass":{ "shape":"StorageClass", "documentation":"

Provides storage class information of the object. Amazon S3 returns this header for all objects except for S3 Standard storage class objects.

Directory buckets - Directory buckets only support EXPRESS_ONEZONE (the S3 Express One Zone storage class) in Availability Zones and ONEZONE_IA (the S3 One Zone-Infrequent Access storage class) in Dedicated Local Zones.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-storage-class" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" }, "ReplicationStatus":{ "shape":"ReplicationStatus", "documentation":"

Amazon S3 can return this if your request involves a bucket that is either a source or destination in a replication rule.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-replication-status" }, "PartsCount":{ "shape":"PartsCount", "documentation":"

The count of parts this object has. This value is only returned if you specify partNumber in your request and the object was uploaded as a multipart upload.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-mp-parts-count" }, "TagCount":{ "shape":"TagCount", "documentation":"

The number of tags, if any, on the object, when you have the relevant permission to read object tags.

You can use GetObjectTagging to retrieve the tag set associated with an object.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-tagging-count" }, "ObjectLockMode":{ "shape":"ObjectLockMode", "documentation":"

The Object Lock mode that's currently in place for this object.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-lock-mode" }, "ObjectLockRetainUntilDate":{ "shape":"ObjectLockRetainUntilDate", "documentation":"

The date and time when this object's Object Lock will expire.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-lock-retain-until-date" }, "ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus":{ "shape":"ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus", "documentation":"

Indicates whether this object has an active legal hold. This field is only returned if you have permission to view an object's legal hold status.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-lock-legal-hold" } }, "payload":"Body" }, "GetObjectRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name containing the object.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points - When you use this action with an Object Lambda access point, you must direct requests to the Object Lambda access point hostname. The Object Lambda access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-object-lambda.Region.amazonaws.com.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "IfMatch":{ "shape":"IfMatch", "documentation":"

Return the object only if its entity tag (ETag) is the same as the one specified in this header; otherwise, return a 412 Precondition Failed error.

If both of the If-Match and If-Unmodified-Since headers are present in the request as follows: If-Match condition evaluates to true, and; If-Unmodified-Since condition evaluates to false; then, S3 returns 200 OK and the data requested.

For more information about conditional requests, see RFC 7232.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-Match" }, "IfModifiedSince":{ "shape":"IfModifiedSince", "documentation":"

Return the object only if it has been modified since the specified time; otherwise, return a 304 Not Modified error.

If both of the If-None-Match and If-Modified-Since headers are present in the request as follows: If-None-Match condition evaluates to false, and; If-Modified-Since condition evaluates to true; then, S3 returns 304 Not Modified status code.

For more information about conditional requests, see RFC 7232.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-Modified-Since" }, "IfNoneMatch":{ "shape":"IfNoneMatch", "documentation":"

Return the object only if its entity tag (ETag) is different from the one specified in this header; otherwise, return a 304 Not Modified error.

If both of the If-None-Match and If-Modified-Since headers are present in the request as follows: If-None-Match condition evaluates to false, and; If-Modified-Since condition evaluates to true; then, S3 returns 304 Not Modified HTTP status code.

For more information about conditional requests, see RFC 7232.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-None-Match" }, "IfUnmodifiedSince":{ "shape":"IfUnmodifiedSince", "documentation":"

Return the object only if it has not been modified since the specified time; otherwise, return a 412 Precondition Failed error.

If both of the If-Match and If-Unmodified-Since headers are present in the request as follows: If-Match condition evaluates to true, and; If-Unmodified-Since condition evaluates to false; then, S3 returns 200 OK and the data requested.

For more information about conditional requests, see RFC 7232.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-Unmodified-Since" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Key of the object to get.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Key"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "Range":{ "shape":"Range", "documentation":"

Downloads the specified byte range of an object. For more information about the HTTP Range header, see https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9110.html#name-range.

Amazon S3 doesn't support retrieving multiple ranges of data per GET request.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Range" }, "ResponseCacheControl":{ "shape":"ResponseCacheControl", "documentation":"

Sets the Cache-Control header of the response.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"response-cache-control" }, "ResponseContentDisposition":{ "shape":"ResponseContentDisposition", "documentation":"

Sets the Content-Disposition header of the response.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"response-content-disposition" }, "ResponseContentEncoding":{ "shape":"ResponseContentEncoding", "documentation":"

Sets the Content-Encoding header of the response.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"response-content-encoding" }, "ResponseContentLanguage":{ "shape":"ResponseContentLanguage", "documentation":"

Sets the Content-Language header of the response.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"response-content-language" }, "ResponseContentType":{ "shape":"ResponseContentType", "documentation":"

Sets the Content-Type header of the response.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"response-content-type" }, "ResponseExpires":{ "shape":"ResponseExpires", "documentation":"

Sets the Expires header of the response.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"response-expires" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

Version ID used to reference a specific version of the object.

By default, the GetObject operation returns the current version of an object. To return a different version, use the versionId subresource.

For more information about versioning, see PutBucketVersioning.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"versionId" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Specifies the algorithm to use when decrypting the object (for example, AES256).

If you encrypt an object by using server-side encryption with customer-provided encryption keys (SSE-C) when you store the object in Amazon S3, then when you GET the object, you must use the following headers:

For more information about SSE-C, see Server-Side Encryption (Using Customer-Provided Encryption Keys) in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKey":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKey", "documentation":"

Specifies the customer-provided encryption key that you originally provided for Amazon S3 to encrypt the data before storing it. This value is used to decrypt the object when recovering it and must match the one used when storing the data. The key must be appropriate for use with the algorithm specified in the x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm header.

If you encrypt an object by using server-side encryption with customer-provided encryption keys (SSE-C) when you store the object in Amazon S3, then when you GET the object, you must use the following headers:

For more information about SSE-C, see Server-Side Encryption (Using Customer-Provided Encryption Keys) in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the customer-provided encryption key according to RFC 1321. Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure that the encryption key was transmitted without error.

If you encrypt an object by using server-side encryption with customer-provided encryption keys (SSE-C) when you store the object in Amazon S3, then when you GET the object, you must use the following headers:

For more information about SSE-C, see Server-Side Encryption (Using Customer-Provided Encryption Keys) in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "PartNumber":{ "shape":"PartNumber", "documentation":"

Part number of the object being read. This is a positive integer between 1 and 10,000. Effectively performs a 'ranged' GET request for the part specified. Useful for downloading just a part of an object.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"partNumber" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "ChecksumMode":{ "shape":"ChecksumMode", "documentation":"

To retrieve the checksum, this mode must be enabled.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-mode" } } }, "GetObjectResponseStatusCode":{ "type":"integer", "box":true }, "GetObjectRetentionOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Retention":{ "shape":"ObjectLockRetention", "documentation":"

The container element for an object's retention settings.

", "locationName":"Retention" } }, "payload":"Retention" }, "GetObjectRetentionRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name containing the object whose retention settings you want to retrieve.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The key name for the object whose retention settings you want to retrieve.

", "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

The version ID for the object whose retention settings you want to retrieve.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"versionId" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetObjectTaggingOutput":{ "type":"structure", "required":["TagSet"], "members":{ "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

The versionId of the object for which you got the tagging information.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-version-id" }, "TagSet":{ "shape":"TagSet", "documentation":"

Contains the tag set.

" } } }, "GetObjectTaggingRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name containing the object for which to get the tagging information.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Object key for which to get the tagging information.

", "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

The versionId of the object for which to get the tagging information.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"versionId" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" } } }, "GetObjectTorrentOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Body":{ "shape":"Body", "documentation":"

A Bencoded dictionary as defined by the BitTorrent specification

", "streaming":true }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } }, "payload":"Body" }, "GetObjectTorrentRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket containing the object for which to get the torrent files.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The object key for which to get the information.

", "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GetPublicAccessBlockOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "PublicAccessBlockConfiguration":{ "shape":"PublicAccessBlockConfiguration", "documentation":"

The PublicAccessBlock configuration currently in effect for this Amazon S3 bucket.

" } }, "payload":"PublicAccessBlockConfiguration" }, "GetPublicAccessBlockRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the Amazon S3 bucket whose PublicAccessBlock configuration you want to retrieve.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "GlacierJobParameters":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Tier"], "members":{ "Tier":{ "shape":"Tier", "documentation":"

Retrieval tier at which the restore will be processed.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for S3 Glacier job parameters.

" }, "Grant":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Grantee":{ "shape":"Grantee", "documentation":"

The person being granted permissions.

" }, "Permission":{ "shape":"Permission", "documentation":"

Specifies the permission given to the grantee.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for grant information.

" }, "GrantFullControl":{"type":"string"}, "GrantRead":{"type":"string"}, "GrantReadACP":{"type":"string"}, "GrantWrite":{"type":"string"}, "GrantWriteACP":{"type":"string"}, "Grantee":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Type"], "members":{ "DisplayName":{ "shape":"DisplayName", "documentation":"

Screen name of the grantee.

" }, "EmailAddress":{ "shape":"EmailAddress", "documentation":"

Email address of the grantee.

Using email addresses to specify a grantee is only supported in the following Amazon Web Services Regions:

For a list of all the Amazon S3 supported Regions and endpoints, see Regions and Endpoints in the Amazon Web Services General Reference.

" }, "ID":{ "shape":"ID", "documentation":"

The canonical user ID of the grantee.

" }, "Type":{ "shape":"Type", "documentation":"

Type of grantee

", "locationName":"xsi:type", "xmlAttribute":true }, "URI":{ "shape":"URI", "documentation":"

URI of the grantee group.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for the person being granted permissions.

", "xmlNamespace":{ "prefix":"xsi", "uri":"http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" } }, "Grants":{ "type":"list", "member":{ "shape":"Grant", "locationName":"Grant" } }, "HeadBucketOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "BucketArn":{ "shape":"S3RegionalOrS3ExpressBucketArnString", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the S3 bucket. ARNs uniquely identify Amazon Web Services resources across all of Amazon Web Services.

This parameter is only supported for S3 directory buckets. For more information, see Using tags with directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-bucket-arn" }, "BucketLocationType":{ "shape":"LocationType", "documentation":"

The type of location where the bucket is created.

This functionality is only supported by directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-bucket-location-type" }, "BucketLocationName":{ "shape":"BucketLocationName", "documentation":"

The name of the location where the bucket will be created.

For directory buckets, the Zone ID of the Availability Zone or the Local Zone where the bucket is created. An example Zone ID value for an Availability Zone is usw2-az1.

This functionality is only supported by directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-bucket-location-name" }, "BucketRegion":{ "shape":"Region", "documentation":"

The Region that the bucket is located.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-bucket-region" }, "AccessPointAlias":{ "shape":"AccessPointAlias", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the bucket name used in the request is an access point alias.

For directory buckets, the value of this field is false.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-access-point-alias" } } }, "HeadBucketRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points - When you use this API operation with an Object Lambda access point, provide the alias of the Object Lambda access point in place of the bucket name. If the Object Lambda access point alias in a request is not valid, the error code InvalidAccessPointAliasError is returned. For more information about InvalidAccessPointAliasError, see List of Error Codes.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "HeadObjectOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "DeleteMarker":{ "shape":"DeleteMarker", "documentation":"

Specifies whether the object retrieved was (true) or was not (false) a Delete Marker. If false, this response header does not appear in the response.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-delete-marker" }, "AcceptRanges":{ "shape":"AcceptRanges", "documentation":"

Indicates that a range of bytes was specified.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"accept-ranges" }, "Expiration":{ "shape":"Expiration", "documentation":"

If the object expiration is configured (see PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration ), the response includes this header. It includes the expiry-date and rule-id key-value pairs providing object expiration information. The value of the rule-id is URL-encoded.

Object expiration information is not returned in directory buckets and this header returns the value \"NotImplemented\" in all responses for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expiration" }, "Restore":{ "shape":"Restore", "documentation":"

If the object is an archived object (an object whose storage class is GLACIER), the response includes this header if either the archive restoration is in progress (see RestoreObject or an archive copy is already restored.

If an archive copy is already restored, the header value indicates when Amazon S3 is scheduled to delete the object copy. For example:

x-amz-restore: ongoing-request=\"false\", expiry-date=\"Fri, 21 Dec 2012 00:00:00 GMT\"

If the object restoration is in progress, the header returns the value ongoing-request=\"true\".

For more information about archiving objects, see Transitioning Objects: General Considerations.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets. Directory buckets only support EXPRESS_ONEZONE (the S3 Express One Zone storage class) in Availability Zones and ONEZONE_IA (the S3 One Zone-Infrequent Access storage class) in Dedicated Local Zones.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-restore" }, "ArchiveStatus":{ "shape":"ArchiveStatus", "documentation":"

The archive state of the head object.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-archive-status" }, "LastModified":{ "shape":"LastModified", "documentation":"

Date and time when the object was last modified.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Last-Modified" }, "ContentLength":{ "shape":"ContentLength", "documentation":"

Size of the body in bytes.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Length" }, "ChecksumCRC32":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32 checksum of the object. This checksum is only be present if the checksum was uploaded with the object. When you use an API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc32" }, "ChecksumCRC32C":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32C", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32C checksum of the object. This checksum is only present if the checksum was uploaded with the object. When you use an API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc32c" }, "ChecksumCRC64NVME":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC64NVME", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 64-bit CRC64NVME checksum of the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc64nvme" }, "ChecksumSHA1":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA1", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 160-bit SHA1 digest of the object. This will only be present if the object was uploaded with the object. When you use the API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-sha1" }, "ChecksumSHA256":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA256", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 256-bit SHA256 digest of the object. This will only be present if the object was uploaded with the object. When you use an API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-sha256" }, "ChecksumType":{ "shape":"ChecksumType", "documentation":"

The checksum type, which determines how part-level checksums are combined to create an object-level checksum for multipart objects. You can use this header response to verify that the checksum type that is received is the same checksum type that was specified in CreateMultipartUpload request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-type" }, "ETag":{ "shape":"ETag", "documentation":"

An entity tag (ETag) is an opaque identifier assigned by a web server to a specific version of a resource found at a URL.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"ETag" }, "MissingMeta":{ "shape":"MissingMeta", "documentation":"

This is set to the number of metadata entries not returned in x-amz-meta headers. This can happen if you create metadata using an API like SOAP that supports more flexible metadata than the REST API. For example, using SOAP, you can create metadata whose values are not legal HTTP headers.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-missing-meta" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

Version ID of the object.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-version-id" }, "CacheControl":{ "shape":"CacheControl", "documentation":"

Specifies caching behavior along the request/reply chain.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Cache-Control" }, "ContentDisposition":{ "shape":"ContentDisposition", "documentation":"

Specifies presentational information for the object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Disposition" }, "ContentEncoding":{ "shape":"ContentEncoding", "documentation":"

Indicates what content encodings have been applied to the object and thus what decoding mechanisms must be applied to obtain the media-type referenced by the Content-Type header field.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Encoding" }, "ContentLanguage":{ "shape":"ContentLanguage", "documentation":"

The language the content is in.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Language" }, "ContentType":{ "shape":"ContentType", "documentation":"

A standard MIME type describing the format of the object data.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Type" }, "ContentRange":{ "shape":"ContentRange", "documentation":"

The portion of the object returned in the response for a GET request.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Range" }, "Expires":{ "shape":"Expires", "documentation":"

The date and time at which the object is no longer cacheable.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Expires" }, "WebsiteRedirectLocation":{ "shape":"WebsiteRedirectLocation", "documentation":"

If the bucket is configured as a website, redirects requests for this object to another object in the same bucket or to an external URL. Amazon S3 stores the value of this header in the object metadata.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-website-redirect-location" }, "ServerSideEncryption":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryption", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption algorithm used when you store this object in Amazon S3 or Amazon FSx.

When accessing data stored in Amazon FSx file systems using S3 access points, the only valid server side encryption option is aws:fsx.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption" }, "Metadata":{ "shape":"Metadata", "documentation":"

A map of metadata to store with the object in S3.

", "location":"headers", "locationName":"x-amz-meta-" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested, the response will include this header to confirm the encryption algorithm that's used.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested, the response will include this header to provide the round-trip message integrity verification of the customer-provided encryption key.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "SSEKMSKeyId":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

If present, indicates the ID of the KMS key that was used for object encryption.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" }, "BucketKeyEnabled":{ "shape":"BucketKeyEnabled", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the object uses an S3 Bucket Key for server-side encryption with Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-bucket-key-enabled" }, "StorageClass":{ "shape":"StorageClass", "documentation":"

Provides storage class information of the object. Amazon S3 returns this header for all objects except for S3 Standard storage class objects.

For more information, see Storage Classes.

Directory buckets - Directory buckets only support EXPRESS_ONEZONE (the S3 Express One Zone storage class) in Availability Zones and ONEZONE_IA (the S3 One Zone-Infrequent Access storage class) in Dedicated Local Zones.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-storage-class" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" }, "ReplicationStatus":{ "shape":"ReplicationStatus", "documentation":"

Amazon S3 can return this header if your request involves a bucket that is either a source or a destination in a replication rule.

In replication, you have a source bucket on which you configure replication and destination bucket or buckets where Amazon S3 stores object replicas. When you request an object (GetObject) or object metadata (HeadObject) from these buckets, Amazon S3 will return the x-amz-replication-status header in the response as follows:

For more information, see Replication.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-replication-status" }, "PartsCount":{ "shape":"PartsCount", "documentation":"

The count of parts this object has. This value is only returned if you specify partNumber in your request and the object was uploaded as a multipart upload.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-mp-parts-count" }, "TagCount":{ "shape":"TagCount", "documentation":"

The number of tags, if any, on the object, when you have the relevant permission to read object tags.

You can use GetObjectTagging to retrieve the tag set associated with an object.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-tagging-count" }, "ObjectLockMode":{ "shape":"ObjectLockMode", "documentation":"

The Object Lock mode, if any, that's in effect for this object. This header is only returned if the requester has the s3:GetObjectRetention permission. For more information about S3 Object Lock, see Object Lock.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-lock-mode" }, "ObjectLockRetainUntilDate":{ "shape":"ObjectLockRetainUntilDate", "documentation":"

The date and time when the Object Lock retention period expires. This header is only returned if the requester has the s3:GetObjectRetention permission.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-lock-retain-until-date" }, "ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus":{ "shape":"ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus", "documentation":"

Specifies whether a legal hold is in effect for this object. This header is only returned if the requester has the s3:GetObjectLegalHold permission. This header is not returned if the specified version of this object has never had a legal hold applied. For more information about S3 Object Lock, see Object Lock.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-lock-legal-hold" } } }, "HeadObjectRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket that contains the object.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "IfMatch":{ "shape":"IfMatch", "documentation":"

Return the object only if its entity tag (ETag) is the same as the one specified; otherwise, return a 412 (precondition failed) error.

If both of the If-Match and If-Unmodified-Since headers are present in the request as follows:

Then Amazon S3 returns 200 OK and the data requested.

For more information about conditional requests, see RFC 7232.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-Match" }, "IfModifiedSince":{ "shape":"IfModifiedSince", "documentation":"

Return the object only if it has been modified since the specified time; otherwise, return a 304 (not modified) error.

If both of the If-None-Match and If-Modified-Since headers are present in the request as follows:

Then Amazon S3 returns the 304 Not Modified response code.

For more information about conditional requests, see RFC 7232.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-Modified-Since" }, "IfNoneMatch":{ "shape":"IfNoneMatch", "documentation":"

Return the object only if its entity tag (ETag) is different from the one specified; otherwise, return a 304 (not modified) error.

If both of the If-None-Match and If-Modified-Since headers are present in the request as follows:

Then Amazon S3 returns the 304 Not Modified response code.

For more information about conditional requests, see RFC 7232.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-None-Match" }, "IfUnmodifiedSince":{ "shape":"IfUnmodifiedSince", "documentation":"

Return the object only if it has not been modified since the specified time; otherwise, return a 412 (precondition failed) error.

If both of the If-Match and If-Unmodified-Since headers are present in the request as follows:

Then Amazon S3 returns 200 OK and the data requested.

For more information about conditional requests, see RFC 7232.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-Unmodified-Since" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The object key.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Key"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "Range":{ "shape":"Range", "documentation":"

HeadObject returns only the metadata for an object. If the Range is satisfiable, only the ContentLength is affected in the response. If the Range is not satisfiable, S3 returns a 416 - Requested Range Not Satisfiable error.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Range" }, "ResponseCacheControl":{ "shape":"ResponseCacheControl", "documentation":"

Sets the Cache-Control header of the response.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"response-cache-control" }, "ResponseContentDisposition":{ "shape":"ResponseContentDisposition", "documentation":"

Sets the Content-Disposition header of the response.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"response-content-disposition" }, "ResponseContentEncoding":{ "shape":"ResponseContentEncoding", "documentation":"

Sets the Content-Encoding header of the response.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"response-content-encoding" }, "ResponseContentLanguage":{ "shape":"ResponseContentLanguage", "documentation":"

Sets the Content-Language header of the response.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"response-content-language" }, "ResponseContentType":{ "shape":"ResponseContentType", "documentation":"

Sets the Content-Type header of the response.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"response-content-type" }, "ResponseExpires":{ "shape":"ResponseExpires", "documentation":"

Sets the Expires header of the response.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"response-expires" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

Version ID used to reference a specific version of the object.

For directory buckets in this API operation, only the null value of the version ID is supported.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"versionId" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Specifies the algorithm to use when encrypting the object (for example, AES256).

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKey":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKey", "documentation":"

Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use in encrypting data. This value is used to store the object and then it is discarded; Amazon S3 does not store the encryption key. The key must be appropriate for use with the algorithm specified in the x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm header.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321. Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure that the encryption key was transmitted without error.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "PartNumber":{ "shape":"PartNumber", "documentation":"

Part number of the object being read. This is a positive integer between 1 and 10,000. Effectively performs a 'ranged' HEAD request for the part specified. Useful querying about the size of the part and the number of parts in this object.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"partNumber" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "ChecksumMode":{ "shape":"ChecksumMode", "documentation":"

To retrieve the checksum, this parameter must be enabled.

General purpose buckets - If you enable checksum mode and the object is uploaded with a checksum and encrypted with an Key Management Service (KMS) key, you must have permission to use the kms:Decrypt action to retrieve the checksum.

Directory buckets - If you enable ChecksumMode and the object is encrypted with Amazon Web Services Key Management Service (Amazon Web Services KMS), you must also have the kms:GenerateDataKey and kms:Decrypt permissions in IAM identity-based policies and KMS key policies for the KMS key to retrieve the checksum of the object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-mode" } } }, "HostName":{"type":"string"}, "HttpErrorCodeReturnedEquals":{"type":"string"}, "HttpRedirectCode":{"type":"string"}, "ID":{"type":"string"}, "IdempotencyParameterMismatch":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

Parameters on this idempotent request are inconsistent with parameters used in previous request(s).

For a list of error codes and more information on Amazon S3 errors, see Error codes.

Idempotency ensures that an API request completes no more than one time. With an idempotent request, if the original request completes successfully, any subsequent retries complete successfully without performing any further actions.

", "error":{"httpStatusCode":400}, "exception":true }, "IfMatch":{"type":"string"}, "IfMatchInitiatedTime":{ "type":"timestamp", "timestampFormat":"rfc822" }, "IfMatchLastModifiedTime":{ "type":"timestamp", "timestampFormat":"rfc822" }, "IfMatchSize":{ "type":"long", "box":true }, "IfModifiedSince":{"type":"timestamp"}, "IfNoneMatch":{"type":"string"}, "IfUnmodifiedSince":{"type":"timestamp"}, "IndexDocument":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Suffix"], "members":{ "Suffix":{ "shape":"Suffix", "documentation":"

A suffix that is appended to a request that is for a directory on the website endpoint. (For example, if the suffix is index.html and you make a request to samplebucket/images/, the data that is returned will be for the object with the key name images/index.html.) The suffix must not be empty and must not include a slash character.

Replacement must be made for object keys containing special characters (such as carriage returns) when using XML requests. For more information, see XML related object key constraints.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for the Suffix element.

" }, "Initiated":{"type":"timestamp"}, "Initiator":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ID":{ "shape":"ID", "documentation":"

If the principal is an Amazon Web Services account, it provides the Canonical User ID. If the principal is an IAM User, it provides a user ARN value.

Directory buckets - If the principal is an Amazon Web Services account, it provides the Amazon Web Services account ID. If the principal is an IAM User, it provides a user ARN value.

" }, "DisplayName":{ "shape":"DisplayName", "documentation":"

Name of the Principal.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container element that identifies who initiated the multipart upload.

" }, "InputSerialization":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "CSV":{ "shape":"CSVInput", "documentation":"

Describes the serialization of a CSV-encoded object.

" }, "CompressionType":{ "shape":"CompressionType", "documentation":"

Specifies object's compression format. Valid values: NONE, GZIP, BZIP2. Default Value: NONE.

" }, "JSON":{ "shape":"JSONInput", "documentation":"

Specifies JSON as object's input serialization format.

" }, "Parquet":{ "shape":"ParquetInput", "documentation":"

Specifies Parquet as object's input serialization format.

" } }, "documentation":"

Describes the serialization format of the object.

" }, "IntelligentTieringAccessTier":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "ARCHIVE_ACCESS", "DEEP_ARCHIVE_ACCESS" ] }, "IntelligentTieringAndOperator":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

An object key name prefix that identifies the subset of objects to which the configuration applies.

" }, "Tags":{ "shape":"TagSet", "documentation":"

All of these tags must exist in the object's tag set in order for the configuration to apply.

", "flattened":true, "locationName":"Tag" } }, "documentation":"

A container for specifying S3 Intelligent-Tiering filters. The filters determine the subset of objects to which the rule applies.

" }, "IntelligentTieringConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Id", "Status", "Tierings" ], "members":{ "Id":{ "shape":"IntelligentTieringId", "documentation":"

The ID used to identify the S3 Intelligent-Tiering configuration.

" }, "Filter":{ "shape":"IntelligentTieringFilter", "documentation":"

Specifies a bucket filter. The configuration only includes objects that meet the filter's criteria.

" }, "Status":{ "shape":"IntelligentTieringStatus", "documentation":"

Specifies the status of the configuration.

" }, "Tierings":{ "shape":"TieringList", "documentation":"

Specifies the S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class tier of the configuration.

", "locationName":"Tiering" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the S3 Intelligent-Tiering configuration for an Amazon S3 bucket.

For information about the S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class, see Storage class for automatically optimizing frequently and infrequently accessed objects.

" }, "IntelligentTieringConfigurationList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"IntelligentTieringConfiguration"}, "flattened":true }, "IntelligentTieringDays":{ "type":"integer", "box":true }, "IntelligentTieringFilter":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

An object key name prefix that identifies the subset of objects to which the rule applies.

Replacement must be made for object keys containing special characters (such as carriage returns) when using XML requests. For more information, see XML related object key constraints.

" }, "Tag":{"shape":"Tag"}, "And":{ "shape":"IntelligentTieringAndOperator", "documentation":"

A conjunction (logical AND) of predicates, which is used in evaluating a metrics filter. The operator must have at least two predicates, and an object must match all of the predicates in order for the filter to apply.

" } }, "documentation":"

The Filter is used to identify objects that the S3 Intelligent-Tiering configuration applies to.

" }, "IntelligentTieringId":{"type":"string"}, "IntelligentTieringStatus":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Enabled", "Disabled" ] }, "InvalidObjectState":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "StorageClass":{"shape":"StorageClass"}, "AccessTier":{"shape":"IntelligentTieringAccessTier"} }, "documentation":"

Object is archived and inaccessible until restored.

If the object you are retrieving is stored in the S3 Glacier Flexible Retrieval storage class, the S3 Glacier Deep Archive storage class, the S3 Intelligent-Tiering Archive Access tier, or the S3 Intelligent-Tiering Deep Archive Access tier, before you can retrieve the object you must first restore a copy using RestoreObject. Otherwise, this operation returns an InvalidObjectState error. For information about restoring archived objects, see Restoring Archived Objects in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "error":{"httpStatusCode":403}, "exception":true }, "InvalidRequest":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

You may receive this error in multiple cases. Depending on the reason for the error, you may receive one of the messages below:

", "error":{"httpStatusCode":400}, "exception":true }, "InvalidWriteOffset":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

The write offset value that you specified does not match the current object size.

", "error":{"httpStatusCode":400}, "exception":true }, "InventoryConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Destination", "IsEnabled", "Id", "IncludedObjectVersions", "Schedule" ], "members":{ "Destination":{ "shape":"InventoryDestination", "documentation":"

Contains information about where to publish the inventory results.

" }, "IsEnabled":{ "shape":"IsEnabled", "documentation":"

Specifies whether the inventory is enabled or disabled. If set to True, an inventory list is generated. If set to False, no inventory list is generated.

" }, "Filter":{ "shape":"InventoryFilter", "documentation":"

Specifies an inventory filter. The inventory only includes objects that meet the filter's criteria.

" }, "Id":{ "shape":"InventoryId", "documentation":"

The ID used to identify the inventory configuration.

" }, "IncludedObjectVersions":{ "shape":"InventoryIncludedObjectVersions", "documentation":"

Object versions to include in the inventory list. If set to All, the list includes all the object versions, which adds the version-related fields VersionId, IsLatest, and DeleteMarker to the list. If set to Current, the list does not contain these version-related fields.

" }, "OptionalFields":{ "shape":"InventoryOptionalFields", "documentation":"

Contains the optional fields that are included in the inventory results.

" }, "Schedule":{ "shape":"InventorySchedule", "documentation":"

Specifies the schedule for generating inventory results.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the S3 Inventory configuration for an Amazon S3 bucket. For more information, see GET Bucket inventory in the Amazon S3 API Reference.

" }, "InventoryConfigurationList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"InventoryConfiguration"}, "flattened":true }, "InventoryConfigurationState":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "ENABLED", "DISABLED" ] }, "InventoryDestination":{ "type":"structure", "required":["S3BucketDestination"], "members":{ "S3BucketDestination":{ "shape":"InventoryS3BucketDestination", "documentation":"

Contains the bucket name, file format, bucket owner (optional), and prefix (optional) where inventory results are published.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the S3 Inventory configuration for an Amazon S3 bucket.

" }, "InventoryEncryption":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "SSES3":{ "shape":"SSES3", "documentation":"

Specifies the use of SSE-S3 to encrypt delivered inventory reports.

", "locationName":"SSE-S3" }, "SSEKMS":{ "shape":"SSEKMS", "documentation":"

Specifies the use of SSE-KMS to encrypt delivered inventory reports.

", "locationName":"SSE-KMS" } }, "documentation":"

Contains the type of server-side encryption used to encrypt the S3 Inventory results.

" }, "InventoryFilter":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Prefix"], "members":{ "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

The prefix that an object must have to be included in the inventory results.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies an S3 Inventory filter. The inventory only includes objects that meet the filter's criteria.

" }, "InventoryFormat":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "CSV", "ORC", "Parquet" ] }, "InventoryFrequency":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Daily", "Weekly" ] }, "InventoryId":{"type":"string"}, "InventoryIncludedObjectVersions":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "All", "Current" ] }, "InventoryOptionalField":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Size", "LastModifiedDate", "StorageClass", "ETag", "IsMultipartUploaded", "ReplicationStatus", "EncryptionStatus", "ObjectLockRetainUntilDate", "ObjectLockMode", "ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus", "IntelligentTieringAccessTier", "BucketKeyStatus", "ChecksumAlgorithm", "ObjectAccessControlList", "ObjectOwner" ] }, "InventoryOptionalFields":{ "type":"list", "member":{ "shape":"InventoryOptionalField", "locationName":"Field" } }, "InventoryS3BucketDestination":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Format" ], "members":{ "AccountId":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID that owns the destination S3 bucket. If no account ID is provided, the owner is not validated before exporting data.

Although this value is optional, we strongly recommend that you set it to help prevent problems if the destination bucket ownership changes.

" }, "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the bucket where inventory results will be published.

" }, "Format":{ "shape":"InventoryFormat", "documentation":"

Specifies the output format of the inventory results.

" }, "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

The prefix that is prepended to all inventory results.

" }, "Encryption":{ "shape":"InventoryEncryption", "documentation":"

Contains the type of server-side encryption used to encrypt the inventory results.

" } }, "documentation":"

Contains the bucket name, file format, bucket owner (optional), and prefix (optional) where S3 Inventory results are published.

" }, "InventorySchedule":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Frequency"], "members":{ "Frequency":{ "shape":"InventoryFrequency", "documentation":"

Specifies how frequently inventory results are produced.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the schedule for generating S3 Inventory results.

" }, "InventoryTableConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":["ConfigurationState"], "members":{ "ConfigurationState":{ "shape":"InventoryConfigurationState", "documentation":"

The configuration state of the inventory table, indicating whether the inventory table is enabled or disabled.

" }, "EncryptionConfiguration":{ "shape":"MetadataTableEncryptionConfiguration", "documentation":"

The encryption configuration for the inventory table.

" } }, "documentation":"

The inventory table configuration for an S3 Metadata configuration.

" }, "InventoryTableConfigurationResult":{ "type":"structure", "required":["ConfigurationState"], "members":{ "ConfigurationState":{ "shape":"InventoryConfigurationState", "documentation":"

The configuration state of the inventory table, indicating whether the inventory table is enabled or disabled.

" }, "TableStatus":{ "shape":"MetadataTableStatus", "documentation":"

The status of the inventory table. The status values are:

" }, "Error":{"shape":"ErrorDetails"}, "TableName":{ "shape":"S3TablesName", "documentation":"

The name of the inventory table.

" }, "TableArn":{ "shape":"S3TablesArn", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the inventory table.

" } }, "documentation":"

The inventory table configuration for an S3 Metadata configuration.

" }, "InventoryTableConfigurationUpdates":{ "type":"structure", "required":["ConfigurationState"], "members":{ "ConfigurationState":{ "shape":"InventoryConfigurationState", "documentation":"

The configuration state of the inventory table, indicating whether the inventory table is enabled or disabled.

" }, "EncryptionConfiguration":{ "shape":"MetadataTableEncryptionConfiguration", "documentation":"

The encryption configuration for the inventory table.

" } }, "documentation":"

The specified updates to the S3 Metadata inventory table configuration.

" }, "IsEnabled":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "IsLatest":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "IsPublic":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "IsRestoreInProgress":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "IsTruncated":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "JSONInput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Type":{ "shape":"JSONType", "documentation":"

The type of JSON. Valid values: Document, Lines.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies JSON as object's input serialization format.

" }, "JSONOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "RecordDelimiter":{ "shape":"RecordDelimiter", "documentation":"

The value used to separate individual records in the output. If no value is specified, Amazon S3 uses a newline character ('\\n').

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies JSON as request's output serialization format.

" }, "JSONType":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "DOCUMENT", "LINES" ] }, "JournalTableConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":["RecordExpiration"], "members":{ "RecordExpiration":{ "shape":"RecordExpiration", "documentation":"

The journal table record expiration settings for the journal table.

" }, "EncryptionConfiguration":{ "shape":"MetadataTableEncryptionConfiguration", "documentation":"

The encryption configuration for the journal table.

" } }, "documentation":"

The journal table configuration for an S3 Metadata configuration.

" }, "JournalTableConfigurationResult":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "TableStatus", "TableName", "RecordExpiration" ], "members":{ "TableStatus":{ "shape":"MetadataTableStatus", "documentation":"

The status of the journal table. The status values are:

" }, "Error":{"shape":"ErrorDetails"}, "TableName":{ "shape":"S3TablesName", "documentation":"

The name of the journal table.

" }, "TableArn":{ "shape":"S3TablesArn", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the journal table.

" }, "RecordExpiration":{ "shape":"RecordExpiration", "documentation":"

The journal table record expiration settings for the journal table.

" } }, "documentation":"

The journal table configuration for the S3 Metadata configuration.

" }, "JournalTableConfigurationUpdates":{ "type":"structure", "required":["RecordExpiration"], "members":{ "RecordExpiration":{ "shape":"RecordExpiration", "documentation":"

The journal table record expiration settings for the journal table.

" } }, "documentation":"

The specified updates to the S3 Metadata journal table configuration.

" }, "KMSContext":{"type":"string"}, "KeyCount":{"type":"integer"}, "KeyMarker":{"type":"string"}, "KeyPrefixEquals":{"type":"string"}, "KmsKeyArn":{"type":"string"}, "LambdaFunctionArn":{"type":"string"}, "LambdaFunctionConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "LambdaFunctionArn", "Events" ], "members":{ "Id":{"shape":"NotificationId"}, "LambdaFunctionArn":{ "shape":"LambdaFunctionArn", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the Lambda function that Amazon S3 invokes when the specified event type occurs.

", "locationName":"CloudFunction" }, "Events":{ "shape":"EventList", "documentation":"

The Amazon S3 bucket event for which to invoke the Lambda function. For more information, see Supported Event Types in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "locationName":"Event" }, "Filter":{"shape":"NotificationConfigurationFilter"} }, "documentation":"

A container for specifying the configuration for Lambda notifications.

" }, "LambdaFunctionConfigurationList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"LambdaFunctionConfiguration"}, "flattened":true }, "LastModified":{"type":"timestamp"}, "LastModifiedTime":{ "type":"timestamp", "timestampFormat":"rfc822" }, "LifecycleConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Rules"], "members":{ "Rules":{ "shape":"Rules", "documentation":"

Specifies lifecycle configuration rules for an Amazon S3 bucket.

", "locationName":"Rule" } }, "documentation":"

Container for lifecycle rules. You can add as many as 1000 rules.

For more information see, Managing your storage lifecycle in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "LifecycleExpiration":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Date":{ "shape":"Date", "documentation":"

Indicates at what date the object is to be moved or deleted. The date value must conform to the ISO 8601 format. The time is always midnight UTC.

This parameter applies to general purpose buckets only. It is not supported for directory bucket lifecycle configurations.

" }, "Days":{ "shape":"Days", "documentation":"

Indicates the lifetime, in days, of the objects that are subject to the rule. The value must be a non-zero positive integer.

" }, "ExpiredObjectDeleteMarker":{ "shape":"ExpiredObjectDeleteMarker", "documentation":"

Indicates whether Amazon S3 will remove a delete marker with no noncurrent versions. If set to true, the delete marker will be expired; if set to false the policy takes no action. This cannot be specified with Days or Date in a Lifecycle Expiration Policy.

This parameter applies to general purpose buckets only. It is not supported for directory bucket lifecycle configurations.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for the expiration for the lifecycle of the object.

For more information see, Managing your storage lifecycle in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "LifecycleRule":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Status"], "members":{ "Expiration":{ "shape":"LifecycleExpiration", "documentation":"

Specifies the expiration for the lifecycle of the object in the form of date, days and, whether the object has a delete marker.

" }, "ID":{ "shape":"ID", "documentation":"

Unique identifier for the rule. The value cannot be longer than 255 characters.

" }, "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

Prefix identifying one or more objects to which the rule applies. This is no longer used; use Filter instead.

Replacement must be made for object keys containing special characters (such as carriage returns) when using XML requests. For more information, see XML related object key constraints.

", "deprecated":true }, "Filter":{ "shape":"LifecycleRuleFilter", "documentation":"

The Filter is used to identify objects that a Lifecycle Rule applies to. A Filter must have exactly one of Prefix, Tag, ObjectSizeGreaterThan, ObjectSizeLessThan, or And specified. Filter is required if the LifecycleRule does not contain a Prefix element.

For more information about Tag filters, see Adding filters to Lifecycle rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Tag filters are not supported for directory buckets.

" }, "Status":{ "shape":"ExpirationStatus", "documentation":"

If 'Enabled', the rule is currently being applied. If 'Disabled', the rule is not currently being applied.

" }, "Transitions":{ "shape":"TransitionList", "documentation":"

Specifies when an Amazon S3 object transitions to a specified storage class.

This parameter applies to general purpose buckets only. It is not supported for directory bucket lifecycle configurations.

", "locationName":"Transition" }, "NoncurrentVersionTransitions":{ "shape":"NoncurrentVersionTransitionList", "documentation":"

Specifies the transition rule for the lifecycle rule that describes when noncurrent objects transition to a specific storage class. If your bucket is versioning-enabled (or versioning is suspended), you can set this action to request that Amazon S3 transition noncurrent object versions to a specific storage class at a set period in the object's lifetime.

This parameter applies to general purpose buckets only. It is not supported for directory bucket lifecycle configurations.

", "locationName":"NoncurrentVersionTransition" }, "NoncurrentVersionExpiration":{"shape":"NoncurrentVersionExpiration"}, "AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload":{"shape":"AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload"} }, "documentation":"

A lifecycle rule for individual objects in an Amazon S3 bucket.

For more information see, Managing your storage lifecycle in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "LifecycleRuleAndOperator":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

Prefix identifying one or more objects to which the rule applies.

" }, "Tags":{ "shape":"TagSet", "documentation":"

All of these tags must exist in the object's tag set in order for the rule to apply.

", "flattened":true, "locationName":"Tag" }, "ObjectSizeGreaterThan":{ "shape":"ObjectSizeGreaterThanBytes", "documentation":"

Minimum object size to which the rule applies.

" }, "ObjectSizeLessThan":{ "shape":"ObjectSizeLessThanBytes", "documentation":"

Maximum object size to which the rule applies.

" } }, "documentation":"

This is used in a Lifecycle Rule Filter to apply a logical AND to two or more predicates. The Lifecycle Rule will apply to any object matching all of the predicates configured inside the And operator.

" }, "LifecycleRuleFilter":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

Prefix identifying one or more objects to which the rule applies.

Replacement must be made for object keys containing special characters (such as carriage returns) when using XML requests. For more information, see XML related object key constraints.

" }, "Tag":{ "shape":"Tag", "documentation":"

This tag must exist in the object's tag set in order for the rule to apply.

This parameter applies to general purpose buckets only. It is not supported for directory bucket lifecycle configurations.

" }, "ObjectSizeGreaterThan":{ "shape":"ObjectSizeGreaterThanBytes", "documentation":"

Minimum object size to which the rule applies.

" }, "ObjectSizeLessThan":{ "shape":"ObjectSizeLessThanBytes", "documentation":"

Maximum object size to which the rule applies.

" }, "And":{"shape":"LifecycleRuleAndOperator"} }, "documentation":"

The Filter is used to identify objects that a Lifecycle Rule applies to. A Filter can have exactly one of Prefix, Tag, ObjectSizeGreaterThan, ObjectSizeLessThan, or And specified. If the Filter element is left empty, the Lifecycle Rule applies to all objects in the bucket.

" }, "LifecycleRules":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"LifecycleRule"}, "flattened":true }, "ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "IsTruncated":{ "shape":"IsTruncated", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the returned list of analytics configurations is complete. A value of true indicates that the list is not complete and the NextContinuationToken will be provided for a subsequent request.

" }, "ContinuationToken":{ "shape":"Token", "documentation":"

The marker that is used as a starting point for this analytics configuration list response. This value is present if it was sent in the request.

" }, "NextContinuationToken":{ "shape":"NextToken", "documentation":"

NextContinuationToken is sent when isTruncated is true, which indicates that there are more analytics configurations to list. The next request must include this NextContinuationToken. The token is obfuscated and is not a usable value.

" }, "AnalyticsConfigurationList":{ "shape":"AnalyticsConfigurationList", "documentation":"

The list of analytics configurations for a bucket.

", "locationName":"AnalyticsConfiguration" } } }, "ListBucketAnalyticsConfigurationsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket from which analytics configurations are retrieved.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContinuationToken":{ "shape":"Token", "documentation":"

The ContinuationToken that represents a placeholder from where this request should begin.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"continuation-token" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "ListBucketIntelligentTieringConfigurationsOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "IsTruncated":{ "shape":"IsTruncated", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the returned list of analytics configurations is complete. A value of true indicates that the list is not complete and the NextContinuationToken will be provided for a subsequent request.

" }, "ContinuationToken":{ "shape":"Token", "documentation":"

The ContinuationToken that represents a placeholder from where this request should begin.

" }, "NextContinuationToken":{ "shape":"NextToken", "documentation":"

The marker used to continue this inventory configuration listing. Use the NextContinuationToken from this response to continue the listing in a subsequent request. The continuation token is an opaque value that Amazon S3 understands.

" }, "IntelligentTieringConfigurationList":{ "shape":"IntelligentTieringConfigurationList", "documentation":"

The list of S3 Intelligent-Tiering configurations for a bucket.

", "locationName":"IntelligentTieringConfiguration" } } }, "ListBucketIntelligentTieringConfigurationsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the Amazon S3 bucket whose configuration you want to modify or retrieve.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContinuationToken":{ "shape":"Token", "documentation":"

The ContinuationToken that represents a placeholder from where this request should begin.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"continuation-token" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ContinuationToken":{ "shape":"Token", "documentation":"

If sent in the request, the marker that is used as a starting point for this inventory configuration list response.

" }, "InventoryConfigurationList":{ "shape":"InventoryConfigurationList", "documentation":"

The list of inventory configurations for a bucket.

", "locationName":"InventoryConfiguration" }, "IsTruncated":{ "shape":"IsTruncated", "documentation":"

Tells whether the returned list of inventory configurations is complete. A value of true indicates that the list is not complete and the NextContinuationToken is provided for a subsequent request.

" }, "NextContinuationToken":{ "shape":"NextToken", "documentation":"

The marker used to continue this inventory configuration listing. Use the NextContinuationToken from this response to continue the listing in a subsequent request. The continuation token is an opaque value that Amazon S3 understands.

" } } }, "ListBucketInventoryConfigurationsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket containing the inventory configurations to retrieve.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContinuationToken":{ "shape":"Token", "documentation":"

The marker used to continue an inventory configuration listing that has been truncated. Use the NextContinuationToken from a previously truncated list response to continue the listing. The continuation token is an opaque value that Amazon S3 understands.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"continuation-token" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "IsTruncated":{ "shape":"IsTruncated", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the returned list of metrics configurations is complete. A value of true indicates that the list is not complete and the NextContinuationToken will be provided for a subsequent request.

" }, "ContinuationToken":{ "shape":"Token", "documentation":"

The marker that is used as a starting point for this metrics configuration list response. This value is present if it was sent in the request.

" }, "NextContinuationToken":{ "shape":"NextToken", "documentation":"

The marker used to continue a metrics configuration listing that has been truncated. Use the NextContinuationToken from a previously truncated list response to continue the listing. The continuation token is an opaque value that Amazon S3 understands.

" }, "MetricsConfigurationList":{ "shape":"MetricsConfigurationList", "documentation":"

The list of metrics configurations for a bucket.

", "locationName":"MetricsConfiguration" } } }, "ListBucketMetricsConfigurationsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket containing the metrics configurations to retrieve.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContinuationToken":{ "shape":"Token", "documentation":"

The marker that is used to continue a metrics configuration listing that has been truncated. Use the NextContinuationToken from a previously truncated list response to continue the listing. The continuation token is an opaque value that Amazon S3 understands.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"continuation-token" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "ListBucketsOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Buckets":{ "shape":"Buckets", "documentation":"

The list of buckets owned by the requester.

" }, "Owner":{ "shape":"Owner", "documentation":"

The owner of the buckets listed.

" }, "ContinuationToken":{ "shape":"NextToken", "documentation":"

ContinuationToken is included in the response when there are more buckets that can be listed with pagination. The next ListBuckets request to Amazon S3 can be continued with this ContinuationToken. ContinuationToken is obfuscated and is not a real bucket.

" }, "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

If Prefix was sent with the request, it is included in the response.

All bucket names in the response begin with the specified bucket name prefix.

" } } }, "ListBucketsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "MaxBuckets":{ "shape":"MaxBuckets", "documentation":"

Maximum number of buckets to be returned in response. When the number is more than the count of buckets that are owned by an Amazon Web Services account, return all the buckets in response.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"max-buckets" }, "ContinuationToken":{ "shape":"Token", "documentation":"

ContinuationToken indicates to Amazon S3 that the list is being continued on this bucket with a token. ContinuationToken is obfuscated and is not a real key. You can use this ContinuationToken for pagination of the list results.

Length Constraints: Minimum length of 0. Maximum length of 1024.

Required: No.

If you specify the bucket-region, prefix, or continuation-token query parameters without using max-buckets to set the maximum number of buckets returned in the response, Amazon S3 applies a default page size of 10,000 and provides a continuation token if there are more buckets.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"continuation-token" }, "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

Limits the response to bucket names that begin with the specified bucket name prefix.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"prefix" }, "BucketRegion":{ "shape":"BucketRegion", "documentation":"

Limits the response to buckets that are located in the specified Amazon Web Services Region. The Amazon Web Services Region must be expressed according to the Amazon Web Services Region code, such as us-west-2 for the US West (Oregon) Region. For a list of the valid values for all of the Amazon Web Services Regions, see Regions and Endpoints.

Requests made to a Regional endpoint that is different from the bucket-region parameter are not supported. For example, if you want to limit the response to your buckets in Region us-west-2, the request must be made to an endpoint in Region us-west-2.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"bucket-region" } } }, "ListDirectoryBucketsOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Buckets":{ "shape":"Buckets", "documentation":"

The list of buckets owned by the requester.

" }, "ContinuationToken":{ "shape":"DirectoryBucketToken", "documentation":"

If ContinuationToken was sent with the request, it is included in the response. You can use the returned ContinuationToken for pagination of the list response.

" } } }, "ListDirectoryBucketsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ContinuationToken":{ "shape":"DirectoryBucketToken", "documentation":"

ContinuationToken indicates to Amazon S3 that the list is being continued on buckets in this account with a token. ContinuationToken is obfuscated and is not a real bucket name. You can use this ContinuationToken for the pagination of the list results.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"continuation-token" }, "MaxDirectoryBuckets":{ "shape":"MaxDirectoryBuckets", "documentation":"

Maximum number of buckets to be returned in response. When the number is more than the count of buckets that are owned by an Amazon Web Services account, return all the buckets in response.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"max-directory-buckets" } } }, "ListMultipartUploadsOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket to which the multipart upload was initiated. Does not return the access point ARN or access point alias if used.

" }, "KeyMarker":{ "shape":"KeyMarker", "documentation":"

The key at or after which the listing began.

" }, "UploadIdMarker":{ "shape":"UploadIdMarker", "documentation":"

Together with key-marker, specifies the multipart upload after which listing should begin. If key-marker is not specified, the upload-id-marker parameter is ignored. Otherwise, any multipart uploads for a key equal to the key-marker might be included in the list only if they have an upload ID lexicographically greater than the specified upload-id-marker.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

" }, "NextKeyMarker":{ "shape":"NextKeyMarker", "documentation":"

When a list is truncated, this element specifies the value that should be used for the key-marker request parameter in a subsequent request.

" }, "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

When a prefix is provided in the request, this field contains the specified prefix. The result contains only keys starting with the specified prefix.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, only prefixes that end in a delimiter (/) are supported.

" }, "Delimiter":{ "shape":"Delimiter", "documentation":"

Contains the delimiter you specified in the request. If you don't specify a delimiter in your request, this element is absent from the response.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, / is the only supported delimiter.

" }, "NextUploadIdMarker":{ "shape":"NextUploadIdMarker", "documentation":"

When a list is truncated, this element specifies the value that should be used for the upload-id-marker request parameter in a subsequent request.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

" }, "MaxUploads":{ "shape":"MaxUploads", "documentation":"

Maximum number of multipart uploads that could have been included in the response.

" }, "IsTruncated":{ "shape":"IsTruncated", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the returned list of multipart uploads is truncated. A value of true indicates that the list was truncated. The list can be truncated if the number of multipart uploads exceeds the limit allowed or specified by max uploads.

" }, "Uploads":{ "shape":"MultipartUploadList", "documentation":"

Container for elements related to a particular multipart upload. A response can contain zero or more Upload elements.

", "locationName":"Upload" }, "CommonPrefixes":{ "shape":"CommonPrefixList", "documentation":"

If you specify a delimiter in the request, then the result returns each distinct key prefix containing the delimiter in a CommonPrefixes element. The distinct key prefixes are returned in the Prefix child element.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, only prefixes that end in a delimiter (/) are supported.

" }, "EncodingType":{ "shape":"EncodingType", "documentation":"

Encoding type used by Amazon S3 to encode object keys in the response.

If you specify the encoding-type request parameter, Amazon S3 includes this element in the response, and returns encoded key name values in the following response elements:

Delimiter, KeyMarker, Prefix, NextKeyMarker, Key.

" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } } }, "ListMultipartUploadsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket to which the multipart upload was initiated.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Delimiter":{ "shape":"Delimiter", "documentation":"

Character you use to group keys.

All keys that contain the same string between the prefix, if specified, and the first occurrence of the delimiter after the prefix are grouped under a single result element, CommonPrefixes. If you don't specify the prefix parameter, then the substring starts at the beginning of the key. The keys that are grouped under CommonPrefixes result element are not returned elsewhere in the response.

CommonPrefixes is filtered out from results if it is not lexicographically greater than the key-marker.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, / is the only supported delimiter.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"delimiter" }, "EncodingType":{ "shape":"EncodingType", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"encoding-type" }, "KeyMarker":{ "shape":"KeyMarker", "documentation":"

Specifies the multipart upload after which listing should begin.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"key-marker" }, "MaxUploads":{ "shape":"MaxUploads", "documentation":"

Sets the maximum number of multipart uploads, from 1 to 1,000, to return in the response body. 1,000 is the maximum number of uploads that can be returned in a response.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"max-uploads" }, "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

Lists in-progress uploads only for those keys that begin with the specified prefix. You can use prefixes to separate a bucket into different grouping of keys. (You can think of using prefix to make groups in the same way that you'd use a folder in a file system.)

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, only prefixes that end in a delimiter (/) are supported.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Prefix"}, "location":"querystring", "locationName":"prefix" }, "UploadIdMarker":{ "shape":"UploadIdMarker", "documentation":"

Together with key-marker, specifies the multipart upload after which listing should begin. If key-marker is not specified, the upload-id-marker parameter is ignored. Otherwise, any multipart uploads for a key equal to the key-marker might be included in the list only if they have an upload ID lexicographically greater than the specified upload-id-marker.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"upload-id-marker" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" } } }, "ListObjectVersionsOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "IsTruncated":{ "shape":"IsTruncated", "documentation":"

A flag that indicates whether Amazon S3 returned all of the results that satisfied the search criteria. If your results were truncated, you can make a follow-up paginated request by using the NextKeyMarker and NextVersionIdMarker response parameters as a starting place in another request to return the rest of the results.

" }, "KeyMarker":{ "shape":"KeyMarker", "documentation":"

Marks the last key returned in a truncated response.

" }, "VersionIdMarker":{ "shape":"VersionIdMarker", "documentation":"

Marks the last version of the key returned in a truncated response.

" }, "NextKeyMarker":{ "shape":"NextKeyMarker", "documentation":"

When the number of responses exceeds the value of MaxKeys, NextKeyMarker specifies the first key not returned that satisfies the search criteria. Use this value for the key-marker request parameter in a subsequent request.

" }, "NextVersionIdMarker":{ "shape":"NextVersionIdMarker", "documentation":"

When the number of responses exceeds the value of MaxKeys, NextVersionIdMarker specifies the first object version not returned that satisfies the search criteria. Use this value for the version-id-marker request parameter in a subsequent request.

" }, "Versions":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionList", "documentation":"

Container for version information.

", "locationName":"Version" }, "DeleteMarkers":{ "shape":"DeleteMarkers", "documentation":"

Container for an object that is a delete marker. To learn more about delete markers, see Working with delete markers.

", "locationName":"DeleteMarker" }, "Name":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name.

" }, "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

Selects objects that start with the value supplied by this parameter.

" }, "Delimiter":{ "shape":"Delimiter", "documentation":"

The delimiter grouping the included keys. A delimiter is a character that you specify to group keys. All keys that contain the same string between the prefix and the first occurrence of the delimiter are grouped under a single result element in CommonPrefixes. These groups are counted as one result against the max-keys limitation. These keys are not returned elsewhere in the response.

" }, "MaxKeys":{ "shape":"MaxKeys", "documentation":"

Specifies the maximum number of objects to return.

" }, "CommonPrefixes":{ "shape":"CommonPrefixList", "documentation":"

All of the keys rolled up into a common prefix count as a single return when calculating the number of returns.

" }, "EncodingType":{ "shape":"EncodingType", "documentation":"

Encoding type used by Amazon S3 to encode object key names in the XML response.

If you specify the encoding-type request parameter, Amazon S3 includes this element in the response, and returns encoded key name values in the following response elements:

KeyMarker, NextKeyMarker, Prefix, Key, and Delimiter.

" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } } }, "ListObjectVersionsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name that contains the objects.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Delimiter":{ "shape":"Delimiter", "documentation":"

A delimiter is a character that you specify to group keys. All keys that contain the same string between the prefix and the first occurrence of the delimiter are grouped under a single result element in CommonPrefixes. These groups are counted as one result against the max-keys limitation. These keys are not returned elsewhere in the response.

CommonPrefixes is filtered out from results if it is not lexicographically greater than the key-marker.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"delimiter" }, "EncodingType":{ "shape":"EncodingType", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"encoding-type" }, "KeyMarker":{ "shape":"KeyMarker", "documentation":"

Specifies the key to start with when listing objects in a bucket.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"key-marker" }, "MaxKeys":{ "shape":"MaxKeys", "documentation":"

Sets the maximum number of keys returned in the response. By default, the action returns up to 1,000 key names. The response might contain fewer keys but will never contain more. If additional keys satisfy the search criteria, but were not returned because max-keys was exceeded, the response contains <isTruncated>true</isTruncated>. To return the additional keys, see key-marker and version-id-marker.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"max-keys" }, "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

Use this parameter to select only those keys that begin with the specified prefix. You can use prefixes to separate a bucket into different groupings of keys. (You can think of using prefix to make groups in the same way that you'd use a folder in a file system.) You can use prefix with delimiter to roll up numerous objects into a single result under CommonPrefixes.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Prefix"}, "location":"querystring", "locationName":"prefix" }, "VersionIdMarker":{ "shape":"VersionIdMarker", "documentation":"

Specifies the object version you want to start listing from.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"version-id-marker" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "OptionalObjectAttributes":{ "shape":"OptionalObjectAttributesList", "documentation":"

Specifies the optional fields that you want returned in the response. Fields that you do not specify are not returned.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-optional-object-attributes" } } }, "ListObjectsOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "IsTruncated":{ "shape":"IsTruncated", "documentation":"

A flag that indicates whether Amazon S3 returned all of the results that satisfied the search criteria.

" }, "Marker":{ "shape":"Marker", "documentation":"

Indicates where in the bucket listing begins. Marker is included in the response if it was sent with the request.

" }, "NextMarker":{ "shape":"NextMarker", "documentation":"

When the response is truncated (the IsTruncated element value in the response is true), you can use the key name in this field as the marker parameter in the subsequent request to get the next set of objects. Amazon S3 lists objects in alphabetical order.

This element is returned only if you have the delimiter request parameter specified. If the response does not include the NextMarker element and it is truncated, you can use the value of the last Key element in the response as the marker parameter in the subsequent request to get the next set of object keys.

" }, "Contents":{ "shape":"ObjectList", "documentation":"

Metadata about each object returned.

" }, "Name":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name.

" }, "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

Keys that begin with the indicated prefix.

" }, "Delimiter":{ "shape":"Delimiter", "documentation":"

Causes keys that contain the same string between the prefix and the first occurrence of the delimiter to be rolled up into a single result element in the CommonPrefixes collection. These rolled-up keys are not returned elsewhere in the response. Each rolled-up result counts as only one return against the MaxKeys value.

" }, "MaxKeys":{ "shape":"MaxKeys", "documentation":"

The maximum number of keys returned in the response body.

" }, "CommonPrefixes":{ "shape":"CommonPrefixList", "documentation":"

All of the keys (up to 1,000) rolled up in a common prefix count as a single return when calculating the number of returns.

A response can contain CommonPrefixes only if you specify a delimiter.

CommonPrefixes contains all (if there are any) keys between Prefix and the next occurrence of the string specified by the delimiter.

CommonPrefixes lists keys that act like subdirectories in the directory specified by Prefix.

For example, if the prefix is notes/ and the delimiter is a slash (/), as in notes/summer/july, the common prefix is notes/summer/. All of the keys that roll up into a common prefix count as a single return when calculating the number of returns.

" }, "EncodingType":{ "shape":"EncodingType", "documentation":"

Encoding type used by Amazon S3 to encode the object keys in the response. Responses are encoded only in UTF-8. An object key can contain any Unicode character. However, the XML 1.0 parser can't parse certain characters, such as characters with an ASCII value from 0 to 10. For characters that aren't supported in XML 1.0, you can add this parameter to request that Amazon S3 encode the keys in the response. For more information about characters to avoid in object key names, see Object key naming guidelines.

When using the URL encoding type, non-ASCII characters that are used in an object's key name will be percent-encoded according to UTF-8 code values. For example, the object test_file(3).png will appear as test_file%283%29.png.

" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } } }, "ListObjectsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket containing the objects.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Delimiter":{ "shape":"Delimiter", "documentation":"

A delimiter is a character that you use to group keys.

CommonPrefixes is filtered out from results if it is not lexicographically greater than the key-marker.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"delimiter" }, "EncodingType":{ "shape":"EncodingType", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"encoding-type" }, "Marker":{ "shape":"Marker", "documentation":"

Marker is where you want Amazon S3 to start listing from. Amazon S3 starts listing after this specified key. Marker can be any key in the bucket.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"marker" }, "MaxKeys":{ "shape":"MaxKeys", "documentation":"

Sets the maximum number of keys returned in the response. By default, the action returns up to 1,000 key names. The response might contain fewer keys but will never contain more.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"max-keys" }, "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

Limits the response to keys that begin with the specified prefix.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Prefix"}, "location":"querystring", "locationName":"prefix" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "documentation":"

Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the list objects request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "OptionalObjectAttributes":{ "shape":"OptionalObjectAttributesList", "documentation":"

Specifies the optional fields that you want returned in the response. Fields that you do not specify are not returned.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-optional-object-attributes" } } }, "ListObjectsV2Output":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "IsTruncated":{ "shape":"IsTruncated", "documentation":"

Set to false if all of the results were returned. Set to true if more keys are available to return. If the number of results exceeds that specified by MaxKeys, all of the results might not be returned.

" }, "Contents":{ "shape":"ObjectList", "documentation":"

Metadata about each object returned.

" }, "Name":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name.

" }, "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

Keys that begin with the indicated prefix.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, only prefixes that end in a delimiter (/) are supported.

" }, "Delimiter":{ "shape":"Delimiter", "documentation":"

Causes keys that contain the same string between the prefix and the first occurrence of the delimiter to be rolled up into a single result element in the CommonPrefixes collection. These rolled-up keys are not returned elsewhere in the response. Each rolled-up result counts as only one return against the MaxKeys value.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, / is the only supported delimiter.

" }, "MaxKeys":{ "shape":"MaxKeys", "documentation":"

Sets the maximum number of keys returned in the response. By default, the action returns up to 1,000 key names. The response might contain fewer keys but will never contain more.

" }, "CommonPrefixes":{ "shape":"CommonPrefixList", "documentation":"

All of the keys (up to 1,000) that share the same prefix are grouped together. When counting the total numbers of returns by this API operation, this group of keys is considered as one item.

A response can contain CommonPrefixes only if you specify a delimiter.

CommonPrefixes contains all (if there are any) keys between Prefix and the next occurrence of the string specified by a delimiter.

CommonPrefixes lists keys that act like subdirectories in the directory specified by Prefix.

For example, if the prefix is notes/ and the delimiter is a slash (/) as in notes/summer/july, the common prefix is notes/summer/. All of the keys that roll up into a common prefix count as a single return when calculating the number of returns.

" }, "EncodingType":{ "shape":"EncodingType", "documentation":"

Encoding type used by Amazon S3 to encode object key names in the XML response.

If you specify the encoding-type request parameter, Amazon S3 includes this element in the response, and returns encoded key name values in the following response elements:

Delimiter, Prefix, Key, and StartAfter.

" }, "KeyCount":{ "shape":"KeyCount", "documentation":"

KeyCount is the number of keys returned with this request. KeyCount will always be less than or equal to the MaxKeys field. For example, if you ask for 50 keys, your result will include 50 keys or fewer.

" }, "ContinuationToken":{ "shape":"Token", "documentation":"

If ContinuationToken was sent with the request, it is included in the response. You can use the returned ContinuationToken for pagination of the list response.

" }, "NextContinuationToken":{ "shape":"NextToken", "documentation":"

NextContinuationToken is sent when isTruncated is true, which means there are more keys in the bucket that can be listed. The next list requests to Amazon S3 can be continued with this NextContinuationToken. NextContinuationToken is obfuscated and is not a real key

" }, "StartAfter":{ "shape":"StartAfter", "documentation":"

If StartAfter was sent with the request, it is included in the response.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } } }, "ListObjectsV2Request":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Delimiter":{ "shape":"Delimiter", "documentation":"

A delimiter is a character that you use to group keys.

CommonPrefixes is filtered out from results if it is not lexicographically greater than the StartAfter value.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"delimiter" }, "EncodingType":{ "shape":"EncodingType", "documentation":"

Encoding type used by Amazon S3 to encode the object keys in the response. Responses are encoded only in UTF-8. An object key can contain any Unicode character. However, the XML 1.0 parser can't parse certain characters, such as characters with an ASCII value from 0 to 10. For characters that aren't supported in XML 1.0, you can add this parameter to request that Amazon S3 encode the keys in the response. For more information about characters to avoid in object key names, see Object key naming guidelines.

When using the URL encoding type, non-ASCII characters that are used in an object's key name will be percent-encoded according to UTF-8 code values. For example, the object test_file(3).png will appear as test_file%283%29.png.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"encoding-type" }, "MaxKeys":{ "shape":"MaxKeys", "documentation":"

Sets the maximum number of keys returned in the response. By default, the action returns up to 1,000 key names. The response might contain fewer keys but will never contain more.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"max-keys" }, "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

Limits the response to keys that begin with the specified prefix.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, only prefixes that end in a delimiter (/) are supported.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Prefix"}, "location":"querystring", "locationName":"prefix" }, "ContinuationToken":{ "shape":"Token", "documentation":"

ContinuationToken indicates to Amazon S3 that the list is being continued on this bucket with a token. ContinuationToken is obfuscated and is not a real key. You can use this ContinuationToken for pagination of the list results.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"continuation-token" }, "FetchOwner":{ "shape":"FetchOwner", "documentation":"

The owner field is not present in ListObjectsV2 by default. If you want to return the owner field with each key in the result, then set the FetchOwner field to true.

Directory buckets - For directory buckets, the bucket owner is returned as the object owner for all objects.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"fetch-owner" }, "StartAfter":{ "shape":"StartAfter", "documentation":"

StartAfter is where you want Amazon S3 to start listing from. Amazon S3 starts listing after this specified key. StartAfter can be any key in the bucket.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"start-after" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "documentation":"

Confirms that the requester knows that she or he will be charged for the list objects request in V2 style. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "OptionalObjectAttributes":{ "shape":"OptionalObjectAttributesList", "documentation":"

Specifies the optional fields that you want returned in the response. Fields that you do not specify are not returned.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-optional-object-attributes" } } }, "ListPartsOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "AbortDate":{ "shape":"AbortDate", "documentation":"

If the bucket has a lifecycle rule configured with an action to abort incomplete multipart uploads and the prefix in the lifecycle rule matches the object name in the request, then the response includes this header indicating when the initiated multipart upload will become eligible for abort operation. For more information, see Aborting Incomplete Multipart Uploads Using a Bucket Lifecycle Configuration.

The response will also include the x-amz-abort-rule-id header that will provide the ID of the lifecycle configuration rule that defines this action.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-abort-date" }, "AbortRuleId":{ "shape":"AbortRuleId", "documentation":"

This header is returned along with the x-amz-abort-date header. It identifies applicable lifecycle configuration rule that defines the action to abort incomplete multipart uploads.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-abort-rule-id" }, "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket to which the multipart upload was initiated. Does not return the access point ARN or access point alias if used.

" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Object key for which the multipart upload was initiated.

" }, "UploadId":{ "shape":"MultipartUploadId", "documentation":"

Upload ID identifying the multipart upload whose parts are being listed.

" }, "PartNumberMarker":{ "shape":"PartNumberMarker", "documentation":"

Specifies the part after which listing should begin. Only parts with higher part numbers will be listed.

" }, "NextPartNumberMarker":{ "shape":"NextPartNumberMarker", "documentation":"

When a list is truncated, this element specifies the last part in the list, as well as the value to use for the part-number-marker request parameter in a subsequent request.

" }, "MaxParts":{ "shape":"MaxParts", "documentation":"

Maximum number of parts that were allowed in the response.

" }, "IsTruncated":{ "shape":"IsTruncated", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the returned list of parts is truncated. A true value indicates that the list was truncated. A list can be truncated if the number of parts exceeds the limit returned in the MaxParts element.

" }, "Parts":{ "shape":"Parts", "documentation":"

Container for elements related to a particular part. A response can contain zero or more Part elements.

", "locationName":"Part" }, "Initiator":{ "shape":"Initiator", "documentation":"

Container element that identifies who initiated the multipart upload. If the initiator is an Amazon Web Services account, this element provides the same information as the Owner element. If the initiator is an IAM User, this element provides the user ARN and display name.

" }, "Owner":{ "shape":"Owner", "documentation":"

Container element that identifies the object owner, after the object is created. If multipart upload is initiated by an IAM user, this element provides the parent account ID and display name.

Directory buckets - The bucket owner is returned as the object owner for all the parts.

" }, "StorageClass":{ "shape":"StorageClass", "documentation":"

The class of storage used to store the uploaded object.

Directory buckets - Directory buckets only support EXPRESS_ONEZONE (the S3 Express One Zone storage class) in Availability Zones and ONEZONE_IA (the S3 One Zone-Infrequent Access storage class) in Dedicated Local Zones.

" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

The algorithm that was used to create a checksum of the object.

" }, "ChecksumType":{ "shape":"ChecksumType", "documentation":"

The checksum type, which determines how part-level checksums are combined to create an object-level checksum for multipart objects. You can use this header response to verify that the checksum type that is received is the same checksum type that was specified in CreateMultipartUpload request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" } } }, "ListPartsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key", "UploadId" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket to which the parts are being uploaded.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Object key for which the multipart upload was initiated.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Key"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "MaxParts":{ "shape":"MaxParts", "documentation":"

Sets the maximum number of parts to return.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"max-parts" }, "PartNumberMarker":{ "shape":"PartNumberMarker", "documentation":"

Specifies the part after which listing should begin. Only parts with higher part numbers will be listed.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"part-number-marker" }, "UploadId":{ "shape":"MultipartUploadId", "documentation":"

Upload ID identifying the multipart upload whose parts are being listed.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"uploadId" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption (SSE) algorithm used to encrypt the object. This parameter is needed only when the object was created using a checksum algorithm. For more information, see Protecting data using SSE-C keys in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKey":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKey", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption (SSE) customer managed key. This parameter is needed only when the object was created using a checksum algorithm. For more information, see Protecting data using SSE-C keys in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

The MD5 server-side encryption (SSE) customer managed key. This parameter is needed only when the object was created using a checksum algorithm. For more information, see Protecting data using SSE-C keys in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" } } }, "Location":{"type":"string"}, "LocationInfo":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Type":{ "shape":"LocationType", "documentation":"

The type of location where the bucket will be created.

" }, "Name":{ "shape":"LocationNameAsString", "documentation":"

The name of the location where the bucket will be created.

For directory buckets, the name of the location is the Zone ID of the Availability Zone (AZ) or Local Zone (LZ) where the bucket will be created. An example AZ ID value is usw2-az1.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the location where the bucket will be created.

For directory buckets, the location type is Availability Zone or Local Zone. For more information about directory buckets, see Working with directory buckets in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is only supported by directory buckets.

" }, "LocationNameAsString":{"type":"string"}, "LocationPrefix":{"type":"string"}, "LocationType":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "AvailabilityZone", "LocalZone" ] }, "LoggingEnabled":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "TargetBucket", "TargetPrefix" ], "members":{ "TargetBucket":{ "shape":"TargetBucket", "documentation":"

Specifies the bucket where you want Amazon S3 to store server access logs. You can have your logs delivered to any bucket that you own, including the same bucket that is being logged. You can also configure multiple buckets to deliver their logs to the same target bucket. In this case, you should choose a different TargetPrefix for each source bucket so that the delivered log files can be distinguished by key.

" }, "TargetGrants":{ "shape":"TargetGrants", "documentation":"

Container for granting information.

Buckets that use the bucket owner enforced setting for Object Ownership don't support target grants. For more information, see Permissions for server access log delivery in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "TargetPrefix":{ "shape":"TargetPrefix", "documentation":"

A prefix for all log object keys. If you store log files from multiple Amazon S3 buckets in a single bucket, you can use a prefix to distinguish which log files came from which bucket.

" }, "TargetObjectKeyFormat":{ "shape":"TargetObjectKeyFormat", "documentation":"

Amazon S3 key format for log objects.

" } }, "documentation":"

Describes where logs are stored and the prefix that Amazon S3 assigns to all log object keys for a bucket. For more information, see PUT Bucket logging in the Amazon S3 API Reference.

" }, "MFA":{"type":"string"}, "MFADelete":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Enabled", "Disabled" ] }, "MFADeleteStatus":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Enabled", "Disabled" ] }, "Marker":{"type":"string"}, "MaxAgeSeconds":{ "type":"integer", "box":true }, "MaxBuckets":{ "type":"integer", "box":true, "max":10000, "min":1 }, "MaxDirectoryBuckets":{ "type":"integer", "box":true, "max":1000, "min":0 }, "MaxKeys":{"type":"integer"}, "MaxParts":{"type":"integer"}, "MaxUploads":{"type":"integer"}, "Message":{"type":"string"}, "Metadata":{ "type":"map", "key":{"shape":"MetadataKey"}, "value":{"shape":"MetadataValue"} }, "MetadataConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":["JournalTableConfiguration"], "members":{ "JournalTableConfiguration":{ "shape":"JournalTableConfiguration", "documentation":"

The journal table configuration for a metadata configuration.

" }, "InventoryTableConfiguration":{ "shape":"InventoryTableConfiguration", "documentation":"

The inventory table configuration for a metadata configuration.

" } }, "documentation":"

The S3 Metadata configuration for a general purpose bucket.

" }, "MetadataConfigurationResult":{ "type":"structure", "required":["DestinationResult"], "members":{ "DestinationResult":{ "shape":"DestinationResult", "documentation":"

The destination settings for a metadata configuration.

" }, "JournalTableConfigurationResult":{ "shape":"JournalTableConfigurationResult", "documentation":"

The journal table configuration for a metadata configuration.

" }, "InventoryTableConfigurationResult":{ "shape":"InventoryTableConfigurationResult", "documentation":"

The inventory table configuration for a metadata configuration.

" } }, "documentation":"

The S3 Metadata configuration for a general purpose bucket.

" }, "MetadataDirective":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "COPY", "REPLACE" ] }, "MetadataEntry":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Name":{ "shape":"MetadataKey", "documentation":"

Name of the object.

" }, "Value":{ "shape":"MetadataValue", "documentation":"

Value of the object.

" } }, "documentation":"

A metadata key-value pair to store with an object.

" }, "MetadataKey":{"type":"string"}, "MetadataTableConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":["S3TablesDestination"], "members":{ "S3TablesDestination":{ "shape":"S3TablesDestination", "documentation":"

The destination information for the metadata table configuration. The destination table bucket must be in the same Region and Amazon Web Services account as the general purpose bucket. The specified metadata table name must be unique within the aws_s3_metadata namespace in the destination table bucket.

" } }, "documentation":"

The V1 S3 Metadata configuration for a general purpose bucket.

If you created your S3 Metadata configuration before July 15, 2025, we recommend that you delete and re-create your configuration by using CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration so that you can expire journal table records and create a live inventory table.

" }, "MetadataTableConfigurationResult":{ "type":"structure", "required":["S3TablesDestinationResult"], "members":{ "S3TablesDestinationResult":{ "shape":"S3TablesDestinationResult", "documentation":"

The destination information for the metadata table configuration. The destination table bucket must be in the same Region and Amazon Web Services account as the general purpose bucket. The specified metadata table name must be unique within the aws_s3_metadata namespace in the destination table bucket.

" } }, "documentation":"

The V1 S3 Metadata configuration for a general purpose bucket. The destination table bucket must be in the same Region and Amazon Web Services account as the general purpose bucket. The specified metadata table name must be unique within the aws_s3_metadata namespace in the destination table bucket.

If you created your S3 Metadata configuration before July 15, 2025, we recommend that you delete and re-create your configuration by using CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration so that you can expire journal table records and create a live inventory table.

" }, "MetadataTableEncryptionConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":["SseAlgorithm"], "members":{ "SseAlgorithm":{ "shape":"TableSseAlgorithm", "documentation":"

The encryption type specified for a metadata table. To specify server-side encryption with Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS), use the aws:kms value. To specify server-side encryption with Amazon S3 managed keys (SSE-S3), use the AES256 value.

" }, "KmsKeyArn":{ "shape":"KmsKeyArn", "documentation":"

If server-side encryption with Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS) is specified, you must also specify the KMS key Amazon Resource Name (ARN). You must specify a customer-managed KMS key that's located in the same Region as the general purpose bucket that corresponds to the metadata table configuration.

" } }, "documentation":"

The encryption settings for an S3 Metadata journal table or inventory table configuration.

" }, "MetadataTableStatus":{"type":"string"}, "MetadataValue":{"type":"string"}, "Metrics":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Status"], "members":{ "Status":{ "shape":"MetricsStatus", "documentation":"

Specifies whether the replication metrics are enabled.

" }, "EventThreshold":{ "shape":"ReplicationTimeValue", "documentation":"

A container specifying the time threshold for emitting the s3:Replication:OperationMissedThreshold event.

" } }, "documentation":"

A container specifying replication metrics-related settings enabling replication metrics and events.

" }, "MetricsAndOperator":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

The prefix used when evaluating an AND predicate.

" }, "Tags":{ "shape":"TagSet", "documentation":"

The list of tags used when evaluating an AND predicate.

", "flattened":true, "locationName":"Tag" }, "AccessPointArn":{ "shape":"AccessPointArn", "documentation":"

The access point ARN used when evaluating an AND predicate.

" } }, "documentation":"

A conjunction (logical AND) of predicates, which is used in evaluating a metrics filter. The operator must have at least two predicates, and an object must match all of the predicates in order for the filter to apply.

" }, "MetricsConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Id"], "members":{ "Id":{ "shape":"MetricsId", "documentation":"

The ID used to identify the metrics configuration. The ID has a 64 character limit and can only contain letters, numbers, periods, dashes, and underscores.

" }, "Filter":{ "shape":"MetricsFilter", "documentation":"

Specifies a metrics configuration filter. The metrics configuration will only include objects that meet the filter's criteria. A filter must be a prefix, an object tag, an access point ARN, or a conjunction (MetricsAndOperator).

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies a metrics configuration for the CloudWatch request metrics (specified by the metrics configuration ID) from an Amazon S3 bucket. If you're updating an existing metrics configuration, note that this is a full replacement of the existing metrics configuration. If you don't include the elements you want to keep, they are erased. For more information, see PutBucketMetricsConfiguration.

" }, "MetricsConfigurationList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"MetricsConfiguration"}, "flattened":true }, "MetricsFilter":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

The prefix used when evaluating a metrics filter.

" }, "Tag":{ "shape":"Tag", "documentation":"

The tag used when evaluating a metrics filter.

" }, "AccessPointArn":{ "shape":"AccessPointArn", "documentation":"

The access point ARN used when evaluating a metrics filter.

" }, "And":{ "shape":"MetricsAndOperator", "documentation":"

A conjunction (logical AND) of predicates, which is used in evaluating a metrics filter. The operator must have at least two predicates, and an object must match all of the predicates in order for the filter to apply.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies a metrics configuration filter. The metrics configuration only includes objects that meet the filter's criteria. A filter must be a prefix, an object tag, an access point ARN, or a conjunction (MetricsAndOperator). For more information, see PutBucketMetricsConfiguration.

" }, "MetricsId":{"type":"string"}, "MetricsStatus":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Enabled", "Disabled" ] }, "Minutes":{ "type":"integer", "box":true }, "MissingMeta":{"type":"integer"}, "MpuObjectSize":{"type":"long"}, "MultipartUpload":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "UploadId":{ "shape":"MultipartUploadId", "documentation":"

Upload ID that identifies the multipart upload.

" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Key of the object for which the multipart upload was initiated.

" }, "Initiated":{ "shape":"Initiated", "documentation":"

Date and time at which the multipart upload was initiated.

" }, "StorageClass":{ "shape":"StorageClass", "documentation":"

The class of storage used to store the object.

Directory buckets - Directory buckets only support EXPRESS_ONEZONE (the S3 Express One Zone storage class) in Availability Zones and ONEZONE_IA (the S3 One Zone-Infrequent Access storage class) in Dedicated Local Zones.

" }, "Owner":{ "shape":"Owner", "documentation":"

Specifies the owner of the object that is part of the multipart upload.

Directory buckets - The bucket owner is returned as the object owner for all the objects.

" }, "Initiator":{ "shape":"Initiator", "documentation":"

Identifies who initiated the multipart upload.

" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

The algorithm that was used to create a checksum of the object.

" }, "ChecksumType":{ "shape":"ChecksumType", "documentation":"

The checksum type that is used to calculate the object’s checksum value. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for the MultipartUpload for the Amazon S3 object.

" }, "MultipartUploadId":{"type":"string"}, "MultipartUploadList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"MultipartUpload"}, "flattened":true }, "NextKeyMarker":{"type":"string"}, "NextMarker":{"type":"string"}, "NextPartNumberMarker":{ "type":"integer", "box":true }, "NextToken":{"type":"string"}, "NextUploadIdMarker":{"type":"string"}, "NextVersionIdMarker":{"type":"string"}, "NoSuchBucket":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

The specified bucket does not exist.

", "error":{"httpStatusCode":404}, "exception":true }, "NoSuchKey":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

The specified key does not exist.

", "error":{"httpStatusCode":404}, "exception":true }, "NoSuchUpload":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

The specified multipart upload does not exist.

", "error":{"httpStatusCode":404}, "exception":true }, "NoncurrentVersionExpiration":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "NoncurrentDays":{ "shape":"Days", "documentation":"

Specifies the number of days an object is noncurrent before Amazon S3 can perform the associated action. The value must be a non-zero positive integer. For information about the noncurrent days calculations, see How Amazon S3 Calculates When an Object Became Noncurrent in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This parameter applies to general purpose buckets only. It is not supported for directory bucket lifecycle configurations.

" }, "NewerNoncurrentVersions":{ "shape":"VersionCount", "documentation":"

Specifies how many noncurrent versions Amazon S3 will retain. You can specify up to 100 noncurrent versions to retain. Amazon S3 will permanently delete any additional noncurrent versions beyond the specified number to retain. For more information about noncurrent versions, see Lifecycle configuration elements in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This parameter applies to general purpose buckets only. It is not supported for directory bucket lifecycle configurations.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies when noncurrent object versions expire. Upon expiration, Amazon S3 permanently deletes the noncurrent object versions. You set this lifecycle configuration action on a bucket that has versioning enabled (or suspended) to request that Amazon S3 delete noncurrent object versions at a specific period in the object's lifetime.

This parameter applies to general purpose buckets only. It is not supported for directory bucket lifecycle configurations.

" }, "NoncurrentVersionTransition":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "NoncurrentDays":{ "shape":"Days", "documentation":"

Specifies the number of days an object is noncurrent before Amazon S3 can perform the associated action. For information about the noncurrent days calculations, see How Amazon S3 Calculates How Long an Object Has Been Noncurrent in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "StorageClass":{ "shape":"TransitionStorageClass", "documentation":"

The class of storage used to store the object.

" }, "NewerNoncurrentVersions":{ "shape":"VersionCount", "documentation":"

Specifies how many noncurrent versions Amazon S3 will retain in the same storage class before transitioning objects. You can specify up to 100 noncurrent versions to retain. Amazon S3 will transition any additional noncurrent versions beyond the specified number to retain. For more information about noncurrent versions, see Lifecycle configuration elements in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for the transition rule that describes when noncurrent objects transition to the STANDARD_IA, ONEZONE_IA, INTELLIGENT_TIERING, GLACIER_IR, GLACIER, or DEEP_ARCHIVE storage class. If your bucket is versioning-enabled (or versioning is suspended), you can set this action to request that Amazon S3 transition noncurrent object versions to the STANDARD_IA, ONEZONE_IA, INTELLIGENT_TIERING, GLACIER_IR, GLACIER, or DEEP_ARCHIVE storage class at a specific period in the object's lifetime.

" }, "NoncurrentVersionTransitionList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"NoncurrentVersionTransition"}, "flattened":true }, "NotificationConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "TopicConfigurations":{ "shape":"TopicConfigurationList", "documentation":"

The topic to which notifications are sent and the events for which notifications are generated.

", "locationName":"TopicConfiguration" }, "QueueConfigurations":{ "shape":"QueueConfigurationList", "documentation":"

The Amazon Simple Queue Service queues to publish messages to and the events for which to publish messages.

", "locationName":"QueueConfiguration" }, "LambdaFunctionConfigurations":{ "shape":"LambdaFunctionConfigurationList", "documentation":"

Describes the Lambda functions to invoke and the events for which to invoke them.

", "locationName":"CloudFunctionConfiguration" }, "EventBridgeConfiguration":{ "shape":"EventBridgeConfiguration", "documentation":"

Enables delivery of events to Amazon EventBridge.

" } }, "documentation":"

A container for specifying the notification configuration of the bucket. If this element is empty, notifications are turned off for the bucket.

" }, "NotificationConfigurationDeprecated":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "TopicConfiguration":{ "shape":"TopicConfigurationDeprecated", "documentation":"

This data type is deprecated. A container for specifying the configuration for publication of messages to an Amazon Simple Notification Service (Amazon SNS) topic when Amazon S3 detects specified events.

" }, "QueueConfiguration":{ "shape":"QueueConfigurationDeprecated", "documentation":"

This data type is deprecated. This data type specifies the configuration for publishing messages to an Amazon Simple Queue Service (Amazon SQS) queue when Amazon S3 detects specified events.

" }, "CloudFunctionConfiguration":{ "shape":"CloudFunctionConfiguration", "documentation":"

Container for specifying the Lambda notification configuration.

" } } }, "NotificationConfigurationFilter":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Key":{ "shape":"S3KeyFilter", "locationName":"S3Key" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies object key name filtering rules. For information about key name filtering, see Configuring event notifications using object key name filtering in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "NotificationId":{ "type":"string", "documentation":"

An optional unique identifier for configurations in a notification configuration. If you don't provide one, Amazon S3 will assign an ID.

" }, "Object":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The name that you assign to an object. You use the object key to retrieve the object.

" }, "LastModified":{ "shape":"LastModified", "documentation":"

Creation date of the object.

" }, "ETag":{ "shape":"ETag", "documentation":"

The entity tag is a hash of the object. The ETag reflects changes only to the contents of an object, not its metadata. The ETag may or may not be an MD5 digest of the object data. Whether or not it is depends on how the object was created and how it is encrypted as described below:

Directory buckets - MD5 is not supported by directory buckets.

" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithmList", "documentation":"

The algorithm that was used to create a checksum of the object.

" }, "ChecksumType":{ "shape":"ChecksumType", "documentation":"

The checksum type that is used to calculate the object’s checksum value. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "Size":{ "shape":"Size", "documentation":"

Size in bytes of the object

" }, "StorageClass":{ "shape":"ObjectStorageClass", "documentation":"

The class of storage used to store the object.

Directory buckets - Directory buckets only support EXPRESS_ONEZONE (the S3 Express One Zone storage class) in Availability Zones and ONEZONE_IA (the S3 One Zone-Infrequent Access storage class) in Dedicated Local Zones.

" }, "Owner":{ "shape":"Owner", "documentation":"

The owner of the object

Directory buckets - The bucket owner is returned as the object owner.

" }, "RestoreStatus":{ "shape":"RestoreStatus", "documentation":"

Specifies the restoration status of an object. Objects in certain storage classes must be restored before they can be retrieved. For more information about these storage classes and how to work with archived objects, see Working with archived objects in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets. Directory buckets only support EXPRESS_ONEZONE (the S3 Express One Zone storage class) in Availability Zones and ONEZONE_IA (the S3 One Zone-Infrequent Access storage class) in Dedicated Local Zones.

" } }, "documentation":"

An object consists of data and its descriptive metadata.

" }, "ObjectAlreadyInActiveTierError":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

This action is not allowed against this storage tier.

", "error":{"httpStatusCode":403}, "exception":true }, "ObjectAttributes":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "ETag", "Checksum", "ObjectParts", "StorageClass", "ObjectSize" ] }, "ObjectAttributesList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"ObjectAttributes"} }, "ObjectCannedACL":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "private", "public-read", "public-read-write", "authenticated-read", "aws-exec-read", "bucket-owner-read", "bucket-owner-full-control" ] }, "ObjectIdentifier":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Key"], "members":{ "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Key name of the object.

Replacement must be made for object keys containing special characters (such as carriage returns) when using XML requests. For more information, see XML related object key constraints.

" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

Version ID for the specific version of the object to delete.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

" }, "ETag":{ "shape":"ETag", "documentation":"

An entity tag (ETag) is an identifier assigned by a web server to a specific version of a resource found at a URL. This header field makes the request method conditional on ETags.

Entity tags (ETags) for S3 Express One Zone are random alphanumeric strings unique to the object.

" }, "LastModifiedTime":{ "shape":"LastModifiedTime", "documentation":"

If present, the objects are deleted only if its modification times matches the provided Timestamp.

This functionality is only supported for directory buckets.

" }, "Size":{ "shape":"Size", "documentation":"

If present, the objects are deleted only if its size matches the provided size in bytes.

This functionality is only supported for directory buckets.

" } }, "documentation":"

Object Identifier is unique value to identify objects.

" }, "ObjectIdentifierList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"ObjectIdentifier"}, "flattened":true }, "ObjectKey":{ "type":"string", "min":1 }, "ObjectList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"Object"}, "flattened":true }, "ObjectLockConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ObjectLockEnabled":{ "shape":"ObjectLockEnabled", "documentation":"

Indicates whether this bucket has an Object Lock configuration enabled. Enable ObjectLockEnabled when you apply ObjectLockConfiguration to a bucket.

" }, "Rule":{ "shape":"ObjectLockRule", "documentation":"

Specifies the Object Lock rule for the specified object. Enable the this rule when you apply ObjectLockConfiguration to a bucket. Bucket settings require both a mode and a period. The period can be either Days or Years but you must select one. You cannot specify Days and Years at the same time.

" } }, "documentation":"

The container element for Object Lock configuration parameters.

" }, "ObjectLockEnabled":{ "type":"string", "enum":["Enabled"] }, "ObjectLockEnabledForBucket":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "ObjectLockLegalHold":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Status":{ "shape":"ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the specified object has a legal hold in place.

" } }, "documentation":"

A legal hold configuration for an object.

" }, "ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "ON", "OFF" ] }, "ObjectLockMode":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "GOVERNANCE", "COMPLIANCE" ] }, "ObjectLockRetainUntilDate":{ "type":"timestamp", "timestampFormat":"iso8601" }, "ObjectLockRetention":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Mode":{ "shape":"ObjectLockRetentionMode", "documentation":"

Indicates the Retention mode for the specified object.

" }, "RetainUntilDate":{ "shape":"Date", "documentation":"

The date on which this Object Lock Retention will expire.

" } }, "documentation":"

A Retention configuration for an object.

" }, "ObjectLockRetentionMode":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "GOVERNANCE", "COMPLIANCE" ] }, "ObjectLockRule":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "DefaultRetention":{ "shape":"DefaultRetention", "documentation":"

The default Object Lock retention mode and period that you want to apply to new objects placed in the specified bucket. Bucket settings require both a mode and a period. The period can be either Days or Years but you must select one. You cannot specify Days and Years at the same time.

" } }, "documentation":"

The container element for an Object Lock rule.

" }, "ObjectLockToken":{"type":"string"}, "ObjectNotInActiveTierError":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

The source object of the COPY action is not in the active tier and is only stored in Amazon S3 Glacier.

", "error":{"httpStatusCode":403}, "exception":true }, "ObjectOwnership":{ "type":"string", "documentation":"

The container element for object ownership for a bucket's ownership controls.

BucketOwnerPreferred - Objects uploaded to the bucket change ownership to the bucket owner if the objects are uploaded with the bucket-owner-full-control canned ACL.

ObjectWriter - The uploading account will own the object if the object is uploaded with the bucket-owner-full-control canned ACL.

BucketOwnerEnforced - Access control lists (ACLs) are disabled and no longer affect permissions. The bucket owner automatically owns and has full control over every object in the bucket. The bucket only accepts PUT requests that don't specify an ACL or specify bucket owner full control ACLs (such as the predefined bucket-owner-full-control canned ACL or a custom ACL in XML format that grants the same permissions).

By default, ObjectOwnership is set to BucketOwnerEnforced and ACLs are disabled. We recommend keeping ACLs disabled, except in uncommon use cases where you must control access for each object individually. For more information about S3 Object Ownership, see Controlling ownership of objects and disabling ACLs for your bucket in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets. Directory buckets use the bucket owner enforced setting for S3 Object Ownership.

", "enum":[ "BucketOwnerPreferred", "ObjectWriter", "BucketOwnerEnforced" ] }, "ObjectPart":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "PartNumber":{ "shape":"PartNumber", "documentation":"

The part number identifying the part. This value is a positive integer between 1 and 10,000.

" }, "Size":{ "shape":"Size", "documentation":"

The size of the uploaded part in bytes.

" }, "ChecksumCRC32":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32 checksum of the part. This checksum is present if the multipart upload request was created with the CRC32 checksum algorithm. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumCRC32C":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32C", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32C checksum of the part. This checksum is present if the multipart upload request was created with the CRC32C checksum algorithm. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumCRC64NVME":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC64NVME", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 64-bit CRC64NVME checksum of the part. This checksum is present if the multipart upload request was created with the CRC64NVME checksum algorithm, or if the object was uploaded without a checksum (and Amazon S3 added the default checksum, CRC64NVME, to the uploaded object). For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumSHA1":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA1", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 160-bit SHA1 checksum of the part. This checksum is present if the multipart upload request was created with the SHA1 checksum algorithm. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumSHA256":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA256", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 256-bit SHA256 checksum of the part. This checksum is present if the multipart upload request was created with the SHA256 checksum algorithm. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" } }, "documentation":"

A container for elements related to an individual part.

" }, "ObjectSize":{ "type":"long", "box":true }, "ObjectSizeGreaterThanBytes":{ "type":"long", "box":true }, "ObjectSizeLessThanBytes":{ "type":"long", "box":true }, "ObjectStorageClass":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "STANDARD", "REDUCED_REDUNDANCY", "GLACIER", "STANDARD_IA", "ONEZONE_IA", "INTELLIGENT_TIERING", "DEEP_ARCHIVE", "OUTPOSTS", "GLACIER_IR", "SNOW", "EXPRESS_ONEZONE", "FSX_OPENZFS" ] }, "ObjectVersion":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ETag":{ "shape":"ETag", "documentation":"

The entity tag is an MD5 hash of that version of the object.

" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithmList", "documentation":"

The algorithm that was used to create a checksum of the object.

" }, "ChecksumType":{ "shape":"ChecksumType", "documentation":"

The checksum type that is used to calculate the object’s checksum value. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "Size":{ "shape":"Size", "documentation":"

Size in bytes of the object.

" }, "StorageClass":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionStorageClass", "documentation":"

The class of storage used to store the object.

" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The object key.

" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

Version ID of an object.

" }, "IsLatest":{ "shape":"IsLatest", "documentation":"

Specifies whether the object is (true) or is not (false) the latest version of an object.

" }, "LastModified":{ "shape":"LastModified", "documentation":"

Date and time when the object was last modified.

" }, "Owner":{ "shape":"Owner", "documentation":"

Specifies the owner of the object.

" }, "RestoreStatus":{ "shape":"RestoreStatus", "documentation":"

Specifies the restoration status of an object. Objects in certain storage classes must be restored before they can be retrieved. For more information about these storage classes and how to work with archived objects, see Working with archived objects in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" } }, "documentation":"

The version of an object.

" }, "ObjectVersionId":{"type":"string"}, "ObjectVersionList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"ObjectVersion"}, "flattened":true }, "ObjectVersionStorageClass":{ "type":"string", "enum":["STANDARD"] }, "OptionalObjectAttributes":{ "type":"string", "enum":["RestoreStatus"] }, "OptionalObjectAttributesList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"OptionalObjectAttributes"} }, "OutputLocation":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "S3":{ "shape":"S3Location", "documentation":"

Describes an S3 location that will receive the results of the restore request.

" } }, "documentation":"

Describes the location where the restore job's output is stored.

" }, "OutputSerialization":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "CSV":{ "shape":"CSVOutput", "documentation":"

Describes the serialization of CSV-encoded Select results.

" }, "JSON":{ "shape":"JSONOutput", "documentation":"

Specifies JSON as request's output serialization format.

" } }, "documentation":"

Describes how results of the Select job are serialized.

" }, "Owner":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "DisplayName":{ "shape":"DisplayName", "documentation":"

Container for the display name of the owner. This value is only supported in the following Amazon Web Services Regions:

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

" }, "ID":{ "shape":"ID", "documentation":"

Container for the ID of the owner.

" } }, "documentation":"

End of support notice: Beginning October 1, 2025, Amazon S3 will stop returning DisplayName. Update your applications to use canonical IDs (unique identifier for Amazon Web Services accounts), Amazon Web Services account ID (12 digit identifier) or IAM ARNs (full resource naming) as a direct replacement of DisplayName.

This change affects the following Amazon Web Services Regions: US East (N. Virginia) Region, US West (N. California) Region, US West (Oregon) Region, Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region, Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region, Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region, Europe (Ireland) Region, and South America (São Paulo) Region.

Container for the owner's display name and ID.

" }, "OwnerOverride":{ "type":"string", "enum":["Destination"] }, "OwnershipControls":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Rules"], "members":{ "Rules":{ "shape":"OwnershipControlsRules", "documentation":"

The container element for an ownership control rule.

", "locationName":"Rule" } }, "documentation":"

The container element for a bucket's ownership controls.

" }, "OwnershipControlsRule":{ "type":"structure", "required":["ObjectOwnership"], "members":{ "ObjectOwnership":{"shape":"ObjectOwnership"} }, "documentation":"

The container element for an ownership control rule.

" }, "OwnershipControlsRules":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"OwnershipControlsRule"}, "flattened":true }, "ParquetInput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

Container for Parquet.

" }, "Part":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "PartNumber":{ "shape":"PartNumber", "documentation":"

Part number identifying the part. This is a positive integer between 1 and 10,000.

" }, "LastModified":{ "shape":"LastModified", "documentation":"

Date and time at which the part was uploaded.

" }, "ETag":{ "shape":"ETag", "documentation":"

Entity tag returned when the part was uploaded.

" }, "Size":{ "shape":"Size", "documentation":"

Size in bytes of the uploaded part data.

" }, "ChecksumCRC32":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32 checksum of the part. This checksum is present if the object was uploaded with the CRC32 checksum algorithm. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumCRC32C":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32C", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32C checksum of the part. This checksum is present if the object was uploaded with the CRC32C checksum algorithm. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumCRC64NVME":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC64NVME", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 64-bit CRC64NVME checksum of the part. This checksum is present if the multipart upload request was created with the CRC64NVME checksum algorithm, or if the object was uploaded without a checksum (and Amazon S3 added the default checksum, CRC64NVME, to the uploaded object). For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumSHA1":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA1", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 160-bit SHA1 checksum of the part. This checksum is present if the object was uploaded with the SHA1 checksum algorithm. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "ChecksumSHA256":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA256", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 256-bit SHA256 checksum of the part. This checksum is present if the object was uploaded with the SHA256 checksum algorithm. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for elements related to a part.

" }, "PartNumber":{"type":"integer"}, "PartNumberMarker":{"type":"integer"}, "PartitionDateSource":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "EventTime", "DeliveryTime" ] }, "PartitionedPrefix":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "PartitionDateSource":{ "shape":"PartitionDateSource", "documentation":"

Specifies the partition date source for the partitioned prefix. PartitionDateSource can be EventTime or DeliveryTime.

For DeliveryTime, the time in the log file names corresponds to the delivery time for the log files.

For EventTime, The logs delivered are for a specific day only. The year, month, and day correspond to the day on which the event occurred, and the hour, minutes and seconds are set to 00 in the key.

" } }, "documentation":"

Amazon S3 keys for log objects are partitioned in the following format:

[DestinationPrefix][SourceAccountId]/[SourceRegion]/[SourceBucket]/[YYYY]/[MM]/[DD]/[YYYY]-[MM]-[DD]-[hh]-[mm]-[ss]-[UniqueString]

PartitionedPrefix defaults to EventTime delivery when server access logs are delivered.

", "locationName":"PartitionedPrefix" }, "Parts":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"Part"}, "flattened":true }, "PartsCount":{ "type":"integer", "box":true }, "PartsList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"ObjectPart"}, "flattened":true }, "Payer":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Requester", "BucketOwner" ] }, "Permission":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "FULL_CONTROL", "WRITE", "WRITE_ACP", "READ", "READ_ACP" ] }, "Policy":{"type":"string"}, "PolicyStatus":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "IsPublic":{ "shape":"IsPublic", "documentation":"

The policy status for this bucket. TRUE indicates that this bucket is public. FALSE indicates that the bucket is not public.

", "locationName":"IsPublic" } }, "documentation":"

The container element for a bucket's policy status.

" }, "Prefix":{"type":"string"}, "Priority":{ "type":"integer", "box":true }, "Progress":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "BytesScanned":{ "shape":"BytesScanned", "documentation":"

The current number of object bytes scanned.

" }, "BytesProcessed":{ "shape":"BytesProcessed", "documentation":"

The current number of uncompressed object bytes processed.

" }, "BytesReturned":{ "shape":"BytesReturned", "documentation":"

The current number of bytes of records payload data returned.

" } }, "documentation":"

This data type contains information about progress of an operation.

" }, "ProgressEvent":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Details":{ "shape":"Progress", "documentation":"

The Progress event details.

", "eventpayload":true } }, "documentation":"

This data type contains information about the progress event of an operation.

", "event":true }, "Protocol":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "http", "https" ] }, "PublicAccessBlockConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "BlockPublicAcls":{ "shape":"Setting", "documentation":"

Specifies whether Amazon S3 should block public access control lists (ACLs) for this bucket and objects in this bucket. Setting this element to TRUE causes the following behavior:

Enabling this setting doesn't affect existing policies or ACLs.

", "locationName":"BlockPublicAcls" }, "IgnorePublicAcls":{ "shape":"Setting", "documentation":"

Specifies whether Amazon S3 should ignore public ACLs for this bucket and objects in this bucket. Setting this element to TRUE causes Amazon S3 to ignore all public ACLs on this bucket and objects in this bucket.

Enabling this setting doesn't affect the persistence of any existing ACLs and doesn't prevent new public ACLs from being set.

", "locationName":"IgnorePublicAcls" }, "BlockPublicPolicy":{ "shape":"Setting", "documentation":"

Specifies whether Amazon S3 should block public bucket policies for this bucket. Setting this element to TRUE causes Amazon S3 to reject calls to PUT Bucket policy if the specified bucket policy allows public access.

Enabling this setting doesn't affect existing bucket policies.

", "locationName":"BlockPublicPolicy" }, "RestrictPublicBuckets":{ "shape":"Setting", "documentation":"

Specifies whether Amazon S3 should restrict public bucket policies for this bucket. Setting this element to TRUE restricts access to this bucket to only Amazon Web Services service principals and authorized users within this account if the bucket has a public policy.

Enabling this setting doesn't affect previously stored bucket policies, except that public and cross-account access within any public bucket policy, including non-public delegation to specific accounts, is blocked.

", "locationName":"RestrictPublicBuckets" } }, "documentation":"

The PublicAccessBlock configuration that you want to apply to this Amazon S3 bucket. You can enable the configuration options in any combination. For more information about when Amazon S3 considers a bucket or object public, see The Meaning of \"Public\" in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "PutBucketAccelerateConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "AccelerateConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket for which the accelerate configuration is set.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "AccelerateConfiguration":{ "shape":"AccelerateConfiguration", "documentation":"

Container for setting the transfer acceleration state.

", "locationName":"AccelerateConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the request when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" } }, "payload":"AccelerateConfiguration" }, "PutBucketAclRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "ACL":{ "shape":"BucketCannedACL", "documentation":"

The canned ACL to apply to the bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-acl" }, "AccessControlPolicy":{ "shape":"AccessControlPolicy", "documentation":"

Contains the elements that set the ACL permissions for an object per grantee.

", "locationName":"AccessControlPolicy", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket to which to apply the ACL.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded 128-bit MD5 digest of the data. This header must be used as a message integrity check to verify that the request body was not corrupted in transit. For more information, go to RFC 1864.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the request when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "GrantFullControl":{ "shape":"GrantFullControl", "documentation":"

Allows grantee the read, write, read ACP, and write ACP permissions on the bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-full-control" }, "GrantRead":{ "shape":"GrantRead", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to list the objects in the bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-read" }, "GrantReadACP":{ "shape":"GrantReadACP", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to read the bucket ACL.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-read-acp" }, "GrantWrite":{ "shape":"GrantWrite", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to create new objects in the bucket.

For the bucket and object owners of existing objects, also allows deletions and overwrites of those objects.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-write" }, "GrantWriteACP":{ "shape":"GrantWriteACP", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to write the ACL for the applicable bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-write-acp" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"AccessControlPolicy" }, "PutBucketAnalyticsConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Id", "AnalyticsConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket to which an analytics configuration is stored.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Id":{ "shape":"AnalyticsId", "documentation":"

The ID that identifies the analytics configuration.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"id" }, "AnalyticsConfiguration":{ "shape":"AnalyticsConfiguration", "documentation":"

The configuration and any analyses for the analytics filter.

", "locationName":"AnalyticsConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"AnalyticsConfiguration" }, "PutBucketCorsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "CORSConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

Specifies the bucket impacted by the corsconfiguration.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "CORSConfiguration":{ "shape":"CORSConfiguration", "documentation":"

Describes the cross-origin access configuration for objects in an Amazon S3 bucket. For more information, see Enabling Cross-Origin Resource Sharing in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "locationName":"CORSConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded 128-bit MD5 digest of the data. This header must be used as a message integrity check to verify that the request body was not corrupted in transit. For more information, go to RFC 1864.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the request when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"CORSConfiguration" }, "PutBucketEncryptionRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

Specifies default encryption for a bucket using server-side encryption with different key options.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use path-style requests in the format https://s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com/bucket-name . Virtual-hosted-style requests aren't supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must also follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, DOC-EXAMPLE-BUCKET--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded 128-bit MD5 digest of the server-side encryption configuration.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the request when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

For directory buckets, when you use Amazon Web Services SDKs, CRC32 is the default checksum algorithm that's used for performance.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration", "locationName":"ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

For directory buckets, this header is not supported in this API operation. If you specify this header, the request fails with the HTTP status code 501 Not Implemented.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration" }, "PutBucketIntelligentTieringConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Id", "IntelligentTieringConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the Amazon S3 bucket whose configuration you want to modify or retrieve.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Id":{ "shape":"IntelligentTieringId", "documentation":"

The ID used to identify the S3 Intelligent-Tiering configuration.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"id" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "IntelligentTieringConfiguration":{ "shape":"IntelligentTieringConfiguration", "documentation":"

Container for S3 Intelligent-Tiering configuration.

", "locationName":"IntelligentTieringConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} } }, "payload":"IntelligentTieringConfiguration" }, "PutBucketInventoryConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Id", "InventoryConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket where the inventory configuration will be stored.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Id":{ "shape":"InventoryId", "documentation":"

The ID used to identify the inventory configuration.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"id" }, "InventoryConfiguration":{ "shape":"InventoryConfiguration", "documentation":"

Specifies the inventory configuration.

", "locationName":"InventoryConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"InventoryConfiguration" }, "PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "TransitionDefaultMinimumObjectSize":{ "shape":"TransitionDefaultMinimumObjectSize", "documentation":"

Indicates which default minimum object size behavior is applied to the lifecycle configuration.

This parameter applies to general purpose buckets only. It is not supported for directory bucket lifecycle configurations.

To customize the minimum object size for any transition you can add a filter that specifies a custom ObjectSizeGreaterThan or ObjectSizeLessThan in the body of your transition rule. Custom filters always take precedence over the default transition behavior.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-transition-default-minimum-object-size" } } }, "PutBucketLifecycleConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket for which to set the configuration.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the request when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "LifecycleConfiguration":{ "shape":"BucketLifecycleConfiguration", "documentation":"

Container for lifecycle rules. You can add as many as 1,000 rules.

", "locationName":"LifecycleConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

This parameter applies to general purpose buckets only. It is not supported for directory bucket lifecycle configurations.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "TransitionDefaultMinimumObjectSize":{ "shape":"TransitionDefaultMinimumObjectSize", "documentation":"

Indicates which default minimum object size behavior is applied to the lifecycle configuration.

This parameter applies to general purpose buckets only. It is not supported for directory bucket lifecycle configurations.

To customize the minimum object size for any transition you can add a filter that specifies a custom ObjectSizeGreaterThan or ObjectSizeLessThan in the body of your transition rule. Custom filters always take precedence over the default transition behavior.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-transition-default-minimum-object-size" } }, "payload":"LifecycleConfiguration" }, "PutBucketLifecycleRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the request when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "LifecycleConfiguration":{ "shape":"LifecycleConfiguration", "documentation":"

", "locationName":"LifecycleConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"LifecycleConfiguration" }, "PutBucketLoggingRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "BucketLoggingStatus" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket for which to set the logging parameters.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "BucketLoggingStatus":{ "shape":"BucketLoggingStatus", "documentation":"

Container for logging status information.

", "locationName":"BucketLoggingStatus", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The MD5 hash of the PutBucketLogging request body.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the request when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"BucketLoggingStatus" }, "PutBucketMetricsConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Id", "MetricsConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket for which the metrics configuration is set.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Id":{ "shape":"MetricsId", "documentation":"

The ID used to identify the metrics configuration. The ID has a 64 character limit and can only contain letters, numbers, periods, dashes, and underscores.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"id" }, "MetricsConfiguration":{ "shape":"MetricsConfiguration", "documentation":"

Specifies the metrics configuration.

", "locationName":"MetricsConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"MetricsConfiguration" }, "PutBucketNotificationConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "NotificationConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "NotificationConfiguration":{ "shape":"NotificationConfiguration", "locationName":"NotificationConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "SkipDestinationValidation":{ "shape":"SkipValidation", "documentation":"

Skips validation of Amazon SQS, Amazon SNS, and Lambda destinations. True or false value.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-skip-destination-validation" } }, "payload":"NotificationConfiguration" }, "PutBucketNotificationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "NotificationConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The MD5 hash of the PutPublicAccessBlock request body.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the request when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "NotificationConfiguration":{ "shape":"NotificationConfigurationDeprecated", "documentation":"

The container for the configuration.

", "locationName":"NotificationConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"NotificationConfiguration" }, "PutBucketOwnershipControlsRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "OwnershipControls" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the Amazon S3 bucket whose OwnershipControls you want to set.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The MD5 hash of the OwnershipControls request body.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "OwnershipControls":{ "shape":"OwnershipControls", "documentation":"

The OwnershipControls (BucketOwnerEnforced, BucketOwnerPreferred, or ObjectWriter) that you want to apply to this Amazon S3 bucket.

", "locationName":"OwnershipControls", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the object when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum-algorithm header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" } }, "payload":"OwnershipControls" }, "PutBucketPolicyRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Policy" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use path-style requests in the format https://s3express-control.region-code.amazonaws.com/bucket-name . Virtual-hosted-style requests aren't supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must also follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, DOC-EXAMPLE-BUCKET--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The MD5 hash of the request body.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the request when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum-algorithm or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request.

For the x-amz-checksum-algorithm header, replace algorithm with the supported algorithm from the following list:

For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If the individual checksum value you provide through x-amz-checksum-algorithm doesn't match the checksum algorithm you set through x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm, Amazon S3 fails the request with a BadDigest error.

For directory buckets, when you use Amazon Web Services SDKs, CRC32 is the default checksum algorithm that's used for performance.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "ConfirmRemoveSelfBucketAccess":{ "shape":"ConfirmRemoveSelfBucketAccess", "documentation":"

Set this parameter to true to confirm that you want to remove your permissions to change this bucket policy in the future.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-confirm-remove-self-bucket-access" }, "Policy":{ "shape":"Policy", "documentation":"

The bucket policy as a JSON document.

For directory buckets, the only IAM action supported in the bucket policy is s3express:CreateSession.

" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

For directory buckets, this header is not supported in this API operation. If you specify this header, the request fails with the HTTP status code 501 Not Implemented.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"Policy" }, "PutBucketReplicationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "ReplicationConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded 128-bit MD5 digest of the data. You must use this header as a message integrity check to verify that the request body was not corrupted in transit. For more information, see RFC 1864.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the request when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "ReplicationConfiguration":{ "shape":"ReplicationConfiguration", "locationName":"ReplicationConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "Token":{ "shape":"ObjectLockToken", "documentation":"

A token to allow Object Lock to be enabled for an existing bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-bucket-object-lock-token" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"ReplicationConfiguration" }, "PutBucketRequestPaymentRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "RequestPaymentConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded 128-bit MD5 digest of the data. You must use this header as a message integrity check to verify that the request body was not corrupted in transit. For more information, see RFC 1864.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the request when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "RequestPaymentConfiguration":{ "shape":"RequestPaymentConfiguration", "documentation":"

Container for Payer.

", "locationName":"RequestPaymentConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"RequestPaymentConfiguration" }, "PutBucketTaggingRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Tagging" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded 128-bit MD5 digest of the data. You must use this header as a message integrity check to verify that the request body was not corrupted in transit. For more information, see RFC 1864.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the request when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "Tagging":{ "shape":"Tagging", "documentation":"

Container for the TagSet and Tag elements.

", "locationName":"Tagging", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"Tagging" }, "PutBucketVersioningRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "VersioningConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

>The Base64 encoded 128-bit MD5 digest of the data. You must use this header as a message integrity check to verify that the request body was not corrupted in transit. For more information, see RFC 1864.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the request when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "MFA":{ "shape":"MFA", "documentation":"

The concatenation of the authentication device's serial number, a space, and the value that is displayed on your authentication device.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-mfa" }, "VersioningConfiguration":{ "shape":"VersioningConfiguration", "documentation":"

Container for setting the versioning state.

", "locationName":"VersioningConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"VersioningConfiguration" }, "PutBucketWebsiteRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "WebsiteConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded 128-bit MD5 digest of the data. You must use this header as a message integrity check to verify that the request body was not corrupted in transit. For more information, see RFC 1864.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the request when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "WebsiteConfiguration":{ "shape":"WebsiteConfiguration", "documentation":"

Container for the request.

", "locationName":"WebsiteConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"WebsiteConfiguration" }, "PutObjectAclOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } } }, "PutObjectAclRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key" ], "members":{ "ACL":{ "shape":"ObjectCannedACL", "documentation":"

The canned ACL to apply to the object. For more information, see Canned ACL.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-acl" }, "AccessControlPolicy":{ "shape":"AccessControlPolicy", "documentation":"

Contains the elements that set the ACL permissions for an object per grantee.

", "locationName":"AccessControlPolicy", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name that contains the object to which you want to attach the ACL.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded 128-bit MD5 digest of the data. This header must be used as a message integrity check to verify that the request body was not corrupted in transit. For more information, go to RFC 1864.>

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the object when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "GrantFullControl":{ "shape":"GrantFullControl", "documentation":"

Allows grantee the read, write, read ACP, and write ACP permissions on the bucket.

This functionality is not supported for Amazon S3 on Outposts.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-full-control" }, "GrantRead":{ "shape":"GrantRead", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to list the objects in the bucket.

This functionality is not supported for Amazon S3 on Outposts.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-read" }, "GrantReadACP":{ "shape":"GrantReadACP", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to read the bucket ACL.

This functionality is not supported for Amazon S3 on Outposts.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-read-acp" }, "GrantWrite":{ "shape":"GrantWrite", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to create new objects in the bucket.

For the bucket and object owners of existing objects, also allows deletions and overwrites of those objects.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-write" }, "GrantWriteACP":{ "shape":"GrantWriteACP", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to write the ACL for the applicable bucket.

This functionality is not supported for Amazon S3 on Outposts.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-write-acp" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Key for which the PUT action was initiated.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Key"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

Version ID used to reference a specific version of the object.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"versionId" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"AccessControlPolicy" }, "PutObjectLegalHoldOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } } }, "PutObjectLegalHoldRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name containing the object that you want to place a legal hold on.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The key name for the object that you want to place a legal hold on.

", "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "LegalHold":{ "shape":"ObjectLockLegalHold", "documentation":"

Container element for the legal hold configuration you want to apply to the specified object.

", "locationName":"LegalHold", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

The version ID of the object that you want to place a legal hold on.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"versionId" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The MD5 hash for the request body.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the object when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"LegalHold" }, "PutObjectLockConfigurationOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } } }, "PutObjectLockConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Bucket"], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket whose Object Lock configuration you want to create or replace.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ObjectLockConfiguration":{ "shape":"ObjectLockConfiguration", "documentation":"

The Object Lock configuration that you want to apply to the specified bucket.

", "locationName":"ObjectLockConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "Token":{ "shape":"ObjectLockToken", "documentation":"

A token to allow Object Lock to be enabled for an existing bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-bucket-object-lock-token" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The MD5 hash for the request body.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the object when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"ObjectLockConfiguration" }, "PutObjectOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Expiration":{ "shape":"Expiration", "documentation":"

If the expiration is configured for the object (see PutBucketLifecycleConfiguration) in the Amazon S3 User Guide, the response includes this header. It includes the expiry-date and rule-id key-value pairs that provide information about object expiration. The value of the rule-id is URL-encoded.

Object expiration information is not returned in directory buckets and this header returns the value \"NotImplemented\" in all responses for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expiration" }, "ETag":{ "shape":"ETag", "documentation":"

Entity tag for the uploaded object.

General purpose buckets - To ensure that data is not corrupted traversing the network, for objects where the ETag is the MD5 digest of the object, you can calculate the MD5 while putting an object to Amazon S3 and compare the returned ETag to the calculated MD5 value.

Directory buckets - The ETag for the object in a directory bucket isn't the MD5 digest of the object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"ETag" }, "ChecksumCRC32":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32 checksum of the object. This checksum is only be present if the checksum was uploaded with the object. When you use an API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc32" }, "ChecksumCRC32C":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32C", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32C checksum of the object. This checksum is only present if the checksum was uploaded with the object. When you use an API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc32c" }, "ChecksumCRC64NVME":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC64NVME", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 64-bit CRC64NVME checksum of the object. This header is present if the object was uploaded with the CRC64NVME checksum algorithm, or if it was uploaded without a checksum (and Amazon S3 added the default checksum, CRC64NVME, to the uploaded object). For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc64nvme" }, "ChecksumSHA1":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA1", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 160-bit SHA1 digest of the object. This will only be present if the object was uploaded with the object. When you use the API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-sha1" }, "ChecksumSHA256":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA256", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 256-bit SHA256 digest of the object. This will only be present if the object was uploaded with the object. When you use an API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-sha256" }, "ChecksumType":{ "shape":"ChecksumType", "documentation":"

This header specifies the checksum type of the object, which determines how part-level checksums are combined to create an object-level checksum for multipart objects. For PutObject uploads, the checksum type is always FULL_OBJECT. You can use this header as a data integrity check to verify that the checksum type that is received is the same checksum that was specified. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-type" }, "ServerSideEncryption":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryption", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption algorithm used when you store this object in Amazon S3 or Amazon FSx.

When accessing data stored in Amazon FSx file systems using S3 access points, the only valid server side encryption option is aws:fsx.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

Version ID of the object.

If you enable versioning for a bucket, Amazon S3 automatically generates a unique version ID for the object being stored. Amazon S3 returns this ID in the response. When you enable versioning for a bucket, if Amazon S3 receives multiple write requests for the same object simultaneously, it stores all of the objects. For more information about versioning, see Adding Objects to Versioning-Enabled Buckets in the Amazon S3 User Guide. For information about returning the versioning state of a bucket, see GetBucketVersioning.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-version-id" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested, the response will include this header to confirm the encryption algorithm that's used.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested, the response will include this header to provide the round-trip message integrity verification of the customer-provided encryption key.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "SSEKMSKeyId":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

If present, indicates the ID of the KMS key that was used for object encryption.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" }, "SSEKMSEncryptionContext":{ "shape":"SSEKMSEncryptionContext", "documentation":"

If present, indicates the Amazon Web Services KMS Encryption Context to use for object encryption. The value of this header is a Base64 encoded string of a UTF-8 encoded JSON, which contains the encryption context as key-value pairs. This value is stored as object metadata and automatically gets passed on to Amazon Web Services KMS for future GetObject operations on this object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-context" }, "BucketKeyEnabled":{ "shape":"BucketKeyEnabled", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the uploaded object uses an S3 Bucket Key for server-side encryption with Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-bucket-key-enabled" }, "Size":{ "shape":"Size", "documentation":"

The size of the object in bytes. This value is only be present if you append to an object.

This functionality is only supported for objects in the Amazon S3 Express One Zone storage class in directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-size" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } } }, "PutObjectRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key" ], "members":{ "ACL":{ "shape":"ObjectCannedACL", "documentation":"

The canned ACL to apply to the object. For more information, see Canned ACL in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

When adding a new object, you can use headers to grant ACL-based permissions to individual Amazon Web Services accounts or to predefined groups defined by Amazon S3. These permissions are then added to the ACL on the object. By default, all objects are private. Only the owner has full access control. For more information, see Access Control List (ACL) Overview and Managing ACLs Using the REST API in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If the bucket that you're uploading objects to uses the bucket owner enforced setting for S3 Object Ownership, ACLs are disabled and no longer affect permissions. Buckets that use this setting only accept PUT requests that don't specify an ACL or PUT requests that specify bucket owner full control ACLs, such as the bucket-owner-full-control canned ACL or an equivalent form of this ACL expressed in the XML format. PUT requests that contain other ACLs (for example, custom grants to certain Amazon Web Services accounts) fail and return a 400 error with the error code AccessControlListNotSupported. For more information, see Controlling ownership of objects and disabling ACLs in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-acl" }, "Body":{ "shape":"Body", "documentation":"

Object data.

", "streaming":true }, "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name to which the PUT action was initiated.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "CacheControl":{ "shape":"CacheControl", "documentation":"

Can be used to specify caching behavior along the request/reply chain. For more information, see http://www.w3.org/Protocols/rfc2616/rfc2616-sec14.html#sec14.9.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Cache-Control" }, "ContentDisposition":{ "shape":"ContentDisposition", "documentation":"

Specifies presentational information for the object. For more information, see https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6266#section-4.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Disposition" }, "ContentEncoding":{ "shape":"ContentEncoding", "documentation":"

Specifies what content encodings have been applied to the object and thus what decoding mechanisms must be applied to obtain the media-type referenced by the Content-Type header field. For more information, see https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9110.html#field.content-encoding.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Encoding" }, "ContentLanguage":{ "shape":"ContentLanguage", "documentation":"

The language the content is in.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Language" }, "ContentLength":{ "shape":"ContentLength", "documentation":"

Size of the body in bytes. This parameter is useful when the size of the body cannot be determined automatically. For more information, see https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9110.html#name-content-length.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Length" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded 128-bit MD5 digest of the message (without the headers) according to RFC 1864. This header can be used as a message integrity check to verify that the data is the same data that was originally sent. Although it is optional, we recommend using the Content-MD5 mechanism as an end-to-end integrity check. For more information about REST request authentication, see REST Authentication.

The Content-MD5 or x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm header is required for any request to upload an object with a retention period configured using Amazon S3 Object Lock. For more information, see Uploading objects to an Object Lock enabled bucket in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ContentType":{ "shape":"ContentType", "documentation":"

A standard MIME type describing the format of the contents. For more information, see https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9110.html#name-content-type.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Type" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the object when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum-algorithm or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request.

For the x-amz-checksum-algorithm header, replace algorithm with the supported algorithm from the following list:

For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If the individual checksum value you provide through x-amz-checksum-algorithm doesn't match the checksum algorithm you set through x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm, Amazon S3 fails the request with a BadDigest error.

The Content-MD5 or x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm header is required for any request to upload an object with a retention period configured using Amazon S3 Object Lock. For more information, see Uploading objects to an Object Lock enabled bucket in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

For directory buckets, when you use Amazon Web Services SDKs, CRC32 is the default checksum algorithm that's used for performance.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "ChecksumCRC32":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32 checksum of the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc32" }, "ChecksumCRC32C":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32C", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32C checksum of the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc32c" }, "ChecksumCRC64NVME":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC64NVME", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 64-bit CRC64NVME checksum of the object. The CRC64NVME checksum is always a full object checksum. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc64nvme" }, "ChecksumSHA1":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA1", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 160-bit SHA1 digest of the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-sha1" }, "ChecksumSHA256":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA256", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 256-bit SHA256 digest of the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-sha256" }, "Expires":{ "shape":"Expires", "documentation":"

The date and time at which the object is no longer cacheable. For more information, see https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7234#section-5.3.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Expires" }, "IfMatch":{ "shape":"IfMatch", "documentation":"

Uploads the object only if the ETag (entity tag) value provided during the WRITE operation matches the ETag of the object in S3. If the ETag values do not match, the operation returns a 412 Precondition Failed error.

If a conflicting operation occurs during the upload S3 returns a 409 ConditionalRequestConflict response. On a 409 failure you should fetch the object's ETag and retry the upload.

Expects the ETag value as a string.

For more information about conditional requests, see RFC 7232, or Conditional requests in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-Match" }, "IfNoneMatch":{ "shape":"IfNoneMatch", "documentation":"

Uploads the object only if the object key name does not already exist in the bucket specified. Otherwise, Amazon S3 returns a 412 Precondition Failed error.

If a conflicting operation occurs during the upload S3 returns a 409 ConditionalRequestConflict response. On a 409 failure you should retry the upload.

Expects the '*' (asterisk) character.

For more information about conditional requests, see RFC 7232, or Conditional requests in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-None-Match" }, "GrantFullControl":{ "shape":"GrantFullControl", "documentation":"

Gives the grantee READ, READ_ACP, and WRITE_ACP permissions on the object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-full-control" }, "GrantRead":{ "shape":"GrantRead", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to read the object data and its metadata.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-read" }, "GrantReadACP":{ "shape":"GrantReadACP", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to read the object ACL.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-read-acp" }, "GrantWriteACP":{ "shape":"GrantWriteACP", "documentation":"

Allows grantee to write the ACL for the applicable object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-grant-write-acp" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Object key for which the PUT action was initiated.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Key"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "WriteOffsetBytes":{ "shape":"WriteOffsetBytes", "documentation":"

Specifies the offset for appending data to existing objects in bytes. The offset must be equal to the size of the existing object being appended to. If no object exists, setting this header to 0 will create a new object.

This functionality is only supported for objects in the Amazon S3 Express One Zone storage class in directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-write-offset-bytes" }, "Metadata":{ "shape":"Metadata", "documentation":"

A map of metadata to store with the object in S3.

", "location":"headers", "locationName":"x-amz-meta-" }, "ServerSideEncryption":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryption", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption algorithm that was used when you store this object in Amazon S3 or Amazon FSx.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption" }, "StorageClass":{ "shape":"StorageClass", "documentation":"

By default, Amazon S3 uses the STANDARD Storage Class to store newly created objects. The STANDARD storage class provides high durability and high availability. Depending on performance needs, you can specify a different Storage Class. For more information, see Storage Classes in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-storage-class" }, "WebsiteRedirectLocation":{ "shape":"WebsiteRedirectLocation", "documentation":"

If the bucket is configured as a website, redirects requests for this object to another object in the same bucket or to an external URL. Amazon S3 stores the value of this header in the object metadata. For information about object metadata, see Object Key and Metadata in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

In the following example, the request header sets the redirect to an object (anotherPage.html) in the same bucket:

x-amz-website-redirect-location: /anotherPage.html

In the following example, the request header sets the object redirect to another website:

x-amz-website-redirect-location: http://www.example.com/

For more information about website hosting in Amazon S3, see Hosting Websites on Amazon S3 and How to Configure Website Page Redirects in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-website-redirect-location" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Specifies the algorithm to use when encrypting the object (for example, AES256).

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKey":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKey", "documentation":"

Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use in encrypting data. This value is used to store the object and then it is discarded; Amazon S3 does not store the encryption key. The key must be appropriate for use with the algorithm specified in the x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm header.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321. Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure that the encryption key was transmitted without error.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "SSEKMSKeyId":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

Specifies the KMS key ID (Key ID, Key ARN, or Key Alias) to use for object encryption. If the KMS key doesn't exist in the same account that's issuing the command, you must use the full Key ARN not the Key ID.

General purpose buckets - If you specify x-amz-server-side-encryption with aws:kms or aws:kms:dsse, this header specifies the ID (Key ID, Key ARN, or Key Alias) of the KMS key to use. If you specify x-amz-server-side-encryption:aws:kms or x-amz-server-side-encryption:aws:kms:dsse, but do not provide x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id, Amazon S3 uses the Amazon Web Services managed key (aws/s3) to protect the data.

Directory buckets - To encrypt data using SSE-KMS, it's recommended to specify the x-amz-server-side-encryption header to aws:kms. Then, the x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id header implicitly uses the bucket's default KMS customer managed key ID. If you want to explicitly set the x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id header, it must match the bucket's default customer managed key (using key ID or ARN, not alias). Your SSE-KMS configuration can only support 1 customer managed key per directory bucket's lifetime. The Amazon Web Services managed key (aws/s3) isn't supported. Incorrect key specification results in an HTTP 400 Bad Request error.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" }, "SSEKMSEncryptionContext":{ "shape":"SSEKMSEncryptionContext", "documentation":"

Specifies the Amazon Web Services KMS Encryption Context as an additional encryption context to use for object encryption. The value of this header is a Base64 encoded string of a UTF-8 encoded JSON, which contains the encryption context as key-value pairs. This value is stored as object metadata and automatically gets passed on to Amazon Web Services KMS for future GetObject operations on this object.

General purpose buckets - This value must be explicitly added during CopyObject operations if you want an additional encryption context for your object. For more information, see Encryption context in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Directory buckets - You can optionally provide an explicit encryption context value. The value must match the default encryption context - the bucket Amazon Resource Name (ARN). An additional encryption context value is not supported.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-context" }, "BucketKeyEnabled":{ "shape":"BucketKeyEnabled", "documentation":"

Specifies whether Amazon S3 should use an S3 Bucket Key for object encryption with server-side encryption using Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS).

General purpose buckets - Setting this header to true causes Amazon S3 to use an S3 Bucket Key for object encryption with SSE-KMS. Also, specifying this header with a PUT action doesn't affect bucket-level settings for S3 Bucket Key.

Directory buckets - S3 Bucket Keys are always enabled for GET and PUT operations in a directory bucket and can’t be disabled. S3 Bucket Keys aren't supported, when you copy SSE-KMS encrypted objects from general purpose buckets to directory buckets, from directory buckets to general purpose buckets, or between directory buckets, through CopyObject, UploadPartCopy, the Copy operation in Batch Operations, or the import jobs. In this case, Amazon S3 makes a call to KMS every time a copy request is made for a KMS-encrypted object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-bucket-key-enabled" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "Tagging":{ "shape":"TaggingHeader", "documentation":"

The tag-set for the object. The tag-set must be encoded as URL Query parameters. (For example, \"Key1=Value1\")

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-tagging" }, "ObjectLockMode":{ "shape":"ObjectLockMode", "documentation":"

The Object Lock mode that you want to apply to this object.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-lock-mode" }, "ObjectLockRetainUntilDate":{ "shape":"ObjectLockRetainUntilDate", "documentation":"

The date and time when you want this object's Object Lock to expire. Must be formatted as a timestamp parameter.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-lock-retain-until-date" }, "ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus":{ "shape":"ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus", "documentation":"

Specifies whether a legal hold will be applied to this object. For more information about S3 Object Lock, see Object Lock in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-object-lock-legal-hold" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"Body" }, "PutObjectRetentionOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } } }, "PutObjectRetentionRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name that contains the object you want to apply this Object Retention configuration to.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The key name for the object that you want to apply this Object Retention configuration to.

", "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "Retention":{ "shape":"ObjectLockRetention", "documentation":"

The container element for the Object Retention configuration.

", "locationName":"Retention", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

The version ID for the object that you want to apply this Object Retention configuration to.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"versionId" }, "BypassGovernanceRetention":{ "shape":"BypassGovernanceRetention", "documentation":"

Indicates whether this action should bypass Governance-mode restrictions.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-bypass-governance-retention" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The MD5 hash for the request body.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the object when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"Retention" }, "PutObjectTaggingOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

The versionId of the object the tag-set was added to.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-version-id" } } }, "PutObjectTaggingRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key", "Tagging" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name containing the object.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Name of the object key.

", "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

The versionId of the object that the tag-set will be added to.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"versionId" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The MD5 hash for the request body.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the object when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "Tagging":{ "shape":"Tagging", "documentation":"

Container for the TagSet and Tag elements

", "locationName":"Tagging", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" } }, "payload":"Tagging" }, "PutPublicAccessBlockRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "PublicAccessBlockConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the Amazon S3 bucket whose PublicAccessBlock configuration you want to set.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The MD5 hash of the PutPublicAccessBlock request body.

For requests made using the Amazon Web Services Command Line Interface (CLI) or Amazon Web Services SDKs, this field is calculated automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the object when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "PublicAccessBlockConfiguration":{ "shape":"PublicAccessBlockConfiguration", "documentation":"

The PublicAccessBlock configuration that you want to apply to this Amazon S3 bucket. You can enable the configuration options in any combination. For more information about when Amazon S3 considers a bucket or object public, see The Meaning of \"Public\" in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "locationName":"PublicAccessBlockConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"PublicAccessBlockConfiguration" }, "QueueArn":{"type":"string"}, "QueueConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "QueueArn", "Events" ], "members":{ "Id":{"shape":"NotificationId"}, "QueueArn":{ "shape":"QueueArn", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the Amazon SQS queue to which Amazon S3 publishes a message when it detects events of the specified type.

", "locationName":"Queue" }, "Events":{ "shape":"EventList", "documentation":"

A collection of bucket events for which to send notifications

", "locationName":"Event" }, "Filter":{"shape":"NotificationConfigurationFilter"} }, "documentation":"

Specifies the configuration for publishing messages to an Amazon Simple Queue Service (Amazon SQS) queue when Amazon S3 detects specified events.

" }, "QueueConfigurationDeprecated":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Id":{"shape":"NotificationId"}, "Event":{ "shape":"Event", "deprecated":true }, "Events":{ "shape":"EventList", "documentation":"

A collection of bucket events for which to send notifications.

", "locationName":"Event" }, "Queue":{ "shape":"QueueArn", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the Amazon SQS queue to which Amazon S3 publishes a message when it detects events of the specified type.

" } }, "documentation":"

This data type is deprecated. Use QueueConfiguration for the same purposes. This data type specifies the configuration for publishing messages to an Amazon Simple Queue Service (Amazon SQS) queue when Amazon S3 detects specified events.

" }, "QueueConfigurationList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"QueueConfiguration"}, "flattened":true }, "Quiet":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "QuoteCharacter":{"type":"string"}, "QuoteEscapeCharacter":{"type":"string"}, "QuoteFields":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "ALWAYS", "ASNEEDED" ] }, "Range":{"type":"string"}, "RecordDelimiter":{"type":"string"}, "RecordExpiration":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Expiration"], "members":{ "Expiration":{ "shape":"ExpirationState", "documentation":"

Specifies whether journal table record expiration is enabled or disabled.

" }, "Days":{ "shape":"RecordExpirationDays", "documentation":"

If you enable journal table record expiration, you can set the number of days to retain your journal table records. Journal table records must be retained for a minimum of 7 days. To set this value, specify any whole number from 7 to 2147483647. For example, to retain your journal table records for one year, set this value to 365.

", "box":true } }, "documentation":"

The journal table record expiration settings for a journal table in an S3 Metadata configuration.

" }, "RecordExpirationDays":{"type":"integer"}, "RecordsEvent":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Payload":{ "shape":"Body", "documentation":"

The byte array of partial, one or more result records. S3 Select doesn't guarantee that a record will be self-contained in one record frame. To ensure continuous streaming of data, S3 Select might split the same record across multiple record frames instead of aggregating the results in memory. Some S3 clients (for example, the SDK for Java) handle this behavior by creating a ByteStream out of the response by default. Other clients might not handle this behavior by default. In those cases, you must aggregate the results on the client side and parse the response.

", "eventpayload":true } }, "documentation":"

The container for the records event.

", "event":true }, "Redirect":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "HostName":{ "shape":"HostName", "documentation":"

The host name to use in the redirect request.

" }, "HttpRedirectCode":{ "shape":"HttpRedirectCode", "documentation":"

The HTTP redirect code to use on the response. Not required if one of the siblings is present.

" }, "Protocol":{ "shape":"Protocol", "documentation":"

Protocol to use when redirecting requests. The default is the protocol that is used in the original request.

" }, "ReplaceKeyPrefixWith":{ "shape":"ReplaceKeyPrefixWith", "documentation":"

The object key prefix to use in the redirect request. For example, to redirect requests for all pages with prefix docs/ (objects in the docs/ folder) to documents/, you can set a condition block with KeyPrefixEquals set to docs/ and in the Redirect set ReplaceKeyPrefixWith to /documents. Not required if one of the siblings is present. Can be present only if ReplaceKeyWith is not provided.

Replacement must be made for object keys containing special characters (such as carriage returns) when using XML requests. For more information, see XML related object key constraints.

" }, "ReplaceKeyWith":{ "shape":"ReplaceKeyWith", "documentation":"

The specific object key to use in the redirect request. For example, redirect request to error.html. Not required if one of the siblings is present. Can be present only if ReplaceKeyPrefixWith is not provided.

Replacement must be made for object keys containing special characters (such as carriage returns) when using XML requests. For more information, see XML related object key constraints.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies how requests are redirected. In the event of an error, you can specify a different error code to return.

" }, "RedirectAllRequestsTo":{ "type":"structure", "required":["HostName"], "members":{ "HostName":{ "shape":"HostName", "documentation":"

Name of the host where requests are redirected.

" }, "Protocol":{ "shape":"Protocol", "documentation":"

Protocol to use when redirecting requests. The default is the protocol that is used in the original request.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the redirect behavior of all requests to a website endpoint of an Amazon S3 bucket.

" }, "Region":{ "type":"string", "max":20, "min":0 }, "RenameObjectOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{} }, "RenameObjectRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key", "RenameSource" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name of the directory bucket containing the object.

You must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Availability Zone. Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Key name of the object to rename.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Key"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "RenameSource":{ "shape":"RenameSource", "documentation":"

Specifies the source for the rename operation. The value must be URL encoded.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-rename-source" }, "DestinationIfMatch":{ "shape":"IfMatch", "documentation":"

Renames the object only if the ETag (entity tag) value provided during the operation matches the ETag of the object in S3. The If-Match header field makes the request method conditional on ETags. If the ETag values do not match, the operation returns a 412 Precondition Failed error.

Expects the ETag value as a string.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-Match" }, "DestinationIfNoneMatch":{ "shape":"IfNoneMatch", "documentation":"

Renames the object only if the destination does not already exist in the specified directory bucket. If the object does exist when you send a request with If-None-Match:*, the S3 API will return a 412 Precondition Failed error, preventing an overwrite. The If-None-Match header prevents overwrites of existing data by validating that there's not an object with the same key name already in your directory bucket.

Expects the * character (asterisk).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-None-Match" }, "DestinationIfModifiedSince":{ "shape":"IfModifiedSince", "documentation":"

Renames the object if the destination exists and if it has been modified since the specified time.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-Modified-Since" }, "DestinationIfUnmodifiedSince":{ "shape":"IfUnmodifiedSince", "documentation":"

Renames the object if it hasn't been modified since the specified time.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"If-Unmodified-Since" }, "SourceIfMatch":{ "shape":"RenameSourceIfMatch", "documentation":"

Renames the object if the source exists and if its entity tag (ETag) matches the specified ETag.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-rename-source-if-match" }, "SourceIfNoneMatch":{ "shape":"RenameSourceIfNoneMatch", "documentation":"

Renames the object if the source exists and if its entity tag (ETag) is different than the specified ETag. If an asterisk (*) character is provided, the operation will fail and return a 412 Precondition Failed error.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-rename-source-if-none-match" }, "SourceIfModifiedSince":{ "shape":"RenameSourceIfModifiedSince", "documentation":"

Renames the object if the source exists and if it has been modified since the specified time.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-rename-source-if-modified-since" }, "SourceIfUnmodifiedSince":{ "shape":"RenameSourceIfUnmodifiedSince", "documentation":"

Renames the object if the source exists and hasn't been modified since the specified time.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-rename-source-if-unmodified-since" }, "ClientToken":{ "shape":"ClientToken", "documentation":"

A unique string with a max of 64 ASCII characters in the ASCII range of 33 - 126.

RenameObject supports idempotency using a client token. To make an idempotent API request using RenameObject, specify a client token in the request. You should not reuse the same client token for other API requests. If you retry a request that completed successfully using the same client token and the same parameters, the retry succeeds without performing any further actions. If you retry a successful request using the same client token, but one or more of the parameters are different, the retry fails and an IdempotentParameterMismatch error is returned.

", "idempotencyToken":true, "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-client-token" } } }, "RenameSource":{ "type":"string", "pattern":"\\/?.+\\/.+" }, "RenameSourceIfMatch":{"type":"string"}, "RenameSourceIfModifiedSince":{ "type":"timestamp", "timestampFormat":"rfc822" }, "RenameSourceIfNoneMatch":{"type":"string"}, "RenameSourceIfUnmodifiedSince":{ "type":"timestamp", "timestampFormat":"rfc822" }, "ReplaceKeyPrefixWith":{"type":"string"}, "ReplaceKeyWith":{"type":"string"}, "ReplicaKmsKeyID":{"type":"string"}, "ReplicaModifications":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Status"], "members":{ "Status":{ "shape":"ReplicaModificationsStatus", "documentation":"

Specifies whether Amazon S3 replicates modifications on replicas.

" } }, "documentation":"

A filter that you can specify for selection for modifications on replicas. Amazon S3 doesn't replicate replica modifications by default. In the latest version of replication configuration (when Filter is specified), you can specify this element and set the status to Enabled to replicate modifications on replicas.

If you don't specify the Filter element, Amazon S3 assumes that the replication configuration is the earlier version, V1. In the earlier version, this element is not allowed.

" }, "ReplicaModificationsStatus":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Enabled", "Disabled" ] }, "ReplicationConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Role", "Rules" ], "members":{ "Role":{ "shape":"Role", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the Identity and Access Management (IAM) role that Amazon S3 assumes when replicating objects. For more information, see How to Set Up Replication in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "Rules":{ "shape":"ReplicationRules", "documentation":"

A container for one or more replication rules. A replication configuration must have at least one rule and can contain a maximum of 1,000 rules.

", "locationName":"Rule" } }, "documentation":"

A container for replication rules. You can add up to 1,000 rules. The maximum size of a replication configuration is 2 MB.

" }, "ReplicationRule":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Status", "Destination" ], "members":{ "ID":{ "shape":"ID", "documentation":"

A unique identifier for the rule. The maximum value is 255 characters.

" }, "Priority":{ "shape":"Priority", "documentation":"

The priority indicates which rule has precedence whenever two or more replication rules conflict. Amazon S3 will attempt to replicate objects according to all replication rules. However, if there are two or more rules with the same destination bucket, then objects will be replicated according to the rule with the highest priority. The higher the number, the higher the priority.

For more information, see Replication in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

An object key name prefix that identifies the object or objects to which the rule applies. The maximum prefix length is 1,024 characters. To include all objects in a bucket, specify an empty string.

Replacement must be made for object keys containing special characters (such as carriage returns) when using XML requests. For more information, see XML related object key constraints.

", "deprecated":true }, "Filter":{"shape":"ReplicationRuleFilter"}, "Status":{ "shape":"ReplicationRuleStatus", "documentation":"

Specifies whether the rule is enabled.

" }, "SourceSelectionCriteria":{ "shape":"SourceSelectionCriteria", "documentation":"

A container that describes additional filters for identifying the source objects that you want to replicate. You can choose to enable or disable the replication of these objects. Currently, Amazon S3 supports only the filter that you can specify for objects created with server-side encryption using a customer managed key stored in Amazon Web Services Key Management Service (SSE-KMS).

" }, "ExistingObjectReplication":{ "shape":"ExistingObjectReplication", "documentation":"

Optional configuration to replicate existing source bucket objects.

This parameter is no longer supported. To replicate existing objects, see Replicating existing objects with S3 Batch Replication in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "Destination":{ "shape":"Destination", "documentation":"

A container for information about the replication destination and its configurations including enabling the S3 Replication Time Control (S3 RTC).

" }, "DeleteMarkerReplication":{"shape":"DeleteMarkerReplication"} }, "documentation":"

Specifies which Amazon S3 objects to replicate and where to store the replicas.

" }, "ReplicationRuleAndOperator":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

An object key name prefix that identifies the subset of objects to which the rule applies.

" }, "Tags":{ "shape":"TagSet", "documentation":"

An array of tags containing key and value pairs.

", "flattened":true, "locationName":"Tag" } }, "documentation":"

A container for specifying rule filters. The filters determine the subset of objects to which the rule applies. This element is required only if you specify more than one filter.

For example:

" }, "ReplicationRuleFilter":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

An object key name prefix that identifies the subset of objects to which the rule applies.

Replacement must be made for object keys containing special characters (such as carriage returns) when using XML requests. For more information, see XML related object key constraints.

" }, "Tag":{ "shape":"Tag", "documentation":"

A container for specifying a tag key and value.

The rule applies only to objects that have the tag in their tag set.

" }, "And":{ "shape":"ReplicationRuleAndOperator", "documentation":"

A container for specifying rule filters. The filters determine the subset of objects to which the rule applies. This element is required only if you specify more than one filter. For example:

" } }, "documentation":"

A filter that identifies the subset of objects to which the replication rule applies. A Filter must specify exactly one Prefix, Tag, or an And child element.

" }, "ReplicationRuleStatus":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Enabled", "Disabled" ] }, "ReplicationRules":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"ReplicationRule"}, "flattened":true }, "ReplicationStatus":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "COMPLETE", "PENDING", "FAILED", "REPLICA", "COMPLETED" ] }, "ReplicationTime":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Status", "Time" ], "members":{ "Status":{ "shape":"ReplicationTimeStatus", "documentation":"

Specifies whether the replication time is enabled.

" }, "Time":{ "shape":"ReplicationTimeValue", "documentation":"

A container specifying the time by which replication should be complete for all objects and operations on objects.

" } }, "documentation":"

A container specifying S3 Replication Time Control (S3 RTC) related information, including whether S3 RTC is enabled and the time when all objects and operations on objects must be replicated. Must be specified together with a Metrics block.

" }, "ReplicationTimeStatus":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Enabled", "Disabled" ] }, "ReplicationTimeValue":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Minutes":{ "shape":"Minutes", "documentation":"

Contains an integer specifying time in minutes.

Valid value: 15

" } }, "documentation":"

A container specifying the time value for S3 Replication Time Control (S3 RTC) and replication metrics EventThreshold.

" }, "RequestCharged":{ "type":"string", "documentation":"

If present, indicates that the requester was successfully charged for the request. For more information, see Using Requester Pays buckets for storage transfers and usage in the Amazon Simple Storage Service user guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "enum":["requester"] }, "RequestPayer":{ "type":"string", "documentation":"

Confirms that the requester knows that they will be charged for the request. Bucket owners need not specify this parameter in their requests. If either the source or destination S3 bucket has Requester Pays enabled, the requester will pay for corresponding charges to copy the object. For information about downloading objects from Requester Pays buckets, see Downloading Objects in Requester Pays Buckets in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "enum":["requester"] }, "RequestPaymentConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Payer"], "members":{ "Payer":{ "shape":"Payer", "documentation":"

Specifies who pays for the download and request fees.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for Payer.

" }, "RequestProgress":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Enabled":{ "shape":"EnableRequestProgress", "documentation":"

Specifies whether periodic QueryProgress frames should be sent. Valid values: TRUE, FALSE. Default value: FALSE.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for specifying if periodic QueryProgress messages should be sent.

" }, "RequestRoute":{"type":"string"}, "RequestToken":{"type":"string"}, "ResponseCacheControl":{"type":"string"}, "ResponseContentDisposition":{"type":"string"}, "ResponseContentEncoding":{"type":"string"}, "ResponseContentLanguage":{"type":"string"}, "ResponseContentType":{"type":"string"}, "ResponseExpires":{ "type":"timestamp", "timestampFormat":"rfc822" }, "Restore":{"type":"string"}, "RestoreExpiryDate":{"type":"timestamp"}, "RestoreObjectOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" }, "RestoreOutputPath":{ "shape":"RestoreOutputPath", "documentation":"

Indicates the path in the provided S3 output location where Select results will be restored to.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-restore-output-path" } } }, "RestoreObjectRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name containing the object to restore.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Object key for which the action was initiated.

", "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

VersionId used to reference a specific version of the object.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"versionId" }, "RestoreRequest":{ "shape":"RestoreRequest", "locationName":"RestoreRequest", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the object when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"RestoreRequest" }, "RestoreOutputPath":{"type":"string"}, "RestoreRequest":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Days":{ "shape":"Days", "documentation":"

Lifetime of the active copy in days. Do not use with restores that specify OutputLocation.

The Days element is required for regular restores, and must not be provided for select requests.

" }, "GlacierJobParameters":{ "shape":"GlacierJobParameters", "documentation":"

S3 Glacier related parameters pertaining to this job. Do not use with restores that specify OutputLocation.

" }, "Type":{ "shape":"RestoreRequestType", "documentation":"

Amazon S3 Select is no longer available to new customers. Existing customers of Amazon S3 Select can continue to use the feature as usual. Learn more

Type of restore request.

" }, "Tier":{ "shape":"Tier", "documentation":"

Retrieval tier at which the restore will be processed.

" }, "Description":{ "shape":"Description", "documentation":"

The optional description for the job.

" }, "SelectParameters":{ "shape":"SelectParameters", "documentation":"

Amazon S3 Select is no longer available to new customers. Existing customers of Amazon S3 Select can continue to use the feature as usual. Learn more

Describes the parameters for Select job types.

" }, "OutputLocation":{ "shape":"OutputLocation", "documentation":"

Describes the location where the restore job's output is stored.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for restore job parameters.

" }, "RestoreRequestType":{ "type":"string", "enum":["SELECT"] }, "RestoreStatus":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "IsRestoreInProgress":{ "shape":"IsRestoreInProgress", "documentation":"

Specifies whether the object is currently being restored. If the object restoration is in progress, the header returns the value TRUE. For example:

x-amz-optional-object-attributes: IsRestoreInProgress=\"true\"

If the object restoration has completed, the header returns the value FALSE. For example:

x-amz-optional-object-attributes: IsRestoreInProgress=\"false\", RestoreExpiryDate=\"2012-12-21T00:00:00.000Z\"

If the object hasn't been restored, there is no header response.

" }, "RestoreExpiryDate":{ "shape":"RestoreExpiryDate", "documentation":"

Indicates when the restored copy will expire. This value is populated only if the object has already been restored. For example:

x-amz-optional-object-attributes: IsRestoreInProgress=\"false\", RestoreExpiryDate=\"2012-12-21T00:00:00.000Z\"

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the restoration status of an object. Objects in certain storage classes must be restored before they can be retrieved. For more information about these storage classes and how to work with archived objects, see Working with archived objects in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets. Directory buckets only support EXPRESS_ONEZONE (the S3 Express One Zone storage class) in Availability Zones and ONEZONE_IA (the S3 One Zone-Infrequent Access storage class) in Dedicated Local Zones.

" }, "Role":{"type":"string"}, "RoutingRule":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Redirect"], "members":{ "Condition":{ "shape":"Condition", "documentation":"

A container for describing a condition that must be met for the specified redirect to apply. For example, 1. If request is for pages in the /docs folder, redirect to the /documents folder. 2. If request results in HTTP error 4xx, redirect request to another host where you might process the error.

" }, "Redirect":{ "shape":"Redirect", "documentation":"

Container for redirect information. You can redirect requests to another host, to another page, or with another protocol. In the event of an error, you can specify a different error code to return.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the redirect behavior and when a redirect is applied. For more information about routing rules, see Configuring advanced conditional redirects in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "RoutingRules":{ "type":"list", "member":{ "shape":"RoutingRule", "locationName":"RoutingRule" } }, "Rule":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Prefix", "Status" ], "members":{ "Expiration":{ "shape":"LifecycleExpiration", "documentation":"

Specifies the expiration for the lifecycle of the object.

" }, "ID":{ "shape":"ID", "documentation":"

Unique identifier for the rule. The value can't be longer than 255 characters.

" }, "Prefix":{ "shape":"Prefix", "documentation":"

Object key prefix that identifies one or more objects to which this rule applies.

Replacement must be made for object keys containing special characters (such as carriage returns) when using XML requests. For more information, see XML related object key constraints.

" }, "Status":{ "shape":"ExpirationStatus", "documentation":"

If Enabled, the rule is currently being applied. If Disabled, the rule is not currently being applied.

" }, "Transition":{ "shape":"Transition", "documentation":"

Specifies when an object transitions to a specified storage class. For more information about Amazon S3 lifecycle configuration rules, see Transitioning Objects Using Amazon S3 Lifecycle in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "NoncurrentVersionTransition":{"shape":"NoncurrentVersionTransition"}, "NoncurrentVersionExpiration":{"shape":"NoncurrentVersionExpiration"}, "AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload":{"shape":"AbortIncompleteMultipartUpload"} }, "documentation":"

Specifies lifecycle rules for an Amazon S3 bucket. For more information, see Put Bucket Lifecycle Configuration in the Amazon S3 API Reference. For examples, see Put Bucket Lifecycle Configuration Examples.

" }, "Rules":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"Rule"}, "flattened":true }, "S3KeyFilter":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "FilterRules":{ "shape":"FilterRuleList", "locationName":"FilterRule" } }, "documentation":"

A container for object key name prefix and suffix filtering rules.

" }, "S3Location":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "BucketName", "Prefix" ], "members":{ "BucketName":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket where the restore results will be placed.

" }, "Prefix":{ "shape":"LocationPrefix", "documentation":"

The prefix that is prepended to the restore results for this request.

" }, "Encryption":{"shape":"Encryption"}, "CannedACL":{ "shape":"ObjectCannedACL", "documentation":"

The canned ACL to apply to the restore results.

" }, "AccessControlList":{ "shape":"Grants", "documentation":"

A list of grants that control access to the staged results.

" }, "Tagging":{ "shape":"Tagging", "documentation":"

The tag-set that is applied to the restore results.

" }, "UserMetadata":{ "shape":"UserMetadata", "documentation":"

A list of metadata to store with the restore results in S3.

" }, "StorageClass":{ "shape":"StorageClass", "documentation":"

The class of storage used to store the restore results.

" } }, "documentation":"

Describes an Amazon S3 location that will receive the results of the restore request.

" }, "S3RegionalOrS3ExpressBucketArnString":{ "type":"string", "max":128, "min":1, "pattern":"arn:[^:]+:(s3|s3express):.*" }, "S3TablesArn":{"type":"string"}, "S3TablesBucketArn":{"type":"string"}, "S3TablesBucketType":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "aws", "customer" ] }, "S3TablesDestination":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "TableBucketArn", "TableName" ], "members":{ "TableBucketArn":{ "shape":"S3TablesBucketArn", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the table bucket that's specified as the destination in the metadata table configuration. The destination table bucket must be in the same Region and Amazon Web Services account as the general purpose bucket.

" }, "TableName":{ "shape":"S3TablesName", "documentation":"

The name for the metadata table in your metadata table configuration. The specified metadata table name must be unique within the aws_s3_metadata namespace in the destination table bucket.

" } }, "documentation":"

The destination information for a V1 S3 Metadata configuration. The destination table bucket must be in the same Region and Amazon Web Services account as the general purpose bucket. The specified metadata table name must be unique within the aws_s3_metadata namespace in the destination table bucket.

If you created your S3 Metadata configuration before July 15, 2025, we recommend that you delete and re-create your configuration by using CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration so that you can expire journal table records and create a live inventory table.

" }, "S3TablesDestinationResult":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "TableBucketArn", "TableName", "TableArn", "TableNamespace" ], "members":{ "TableBucketArn":{ "shape":"S3TablesBucketArn", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the table bucket that's specified as the destination in the metadata table configuration. The destination table bucket must be in the same Region and Amazon Web Services account as the general purpose bucket.

" }, "TableName":{ "shape":"S3TablesName", "documentation":"

The name for the metadata table in your metadata table configuration. The specified metadata table name must be unique within the aws_s3_metadata namespace in the destination table bucket.

" }, "TableArn":{ "shape":"S3TablesArn", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the metadata table in the metadata table configuration. The specified metadata table name must be unique within the aws_s3_metadata namespace in the destination table bucket.

" }, "TableNamespace":{ "shape":"S3TablesNamespace", "documentation":"

The table bucket namespace for the metadata table in your metadata table configuration. This value is always aws_s3_metadata.

" } }, "documentation":"

The destination information for a V1 S3 Metadata configuration. The destination table bucket must be in the same Region and Amazon Web Services account as the general purpose bucket. The specified metadata table name must be unique within the aws_s3_metadata namespace in the destination table bucket.

If you created your S3 Metadata configuration before July 15, 2025, we recommend that you delete and re-create your configuration by using CreateBucketMetadataConfiguration so that you can expire journal table records and create a live inventory table.

" }, "S3TablesName":{"type":"string"}, "S3TablesNamespace":{"type":"string"}, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{"type":"string"}, "SSECustomerKey":{ "type":"string", "sensitive":true }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{"type":"string"}, "SSEKMS":{ "type":"structure", "required":["KeyId"], "members":{ "KeyId":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

Specifies the ID of the Key Management Service (KMS) symmetric encryption customer managed key to use for encrypting inventory reports.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the use of SSE-KMS to encrypt delivered inventory reports.

", "locationName":"SSE-KMS" }, "SSEKMSEncryptionContext":{ "type":"string", "sensitive":true }, "SSEKMSKeyId":{ "type":"string", "sensitive":true }, "SSES3":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

Specifies the use of SSE-S3 to encrypt delivered inventory reports.

", "locationName":"SSE-S3" }, "ScanRange":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Start":{ "shape":"Start", "documentation":"

Specifies the start of the byte range. This parameter is optional. Valid values: non-negative integers. The default value is 0. If only start is supplied, it means scan from that point to the end of the file. For example, <scanrange><start>50</start></scanrange> means scan from byte 50 until the end of the file.

" }, "End":{ "shape":"End", "documentation":"

Specifies the end of the byte range. This parameter is optional. Valid values: non-negative integers. The default value is one less than the size of the object being queried. If only the End parameter is supplied, it is interpreted to mean scan the last N bytes of the file. For example, <scanrange><end>50</end></scanrange> means scan the last 50 bytes.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the byte range of the object to get the records from. A record is processed when its first byte is contained by the range. This parameter is optional, but when specified, it must not be empty. See RFC 2616, Section 14.35.1 about how to specify the start and end of the range.

" }, "SelectObjectContentEventStream":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Records":{ "shape":"RecordsEvent", "documentation":"

The Records Event.

" }, "Stats":{ "shape":"StatsEvent", "documentation":"

The Stats Event.

" }, "Progress":{ "shape":"ProgressEvent", "documentation":"

The Progress Event.

" }, "Cont":{ "shape":"ContinuationEvent", "documentation":"

The Continuation Event.

" }, "End":{ "shape":"EndEvent", "documentation":"

The End Event.

" } }, "documentation":"

The container for selecting objects from a content event stream.

", "eventstream":true }, "SelectObjectContentOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Payload":{ "shape":"SelectObjectContentEventStream", "documentation":"

The array of results.

" } }, "payload":"Payload" }, "SelectObjectContentRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key", "Expression", "ExpressionType", "InputSerialization", "OutputSerialization" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The S3 bucket.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

The object key.

", "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption (SSE) algorithm used to encrypt the object. This parameter is needed only when the object was created using a checksum algorithm. For more information, see Protecting data using SSE-C keys in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKey":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKey", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption (SSE) customer managed key. This parameter is needed only when the object was created using a checksum algorithm. For more information, see Protecting data using SSE-C keys in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

The MD5 server-side encryption (SSE) customer managed key. This parameter is needed only when the object was created using a checksum algorithm. For more information, see Protecting data using SSE-C keys in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "Expression":{ "shape":"Expression", "documentation":"

The expression that is used to query the object.

" }, "ExpressionType":{ "shape":"ExpressionType", "documentation":"

The type of the provided expression (for example, SQL).

" }, "RequestProgress":{ "shape":"RequestProgress", "documentation":"

Specifies if periodic request progress information should be enabled.

" }, "InputSerialization":{ "shape":"InputSerialization", "documentation":"

Describes the format of the data in the object that is being queried.

" }, "OutputSerialization":{ "shape":"OutputSerialization", "documentation":"

Describes the format of the data that you want Amazon S3 to return in response.

" }, "ScanRange":{ "shape":"ScanRange", "documentation":"

Specifies the byte range of the object to get the records from. A record is processed when its first byte is contained by the range. This parameter is optional, but when specified, it must not be empty. See RFC 2616, Section 14.35.1 about how to specify the start and end of the range.

ScanRangemay be used in the following ways:

" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "documentation":"

Learn Amazon S3 Select is no longer available to new customers. Existing customers of Amazon S3 Select can continue to use the feature as usual. Learn more

Request to filter the contents of an Amazon S3 object based on a simple Structured Query Language (SQL) statement. In the request, along with the SQL expression, you must specify a data serialization format (JSON or CSV) of the object. Amazon S3 uses this to parse object data into records. It returns only records that match the specified SQL expression. You must also specify the data serialization format for the response. For more information, see S3Select API Documentation.

" }, "SelectParameters":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "InputSerialization", "ExpressionType", "Expression", "OutputSerialization" ], "members":{ "InputSerialization":{ "shape":"InputSerialization", "documentation":"

Describes the serialization format of the object.

" }, "ExpressionType":{ "shape":"ExpressionType", "documentation":"

The type of the provided expression (for example, SQL).

" }, "Expression":{ "shape":"Expression", "documentation":"

Amazon S3 Select is no longer available to new customers. Existing customers of Amazon S3 Select can continue to use the feature as usual. Learn more

The expression that is used to query the object.

" }, "OutputSerialization":{ "shape":"OutputSerialization", "documentation":"

Describes how the results of the Select job are serialized.

" } }, "documentation":"

Amazon S3 Select is no longer available to new customers. Existing customers of Amazon S3 Select can continue to use the feature as usual. Learn more

Describes the parameters for Select job types.

Learn How to optimize querying your data in Amazon S3 using Amazon Athena, S3 Object Lambda, or client-side filtering.

" }, "ServerSideEncryption":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "AES256", "aws:fsx", "aws:kms", "aws:kms:dsse" ] }, "ServerSideEncryptionByDefault":{ "type":"structure", "required":["SSEAlgorithm"], "members":{ "SSEAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryption", "documentation":"

Server-side encryption algorithm to use for the default encryption.

For directory buckets, there are only two supported values for server-side encryption: AES256 and aws:kms.

" }, "KMSMasterKeyID":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

Amazon Web Services Key Management Service (KMS) customer managed key ID to use for the default encryption.

You can specify the key ID, key alias, or the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the KMS key.

If you are using encryption with cross-account or Amazon Web Services service operations, you must use a fully qualified KMS key ARN. For more information, see Using encryption for cross-account operations.

Amazon S3 only supports symmetric encryption KMS keys. For more information, see Asymmetric keys in Amazon Web Services KMS in the Amazon Web Services Key Management Service Developer Guide.

" } }, "documentation":"

Describes the default server-side encryption to apply to new objects in the bucket. If a PUT Object request doesn't specify any server-side encryption, this default encryption will be applied. For more information, see PutBucketEncryption.

" }, "ServerSideEncryptionConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Rules"], "members":{ "Rules":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryptionRules", "documentation":"

Container for information about a particular server-side encryption configuration rule.

", "locationName":"Rule" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the default server-side-encryption configuration.

" }, "ServerSideEncryptionRule":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ApplyServerSideEncryptionByDefault":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryptionByDefault", "documentation":"

Specifies the default server-side encryption to apply to new objects in the bucket. If a PUT Object request doesn't specify any server-side encryption, this default encryption will be applied.

" }, "BucketKeyEnabled":{ "shape":"BucketKeyEnabled", "documentation":"

Specifies whether Amazon S3 should use an S3 Bucket Key with server-side encryption using KMS (SSE-KMS) for new objects in the bucket. Existing objects are not affected. Setting the BucketKeyEnabled element to true causes Amazon S3 to use an S3 Bucket Key.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies the default server-side encryption configuration.

" }, "ServerSideEncryptionRules":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"ServerSideEncryptionRule"}, "flattened":true }, "SessionCredentialValue":{ "type":"string", "sensitive":true }, "SessionCredentials":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "AccessKeyId", "SecretAccessKey", "SessionToken", "Expiration" ], "members":{ "AccessKeyId":{ "shape":"AccessKeyIdValue", "documentation":"

A unique identifier that's associated with a secret access key. The access key ID and the secret access key are used together to sign programmatic Amazon Web Services requests cryptographically.

", "locationName":"AccessKeyId" }, "SecretAccessKey":{ "shape":"SessionCredentialValue", "documentation":"

A key that's used with the access key ID to cryptographically sign programmatic Amazon Web Services requests. Signing a request identifies the sender and prevents the request from being altered.

", "locationName":"SecretAccessKey" }, "SessionToken":{ "shape":"SessionCredentialValue", "documentation":"

A part of the temporary security credentials. The session token is used to validate the temporary security credentials.

", "locationName":"SessionToken" }, "Expiration":{ "shape":"SessionExpiration", "documentation":"

Temporary security credentials expire after a specified interval. After temporary credentials expire, any calls that you make with those credentials will fail. So you must generate a new set of temporary credentials. Temporary credentials cannot be extended or refreshed beyond the original specified interval.

", "locationName":"Expiration" } }, "documentation":"

The established temporary security credentials of the session.

Directory buckets - These session credentials are only supported for the authentication and authorization of Zonal endpoint API operations on directory buckets.

" }, "SessionExpiration":{"type":"timestamp"}, "SessionMode":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "ReadOnly", "ReadWrite" ] }, "Setting":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "SimplePrefix":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

To use simple format for S3 keys for log objects, set SimplePrefix to an empty object.

[DestinationPrefix][YYYY]-[MM]-[DD]-[hh]-[mm]-[ss]-[UniqueString]

", "locationName":"SimplePrefix" }, "Size":{ "type":"long", "box":true }, "SkipValidation":{ "type":"boolean", "box":true }, "SourceSelectionCriteria":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "SseKmsEncryptedObjects":{ "shape":"SseKmsEncryptedObjects", "documentation":"

A container for filter information for the selection of Amazon S3 objects encrypted with Amazon Web Services KMS. If you include SourceSelectionCriteria in the replication configuration, this element is required.

" }, "ReplicaModifications":{ "shape":"ReplicaModifications", "documentation":"

A filter that you can specify for selections for modifications on replicas. Amazon S3 doesn't replicate replica modifications by default. In the latest version of replication configuration (when Filter is specified), you can specify this element and set the status to Enabled to replicate modifications on replicas.

If you don't specify the Filter element, Amazon S3 assumes that the replication configuration is the earlier version, V1. In the earlier version, this element is not allowed

" } }, "documentation":"

A container that describes additional filters for identifying the source objects that you want to replicate. You can choose to enable or disable the replication of these objects. Currently, Amazon S3 supports only the filter that you can specify for objects created with server-side encryption using a customer managed key stored in Amazon Web Services Key Management Service (SSE-KMS).

" }, "SseKmsEncryptedObjects":{ "type":"structure", "required":["Status"], "members":{ "Status":{ "shape":"SseKmsEncryptedObjectsStatus", "documentation":"

Specifies whether Amazon S3 replicates objects created with server-side encryption using an Amazon Web Services KMS key stored in Amazon Web Services Key Management Service.

" } }, "documentation":"

A container for filter information for the selection of S3 objects encrypted with Amazon Web Services KMS.

" }, "SseKmsEncryptedObjectsStatus":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Enabled", "Disabled" ] }, "Start":{ "type":"long", "box":true }, "StartAfter":{"type":"string"}, "Stats":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "BytesScanned":{ "shape":"BytesScanned", "documentation":"

The total number of object bytes scanned.

" }, "BytesProcessed":{ "shape":"BytesProcessed", "documentation":"

The total number of uncompressed object bytes processed.

" }, "BytesReturned":{ "shape":"BytesReturned", "documentation":"

The total number of bytes of records payload data returned.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for the stats details.

" }, "StatsEvent":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Details":{ "shape":"Stats", "documentation":"

The Stats event details.

", "eventpayload":true } }, "documentation":"

Container for the Stats Event.

", "event":true }, "StorageClass":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "STANDARD", "REDUCED_REDUNDANCY", "STANDARD_IA", "ONEZONE_IA", "INTELLIGENT_TIERING", "GLACIER", "DEEP_ARCHIVE", "OUTPOSTS", "GLACIER_IR", "SNOW", "EXPRESS_ONEZONE", "FSX_OPENZFS" ] }, "StorageClassAnalysis":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "DataExport":{ "shape":"StorageClassAnalysisDataExport", "documentation":"

Specifies how data related to the storage class analysis for an Amazon S3 bucket should be exported.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies data related to access patterns to be collected and made available to analyze the tradeoffs between different storage classes for an Amazon S3 bucket.

" }, "StorageClassAnalysisDataExport":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "OutputSchemaVersion", "Destination" ], "members":{ "OutputSchemaVersion":{ "shape":"StorageClassAnalysisSchemaVersion", "documentation":"

The version of the output schema to use when exporting data. Must be V_1.

" }, "Destination":{ "shape":"AnalyticsExportDestination", "documentation":"

The place to store the data for an analysis.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for data related to the storage class analysis for an Amazon S3 bucket for export.

" }, "StorageClassAnalysisSchemaVersion":{ "type":"string", "enum":["V_1"] }, "Suffix":{"type":"string"}, "TableSseAlgorithm":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "aws:kms", "AES256" ] }, "Tag":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Key", "Value" ], "members":{ "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Name of the object key.

" }, "Value":{ "shape":"Value", "documentation":"

Value of the tag.

" } }, "documentation":"

A container of a key value name pair.

" }, "TagCount":{ "type":"integer", "box":true }, "TagSet":{ "type":"list", "member":{ "shape":"Tag", "locationName":"Tag" } }, "Tagging":{ "type":"structure", "required":["TagSet"], "members":{ "TagSet":{ "shape":"TagSet", "documentation":"

A collection for a set of tags

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for TagSet elements.

" }, "TaggingDirective":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "COPY", "REPLACE" ] }, "TaggingHeader":{"type":"string"}, "TargetBucket":{"type":"string"}, "TargetGrant":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Grantee":{ "shape":"Grantee", "documentation":"

Container for the person being granted permissions.

" }, "Permission":{ "shape":"BucketLogsPermission", "documentation":"

Logging permissions assigned to the grantee for the bucket.

" } }, "documentation":"

Container for granting information.

Buckets that use the bucket owner enforced setting for Object Ownership don't support target grants. For more information, see Permissions server access log delivery in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "TargetGrants":{ "type":"list", "member":{ "shape":"TargetGrant", "locationName":"Grant" } }, "TargetObjectKeyFormat":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "SimplePrefix":{ "shape":"SimplePrefix", "documentation":"

To use the simple format for S3 keys for log objects. To specify SimplePrefix format, set SimplePrefix to {}.

", "locationName":"SimplePrefix" }, "PartitionedPrefix":{ "shape":"PartitionedPrefix", "documentation":"

Partitioned S3 key for log objects.

", "locationName":"PartitionedPrefix" } }, "documentation":"

Amazon S3 key format for log objects. Only one format, PartitionedPrefix or SimplePrefix, is allowed.

" }, "TargetPrefix":{"type":"string"}, "Tier":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "Standard", "Bulk", "Expedited" ] }, "Tiering":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Days", "AccessTier" ], "members":{ "Days":{ "shape":"IntelligentTieringDays", "documentation":"

The number of consecutive days of no access after which an object will be eligible to be transitioned to the corresponding tier. The minimum number of days specified for Archive Access tier must be at least 90 days and Deep Archive Access tier must be at least 180 days. The maximum can be up to 2 years (730 days).

" }, "AccessTier":{ "shape":"IntelligentTieringAccessTier", "documentation":"

S3 Intelligent-Tiering access tier. See Storage class for automatically optimizing frequently and infrequently accessed objects for a list of access tiers in the S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class.

" } }, "documentation":"

The S3 Intelligent-Tiering storage class is designed to optimize storage costs by automatically moving data to the most cost-effective storage access tier, without additional operational overhead.

" }, "TieringList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"Tiering"}, "flattened":true }, "Token":{"type":"string"}, "TooManyParts":{ "type":"structure", "members":{}, "documentation":"

You have attempted to add more parts than the maximum of 10000 that are allowed for this object. You can use the CopyObject operation to copy this object to another and then add more data to the newly copied object.

", "error":{"httpStatusCode":400}, "exception":true }, "TopicArn":{"type":"string"}, "TopicConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "TopicArn", "Events" ], "members":{ "Id":{"shape":"NotificationId"}, "TopicArn":{ "shape":"TopicArn", "documentation":"

The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the Amazon SNS topic to which Amazon S3 publishes a message when it detects events of the specified type.

", "locationName":"Topic" }, "Events":{ "shape":"EventList", "documentation":"

The Amazon S3 bucket event about which to send notifications. For more information, see Supported Event Types in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "locationName":"Event" }, "Filter":{"shape":"NotificationConfigurationFilter"} }, "documentation":"

A container for specifying the configuration for publication of messages to an Amazon Simple Notification Service (Amazon SNS) topic when Amazon S3 detects specified events.

" }, "TopicConfigurationDeprecated":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Id":{"shape":"NotificationId"}, "Events":{ "shape":"EventList", "documentation":"

A collection of events related to objects

", "locationName":"Event" }, "Event":{ "shape":"Event", "documentation":"

Bucket event for which to send notifications.

", "deprecated":true }, "Topic":{ "shape":"TopicArn", "documentation":"

Amazon SNS topic to which Amazon S3 will publish a message to report the specified events for the bucket.

" } }, "documentation":"

A container for specifying the configuration for publication of messages to an Amazon Simple Notification Service (Amazon SNS) topic when Amazon S3 detects specified events. This data type is deprecated. Use TopicConfiguration instead.

" }, "TopicConfigurationList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"TopicConfiguration"}, "flattened":true }, "Transition":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "Date":{ "shape":"Date", "documentation":"

Indicates when objects are transitioned to the specified storage class. The date value must be in ISO 8601 format. The time is always midnight UTC.

" }, "Days":{ "shape":"Days", "documentation":"

Indicates the number of days after creation when objects are transitioned to the specified storage class. If the specified storage class is INTELLIGENT_TIERING, GLACIER_IR, GLACIER, or DEEP_ARCHIVE, valid values are 0 or positive integers. If the specified storage class is STANDARD_IA or ONEZONE_IA, valid values are positive integers greater than 30. Be aware that some storage classes have a minimum storage duration and that you're charged for transitioning objects before their minimum storage duration. For more information, see Constraints and considerations for transitions in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "StorageClass":{ "shape":"TransitionStorageClass", "documentation":"

The storage class to which you want the object to transition.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies when an object transitions to a specified storage class. For more information about Amazon S3 lifecycle configuration rules, see Transitioning Objects Using Amazon S3 Lifecycle in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

" }, "TransitionDefaultMinimumObjectSize":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "varies_by_storage_class", "all_storage_classes_128K" ] }, "TransitionList":{ "type":"list", "member":{"shape":"Transition"}, "flattened":true }, "TransitionStorageClass":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "GLACIER", "STANDARD_IA", "ONEZONE_IA", "INTELLIGENT_TIERING", "DEEP_ARCHIVE", "GLACIER_IR" ] }, "Type":{ "type":"string", "enum":[ "CanonicalUser", "AmazonCustomerByEmail", "Group" ] }, "URI":{"type":"string"}, "UpdateBucketMetadataInventoryTableConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "InventoryTableConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The general purpose bucket that corresponds to the metadata configuration that you want to enable or disable an inventory table for.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The Content-MD5 header for the inventory table configuration.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

The checksum algorithm to use with your inventory table configuration.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "InventoryTableConfiguration":{ "shape":"InventoryTableConfigurationUpdates", "documentation":"

The contents of your inventory table configuration.

", "locationName":"InventoryTableConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The expected owner of the general purpose bucket that corresponds to the metadata table configuration that you want to enable or disable an inventory table for.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"InventoryTableConfiguration" }, "UpdateBucketMetadataJournalTableConfigurationRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "JournalTableConfiguration" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The general purpose bucket that corresponds to the metadata configuration that you want to enable or disable journal table record expiration for.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The Content-MD5 header for the journal table configuration.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

The checksum algorithm to use with your journal table configuration.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "JournalTableConfiguration":{ "shape":"JournalTableConfigurationUpdates", "documentation":"

The contents of your journal table configuration.

", "locationName":"JournalTableConfiguration", "xmlNamespace":{"uri":"http://s3.amazonaws.com/doc/2006-03-01/"} }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The expected owner of the general purpose bucket that corresponds to the metadata table configuration that you want to enable or disable journal table record expiration for.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"JournalTableConfiguration" }, "UploadIdMarker":{"type":"string"}, "UploadPartCopyOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "CopySourceVersionId":{ "shape":"CopySourceVersionId", "documentation":"

The version of the source object that was copied, if you have enabled versioning on the source bucket.

This functionality is not supported when the source object is in a directory bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-version-id" }, "CopyPartResult":{ "shape":"CopyPartResult", "documentation":"

Container for all response elements.

" }, "ServerSideEncryption":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryption", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption algorithm used when you store this object in Amazon S3 or Amazon FSx.

When accessing data stored in Amazon FSx file systems using S3 access points, the only valid server side encryption option is aws:fsx.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested, the response will include this header to confirm the encryption algorithm that's used.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested, the response will include this header to provide the round-trip message integrity verification of the customer-provided encryption key.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "SSEKMSKeyId":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

If present, indicates the ID of the KMS key that was used for object encryption.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" }, "BucketKeyEnabled":{ "shape":"BucketKeyEnabled", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the multipart upload uses an S3 Bucket Key for server-side encryption with Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-bucket-key-enabled" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } }, "payload":"CopyPartResult" }, "UploadPartCopyRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "CopySource", "Key", "PartNumber", "UploadId" ], "members":{ "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The bucket name.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Copying objects across different Amazon Web Services Regions isn't supported when the source or destination bucket is in Amazon Web Services Local Zones. The source and destination buckets must have the same parent Amazon Web Services Region. Otherwise, you get an HTTP 400 Bad Request error with the error code InvalidRequest.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "CopySource":{ "shape":"CopySource", "documentation":"

Specifies the source object for the copy operation. You specify the value in one of two formats, depending on whether you want to access the source object through an access point:

If your bucket has versioning enabled, you could have multiple versions of the same object. By default, x-amz-copy-source identifies the current version of the source object to copy. To copy a specific version of the source object to copy, append ?versionId=<version-id> to the x-amz-copy-source request header (for example, x-amz-copy-source: /awsexamplebucket/reports/january.pdf?versionId=QUpfdndhfd8438MNFDN93jdnJFkdmqnh893).

If the current version is a delete marker and you don't specify a versionId in the x-amz-copy-source request header, Amazon S3 returns a 404 Not Found error, because the object does not exist. If you specify versionId in the x-amz-copy-source and the versionId is a delete marker, Amazon S3 returns an HTTP 400 Bad Request error, because you are not allowed to specify a delete marker as a version for the x-amz-copy-source.

Directory buckets - S3 Versioning isn't enabled and supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source" }, "CopySourceIfMatch":{ "shape":"CopySourceIfMatch", "documentation":"

Copies the object if its entity tag (ETag) matches the specified tag.

If both of the x-amz-copy-source-if-match and x-amz-copy-source-if-unmodified-since headers are present in the request as follows:

x-amz-copy-source-if-match condition evaluates to true, and;

x-amz-copy-source-if-unmodified-since condition evaluates to false;

Amazon S3 returns 200 OK and copies the data.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-if-match" }, "CopySourceIfModifiedSince":{ "shape":"CopySourceIfModifiedSince", "documentation":"

Copies the object if it has been modified since the specified time.

If both of the x-amz-copy-source-if-none-match and x-amz-copy-source-if-modified-since headers are present in the request as follows:

x-amz-copy-source-if-none-match condition evaluates to false, and;

x-amz-copy-source-if-modified-since condition evaluates to true;

Amazon S3 returns 412 Precondition Failed response code.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-if-modified-since" }, "CopySourceIfNoneMatch":{ "shape":"CopySourceIfNoneMatch", "documentation":"

Copies the object if its entity tag (ETag) is different than the specified ETag.

If both of the x-amz-copy-source-if-none-match and x-amz-copy-source-if-modified-since headers are present in the request as follows:

x-amz-copy-source-if-none-match condition evaluates to false, and;

x-amz-copy-source-if-modified-since condition evaluates to true;

Amazon S3 returns 412 Precondition Failed response code.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-if-none-match" }, "CopySourceIfUnmodifiedSince":{ "shape":"CopySourceIfUnmodifiedSince", "documentation":"

Copies the object if it hasn't been modified since the specified time.

If both of the x-amz-copy-source-if-match and x-amz-copy-source-if-unmodified-since headers are present in the request as follows:

x-amz-copy-source-if-match condition evaluates to true, and;

x-amz-copy-source-if-unmodified-since condition evaluates to false;

Amazon S3 returns 200 OK and copies the data.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-if-unmodified-since" }, "CopySourceRange":{ "shape":"CopySourceRange", "documentation":"

The range of bytes to copy from the source object. The range value must use the form bytes=first-last, where the first and last are the zero-based byte offsets to copy. For example, bytes=0-9 indicates that you want to copy the first 10 bytes of the source. You can copy a range only if the source object is greater than 5 MB.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-range" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Object key for which the multipart upload was initiated.

", "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "PartNumber":{ "shape":"PartNumber", "documentation":"

Part number of part being copied. This is a positive integer between 1 and 10,000.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"partNumber" }, "UploadId":{ "shape":"MultipartUploadId", "documentation":"

Upload ID identifying the multipart upload whose part is being copied.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"uploadId" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Specifies the algorithm to use when encrypting the object (for example, AES256).

This functionality is not supported when the destination bucket is a directory bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKey":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKey", "documentation":"

Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use in encrypting data. This value is used to store the object and then it is discarded; Amazon S3 does not store the encryption key. The key must be appropriate for use with the algorithm specified in the x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm header. This must be the same encryption key specified in the initiate multipart upload request.

This functionality is not supported when the destination bucket is a directory bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321. Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure that the encryption key was transmitted without error.

This functionality is not supported when the destination bucket is a directory bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "CopySourceSSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"CopySourceSSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Specifies the algorithm to use when decrypting the source object (for example, AES256).

This functionality is not supported when the source object is in a directory bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "CopySourceSSECustomerKey":{ "shape":"CopySourceSSECustomerKey", "documentation":"

Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use to decrypt the source object. The encryption key provided in this header must be one that was used when the source object was created.

This functionality is not supported when the source object is in a directory bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-server-side-encryption-customer-key" }, "CopySourceSSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"CopySourceSSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321. Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure that the encryption key was transmitted without error.

This functionality is not supported when the source object is in a directory bucket.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-copy-source-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected destination bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the destination bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" }, "ExpectedSourceBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected source bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the source bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-source-expected-bucket-owner" } } }, "UploadPartOutput":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ServerSideEncryption":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryption", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption algorithm used when you store this object in Amazon S3 or Amazon FSx.

When accessing data stored in Amazon FSx file systems using S3 access points, the only valid server side encryption option is aws:fsx.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption" }, "ETag":{ "shape":"ETag", "documentation":"

Entity tag for the uploaded object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"ETag" }, "ChecksumCRC32":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32 checksum of the object. This checksum is only be present if the checksum was uploaded with the object. When you use an API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc32" }, "ChecksumCRC32C":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32C", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32C checksum of the object. This checksum is only present if the checksum was uploaded with the object. When you use an API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc32c" }, "ChecksumCRC64NVME":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC64NVME", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 64-bit CRC64NVME checksum of the part. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc64nvme" }, "ChecksumSHA1":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA1", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 160-bit SHA1 digest of the object. This will only be present if the object was uploaded with the object. When you use the API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-sha1" }, "ChecksumSHA256":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA256", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded, 256-bit SHA256 digest of the object. This will only be present if the object was uploaded with the object. When you use an API operation on an object that was uploaded using multipart uploads, this value may not be a direct checksum value of the full object. Instead, it's a calculation based on the checksum values of each individual part. For more information about how checksums are calculated with multipart uploads, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-sha256" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested, the response will include this header to confirm the encryption algorithm that's used.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

If server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was requested, the response will include this header to provide the round-trip message integrity verification of the customer-provided encryption key.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "SSEKMSKeyId":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

If present, indicates the ID of the KMS key that was used for object encryption.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" }, "BucketKeyEnabled":{ "shape":"BucketKeyEnabled", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the multipart upload uses an S3 Bucket Key for server-side encryption with Key Management Service (KMS) keys (SSE-KMS).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-bucket-key-enabled" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-charged" } } }, "UploadPartRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "Bucket", "Key", "PartNumber", "UploadId" ], "members":{ "Body":{ "shape":"Body", "documentation":"

Object data.

", "streaming":true }, "Bucket":{ "shape":"BucketName", "documentation":"

The name of the bucket to which the multipart upload was initiated.

Directory buckets - When you use this operation with a directory bucket, you must use virtual-hosted-style requests in the format Bucket-name.s3express-zone-id.region-code.amazonaws.com. Path-style requests are not supported. Directory bucket names must be unique in the chosen Zone (Availability Zone or Local Zone). Bucket names must follow the format bucket-base-name--zone-id--x-s3 (for example, amzn-s3-demo-bucket--usw2-az1--x-s3). For information about bucket naming restrictions, see Directory bucket naming rules in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Access points - When you use this action with an access point for general purpose buckets, you must provide the alias of the access point in place of the bucket name or specify the access point ARN. When you use this action with an access point for directory buckets, you must provide the access point name in place of the bucket name. When using the access point ARN, you must direct requests to the access point hostname. The access point hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.s3-accesspoint.Region.amazonaws.com. When using this action with an access point through the Amazon Web Services SDKs, you provide the access point ARN in place of the bucket name. For more information about access point ARNs, see Using access points in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Object Lambda access points are not supported by directory buckets.

S3 on Outposts - When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, you must direct requests to the S3 on Outposts hostname. The S3 on Outposts hostname takes the form AccessPointName-AccountId.outpostID.s3-outposts.Region.amazonaws.com. When you use this action with S3 on Outposts, the destination bucket must be the Outposts access point ARN or the access point alias. For more information about S3 on Outposts, see What is S3 on Outposts? in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Bucket"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Bucket" }, "ContentLength":{ "shape":"ContentLength", "documentation":"

Size of the body in bytes. This parameter is useful when the size of the body cannot be determined automatically.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Length" }, "ContentMD5":{ "shape":"ContentMD5", "documentation":"

The Base64 encoded 128-bit MD5 digest of the part data. This parameter is auto-populated when using the command from the CLI. This parameter is required if object lock parameters are specified.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-MD5" }, "ChecksumAlgorithm":{ "shape":"ChecksumAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Indicates the algorithm used to create the checksum for the object when you use the SDK. This header will not provide any additional functionality if you don't use the SDK. When you send this header, there must be a corresponding x-amz-checksum or x-amz-trailer header sent. Otherwise, Amazon S3 fails the request with the HTTP status code 400 Bad Request. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

If you provide an individual checksum, Amazon S3 ignores any provided ChecksumAlgorithm parameter.

This checksum algorithm must be the same for all parts and it match the checksum value supplied in the CreateMultipartUpload request.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-sdk-checksum-algorithm" }, "ChecksumCRC32":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32 checksum of the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc32" }, "ChecksumCRC32C":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32C", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32C checksum of the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc32c" }, "ChecksumCRC64NVME":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC64NVME", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 64-bit CRC64NVME checksum of the part. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-crc64nvme" }, "ChecksumSHA1":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA1", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 160-bit SHA1 digest of the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-sha1" }, "ChecksumSHA256":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA256", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 256-bit SHA256 digest of the object. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-checksum-sha256" }, "Key":{ "shape":"ObjectKey", "documentation":"

Object key for which the multipart upload was initiated.

", "contextParam":{"name":"Key"}, "location":"uri", "locationName":"Key" }, "PartNumber":{ "shape":"PartNumber", "documentation":"

Part number of part being uploaded. This is a positive integer between 1 and 10,000.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"partNumber" }, "UploadId":{ "shape":"MultipartUploadId", "documentation":"

Upload ID identifying the multipart upload whose part is being uploaded.

", "location":"querystring", "locationName":"uploadId" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Specifies the algorithm to use when encrypting the object (for example, AES256).

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSECustomerKey":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKey", "documentation":"

Specifies the customer-provided encryption key for Amazon S3 to use in encrypting data. This value is used to store the object and then it is discarded; Amazon S3 does not store the encryption key. The key must be appropriate for use with the algorithm specified in the x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm header. This must be the same encryption key specified in the initiate multipart upload request.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

Specifies the 128-bit MD5 digest of the encryption key according to RFC 1321. Amazon S3 uses this header for a message integrity check to ensure that the encryption key was transmitted without error.

This functionality is not supported for directory buckets.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "RequestPayer":{ "shape":"RequestPayer", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-payer" }, "ExpectedBucketOwner":{ "shape":"AccountId", "documentation":"

The account ID of the expected bucket owner. If the account ID that you provide does not match the actual owner of the bucket, the request fails with the HTTP status code 403 Forbidden (access denied).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-expected-bucket-owner" } }, "payload":"Body" }, "UserMetadata":{ "type":"list", "member":{ "shape":"MetadataEntry", "locationName":"MetadataEntry" } }, "Value":{"type":"string"}, "VersionCount":{ "type":"integer", "box":true }, "VersionIdMarker":{"type":"string"}, "VersioningConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "MFADelete":{ "shape":"MFADelete", "documentation":"

Specifies whether MFA delete is enabled in the bucket versioning configuration. This element is only returned if the bucket has been configured with MFA delete. If the bucket has never been so configured, this element is not returned.

", "locationName":"MfaDelete" }, "Status":{ "shape":"BucketVersioningStatus", "documentation":"

The versioning state of the bucket.

" } }, "documentation":"

Describes the versioning state of an Amazon S3 bucket. For more information, see PUT Bucket versioning in the Amazon S3 API Reference.

" }, "WebsiteConfiguration":{ "type":"structure", "members":{ "ErrorDocument":{ "shape":"ErrorDocument", "documentation":"

The name of the error document for the website.

" }, "IndexDocument":{ "shape":"IndexDocument", "documentation":"

The name of the index document for the website.

" }, "RedirectAllRequestsTo":{ "shape":"RedirectAllRequestsTo", "documentation":"

The redirect behavior for every request to this bucket's website endpoint.

If you specify this property, you can't specify any other property.

" }, "RoutingRules":{ "shape":"RoutingRules", "documentation":"

Rules that define when a redirect is applied and the redirect behavior.

" } }, "documentation":"

Specifies website configuration parameters for an Amazon S3 bucket.

" }, "WebsiteRedirectLocation":{"type":"string"}, "WriteGetObjectResponseRequest":{ "type":"structure", "required":[ "RequestRoute", "RequestToken" ], "members":{ "RequestRoute":{ "shape":"RequestRoute", "documentation":"

Route prefix to the HTTP URL generated.

", "hostLabel":true, "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-route" }, "RequestToken":{ "shape":"RequestToken", "documentation":"

A single use encrypted token that maps WriteGetObjectResponse to the end user GetObject request.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-request-token" }, "Body":{ "shape":"Body", "documentation":"

The object data.

", "streaming":true }, "StatusCode":{ "shape":"GetObjectResponseStatusCode", "documentation":"

The integer status code for an HTTP response of a corresponding GetObject request. The following is a list of status codes.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-status" }, "ErrorCode":{ "shape":"ErrorCode", "documentation":"

A string that uniquely identifies an error condition. Returned in the <Code> tag of the error XML response for a corresponding GetObject call. Cannot be used with a successful StatusCode header or when the transformed object is provided in the body. All error codes from S3 are sentence-cased. The regular expression (regex) value is \"^[A-Z][a-zA-Z]+$\".

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-error-code" }, "ErrorMessage":{ "shape":"ErrorMessage", "documentation":"

Contains a generic description of the error condition. Returned in the <Message> tag of the error XML response for a corresponding GetObject call. Cannot be used with a successful StatusCode header or when the transformed object is provided in body.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-error-message" }, "AcceptRanges":{ "shape":"AcceptRanges", "documentation":"

Indicates that a range of bytes was specified.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-accept-ranges" }, "CacheControl":{ "shape":"CacheControl", "documentation":"

Specifies caching behavior along the request/reply chain.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-Cache-Control" }, "ContentDisposition":{ "shape":"ContentDisposition", "documentation":"

Specifies presentational information for the object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-Content-Disposition" }, "ContentEncoding":{ "shape":"ContentEncoding", "documentation":"

Specifies what content encodings have been applied to the object and thus what decoding mechanisms must be applied to obtain the media-type referenced by the Content-Type header field.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-Content-Encoding" }, "ContentLanguage":{ "shape":"ContentLanguage", "documentation":"

The language the content is in.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-Content-Language" }, "ContentLength":{ "shape":"ContentLength", "documentation":"

The size of the content body in bytes.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"Content-Length" }, "ContentRange":{ "shape":"ContentRange", "documentation":"

The portion of the object returned in the response.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-Content-Range" }, "ContentType":{ "shape":"ContentType", "documentation":"

A standard MIME type describing the format of the object data.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-Content-Type" }, "ChecksumCRC32":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This specifies the Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32 checksum of the object returned by the Object Lambda function. This may not match the checksum for the object stored in Amazon S3. Amazon S3 will perform validation of the checksum values only when the original GetObject request required checksum validation. For more information about checksums, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Only one checksum header can be specified at a time. If you supply multiple checksum headers, this request will fail.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-checksum-crc32" }, "ChecksumCRC32C":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC32C", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This specifies the Base64 encoded, 32-bit CRC32C checksum of the object returned by the Object Lambda function. This may not match the checksum for the object stored in Amazon S3. Amazon S3 will perform validation of the checksum values only when the original GetObject request required checksum validation. For more information about checksums, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Only one checksum header can be specified at a time. If you supply multiple checksum headers, this request will fail.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-checksum-crc32c" }, "ChecksumCRC64NVME":{ "shape":"ChecksumCRC64NVME", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This header specifies the Base64 encoded, 64-bit CRC64NVME checksum of the part. For more information, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-checksum-crc64nvme" }, "ChecksumSHA1":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA1", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This specifies the Base64 encoded, 160-bit SHA1 digest of the object returned by the Object Lambda function. This may not match the checksum for the object stored in Amazon S3. Amazon S3 will perform validation of the checksum values only when the original GetObject request required checksum validation. For more information about checksums, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Only one checksum header can be specified at a time. If you supply multiple checksum headers, this request will fail.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-checksum-sha1" }, "ChecksumSHA256":{ "shape":"ChecksumSHA256", "documentation":"

This header can be used as a data integrity check to verify that the data received is the same data that was originally sent. This specifies the Base64 encoded, 256-bit SHA256 digest of the object returned by the Object Lambda function. This may not match the checksum for the object stored in Amazon S3. Amazon S3 will perform validation of the checksum values only when the original GetObject request required checksum validation. For more information about checksums, see Checking object integrity in the Amazon S3 User Guide.

Only one checksum header can be specified at a time. If you supply multiple checksum headers, this request will fail.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-checksum-sha256" }, "DeleteMarker":{ "shape":"DeleteMarker", "documentation":"

Specifies whether an object stored in Amazon S3 is (true) or is not (false) a delete marker. To learn more about delete markers, see Working with delete markers.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-delete-marker" }, "ETag":{ "shape":"ETag", "documentation":"

An opaque identifier assigned by a web server to a specific version of a resource found at a URL.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-ETag" }, "Expires":{ "shape":"Expires", "documentation":"

The date and time at which the object is no longer cacheable.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-Expires" }, "Expiration":{ "shape":"Expiration", "documentation":"

If the object expiration is configured (see PUT Bucket lifecycle), the response includes this header. It includes the expiry-date and rule-id key-value pairs that provide the object expiration information. The value of the rule-id is URL-encoded.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-expiration" }, "LastModified":{ "shape":"LastModified", "documentation":"

The date and time that the object was last modified.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-Last-Modified" }, "MissingMeta":{ "shape":"MissingMeta", "documentation":"

Set to the number of metadata entries not returned in x-amz-meta headers. This can happen if you create metadata using an API like SOAP that supports more flexible metadata than the REST API. For example, using SOAP, you can create metadata whose values are not legal HTTP headers.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-missing-meta" }, "Metadata":{ "shape":"Metadata", "documentation":"

A map of metadata to store with the object in S3.

", "location":"headers", "locationName":"x-amz-meta-" }, "ObjectLockMode":{ "shape":"ObjectLockMode", "documentation":"

Indicates whether an object stored in Amazon S3 has Object Lock enabled. For more information about S3 Object Lock, see Object Lock.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-object-lock-mode" }, "ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus":{ "shape":"ObjectLockLegalHoldStatus", "documentation":"

Indicates whether an object stored in Amazon S3 has an active legal hold.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-object-lock-legal-hold" }, "ObjectLockRetainUntilDate":{ "shape":"ObjectLockRetainUntilDate", "documentation":"

The date and time when Object Lock is configured to expire.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-object-lock-retain-until-date" }, "PartsCount":{ "shape":"PartsCount", "documentation":"

The count of parts this object has.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-mp-parts-count" }, "ReplicationStatus":{ "shape":"ReplicationStatus", "documentation":"

Indicates if request involves bucket that is either a source or destination in a Replication rule. For more information about S3 Replication, see Replication.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-replication-status" }, "RequestCharged":{ "shape":"RequestCharged", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-request-charged" }, "Restore":{ "shape":"Restore", "documentation":"

Provides information about object restoration operation and expiration time of the restored object copy.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-restore" }, "ServerSideEncryption":{ "shape":"ServerSideEncryption", "documentation":"

The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing requested object in Amazon S3 or Amazon FSx.

When accessing data stored in Amazon FSx file systems using S3 access points, the only valid server side encryption option is aws:fsx.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-server-side-encryption" }, "SSECustomerAlgorithm":{ "shape":"SSECustomerAlgorithm", "documentation":"

Encryption algorithm used if server-side encryption with a customer-provided encryption key was specified for object stored in Amazon S3.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-algorithm" }, "SSEKMSKeyId":{ "shape":"SSEKMSKeyId", "documentation":"

If present, specifies the ID (Key ID, Key ARN, or Key Alias) of the Amazon Web Services Key Management Service (Amazon Web Services KMS) symmetric encryption customer managed key that was used for stored in Amazon S3 object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-server-side-encryption-aws-kms-key-id" }, "SSECustomerKeyMD5":{ "shape":"SSECustomerKeyMD5", "documentation":"

128-bit MD5 digest of customer-provided encryption key used in Amazon S3 to encrypt data stored in S3. For more information, see Protecting data using server-side encryption with customer-provided encryption keys (SSE-C).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-server-side-encryption-customer-key-MD5" }, "StorageClass":{ "shape":"StorageClass", "documentation":"

Provides storage class information of the object. Amazon S3 returns this header for all objects except for S3 Standard storage class objects.

For more information, see Storage Classes.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-storage-class" }, "TagCount":{ "shape":"TagCount", "documentation":"

The number of tags, if any, on the object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-tagging-count" }, "VersionId":{ "shape":"ObjectVersionId", "documentation":"

An ID used to reference a specific version of the object.

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-version-id" }, "BucketKeyEnabled":{ "shape":"BucketKeyEnabled", "documentation":"

Indicates whether the object stored in Amazon S3 uses an S3 bucket key for server-side encryption with Amazon Web Services KMS (SSE-KMS).

", "location":"header", "locationName":"x-amz-fwd-header-x-amz-server-side-encryption-bucket-key-enabled" } }, "payload":"Body" }, "WriteOffsetBytes":{ "type":"long", "box":true }, "Years":{ "type":"integer", "box":true } }, "documentation":"

", "clientContextParams":{ "Accelerate":{ "documentation":"Enables this client to use S3 Transfer Acceleration endpoints.", "type":"boolean" }, "DisableMultiRegionAccessPoints":{ "documentation":"Disables this client's usage of Multi-Region Access Points.", "type":"boolean" }, "DisableS3ExpressSessionAuth":{ "documentation":"Disables this client's usage of Session Auth for S3Express\n buckets and reverts to using conventional SigV4 for those.", "type":"boolean" }, "ForcePathStyle":{ "documentation":"Forces this client to use path-style addressing for buckets.", "type":"boolean" }, "UseArnRegion":{ "documentation":"Enables this client to use an ARN's region when constructing an endpoint instead of the client's configured region.", "type":"boolean" } } }